blob: d28c91a6e08693bd6036c5aa7c69931bfcc8160c [file] [log] [blame]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau8317b282014-04-23 01:49:41 +02002 HAProxy
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003 Configuration Manual
4 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau8317b282014-04-23 01:49:41 +02005 version 1.5
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006 willy tarreau
Willy Tarreau2e858402014-05-28 17:50:53 +02007 2014/05/28
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008
9
10This document covers the configuration language as implemented in the version
11specified above. It does not provide any hint, example or advice. For such
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012documentation, please refer to the Reference Manual or the Architecture Manual.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013The summary below is meant to help you search sections by name and navigate
14through the document.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016Note to documentation contributors :
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017 This document is formatted with 80 columns per line, with even number of
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018 spaces for indentation and without tabs. Please follow these rules strictly
19 so that it remains easily printable everywhere. If a line needs to be
20 printed verbatim and does not fit, please end each line with a backslash
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020021 ('\') and continue on next line, indented by two characters. It is also
22 sometimes useful to prefix all output lines (logs, console outs) with 3
23 closing angle brackets ('>>>') in order to help get the difference between
24 inputs and outputs when it can become ambiguous. If you add sections,
25 please update the summary below for easier searching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020026
27
28Summary
29-------
30
311. Quick reminder about HTTP
321.1. The HTTP transaction model
331.2. HTTP request
341.2.1. The Request line
351.2.2. The request headers
361.3. HTTP response
371.3.1. The Response line
381.3.2. The response headers
39
402. Configuring HAProxy
412.1. Configuration file format
422.2. Time format
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200432.3. Examples
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020044
453. Global parameters
463.1. Process management and security
473.2. Performance tuning
483.3. Debugging
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100493.4. Userlists
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200503.5. Peers
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020051
524. Proxies
534.1. Proxy keywords matrix
544.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
55
Willy Tarreau086fbf52012-09-24 20:34:51 +0200565. Bind and Server options
575.1. Bind options
585.2. Server and default-server options
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020059
606. HTTP header manipulation
61
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200627. Using ACLs and fetching samples
637.1. ACL basics
647.1.1. Matching booleans
657.1.2. Matching integers
667.1.3. Matching strings
677.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
687.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
697.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
707.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
717.3. Fetching samples
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200727.3.1. Converters
737.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
747.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
757.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
767.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
777.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200787.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020079
808. Logging
818.1. Log levels
828.2. Log formats
838.2.1. Default log format
848.2.2. TCP log format
858.2.3. HTTP log format
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +0100868.2.4. Custom log format
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +0100878.2.5. Error log format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200888.3. Advanced logging options
898.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
908.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
918.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
928.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
938.4. Timing events
948.5. Session state at disconnection
958.6. Non-printable characters
968.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
978.8. Capturing HTTP headers
988.9. Examples of logs
99
1009. Statistics and monitoring
1019.1. CSV format
1029.2. Unix Socket commands
103
104
1051. Quick reminder about HTTP
106----------------------------
107
108When haproxy is running in HTTP mode, both the request and the response are
109fully analyzed and indexed, thus it becomes possible to build matching criteria
110on almost anything found in the contents.
111
112However, it is important to understand how HTTP requests and responses are
113formed, and how HAProxy decomposes them. It will then become easier to write
114correct rules and to debug existing configurations.
115
116
1171.1. The HTTP transaction model
118-------------------------------
119
120The HTTP protocol is transaction-driven. This means that each request will lead
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100121to one and only one response. Traditionally, a TCP connection is established
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200122from the client to the server, a request is sent by the client on the
123connection, the server responds and the connection is closed. A new request
124will involve a new connection :
125
126 [CON1] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [CLO1] [CON2] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO2] ...
127
128In this mode, called the "HTTP close" mode, there are as many connection
129establishments as there are HTTP transactions. Since the connection is closed
130by the server after the response, the client does not need to know the content
131length.
132
133Due to the transactional nature of the protocol, it was possible to improve it
134to avoid closing a connection between two subsequent transactions. In this mode
135however, it is mandatory that the server indicates the content length for each
136response so that the client does not wait indefinitely. For this, a special
137header is used: "Content-length". This mode is called the "keep-alive" mode :
138
139 [CON] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO] ...
140
141Its advantages are a reduced latency between transactions, and less processing
142power required on the server side. It is generally better than the close mode,
143but not always because the clients often limit their concurrent connections to
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200144a smaller value.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200145
146A last improvement in the communications is the pipelining mode. It still uses
147keep-alive, but the client does not wait for the first response to send the
148second request. This is useful for fetching large number of images composing a
149page :
150
151 [CON] [REQ1] [REQ2] ... [RESP1] [RESP2] [CLO] ...
152
153This can obviously have a tremendous benefit on performance because the network
154latency is eliminated between subsequent requests. Many HTTP agents do not
155correctly support pipelining since there is no way to associate a response with
156the corresponding request in HTTP. For this reason, it is mandatory for the
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100157server to reply in the exact same order as the requests were received.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200158
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100159By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
160connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
161leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and the
162start of a new request.
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200163
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100164HAProxy supports 5 connection modes :
165 - keep alive : all requests and responses are processed (default)
166 - tunnel : only the first request and response are processed,
167 everything else is forwarded with no analysis.
168 - passive close : tunnel with "Connection: close" added in both directions.
169 - server close : the server-facing connection is closed after the response.
170 - forced close : the connection is actively closed after end of response.
171
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200172
1731.2. HTTP request
174-----------------
175
176First, let's consider this HTTP request :
177
178 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100179 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200180 1 GET /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2 HTTP/1.1
181 2 Host: www.mydomain.com
182 3 User-agent: my small browser
183 4 Accept: image/jpeg, image/gif
184 5 Accept: image/png
185
186
1871.2.1. The Request line
188-----------------------
189
190Line 1 is the "request line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
191
192 - a METHOD : GET
193 - a URI : /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
194 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
195
196All of them are delimited by what the standard calls LWS (linear white spaces),
197which are commonly spaces, but can also be tabs or line feeds/carriage returns
198followed by spaces/tabs. The method itself cannot contain any colon (':') and
199is limited to alphabetic letters. All those various combinations make it
200desirable that HAProxy performs the splitting itself rather than leaving it to
201the user to write a complex or inaccurate regular expression.
202
203The URI itself can have several forms :
204
205 - A "relative URI" :
206
207 /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
208
209 It is a complete URL without the host part. This is generally what is
210 received by servers, reverse proxies and transparent proxies.
211
212 - An "absolute URI", also called a "URL" :
213
214 http://192.168.0.12:8080/serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
215
216 It is composed of a "scheme" (the protocol name followed by '://'), a host
217 name or address, optionally a colon (':') followed by a port number, then
218 a relative URI beginning at the first slash ('/') after the address part.
219 This is generally what proxies receive, but a server supporting HTTP/1.1
220 must accept this form too.
221
222 - a star ('*') : this form is only accepted in association with the OPTIONS
223 method and is not relayable. It is used to inquiry a next hop's
224 capabilities.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100225
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200226 - an address:port combination : 192.168.0.12:80
227 This is used with the CONNECT method, which is used to establish TCP
228 tunnels through HTTP proxies, generally for HTTPS, but sometimes for
229 other protocols too.
230
231In a relative URI, two sub-parts are identified. The part before the question
232mark is called the "path". It is typically the relative path to static objects
233on the server. The part after the question mark is called the "query string".
234It is mostly used with GET requests sent to dynamic scripts and is very
235specific to the language, framework or application in use.
236
237
2381.2.2. The request headers
239--------------------------
240
241The headers start at the second line. They are composed of a name at the
242beginning of the line, immediately followed by a colon (':'). Traditionally,
243an LWS is added after the colon but that's not required. Then come the values.
244Multiple identical headers may be folded into one single line, delimiting the
245values with commas, provided that their order is respected. This is commonly
246encountered in the "Cookie:" field. A header may span over multiple lines if
247the subsequent lines begin with an LWS. In the example in 1.2, lines 4 and 5
248define a total of 3 values for the "Accept:" header.
249
250Contrary to a common mis-conception, header names are not case-sensitive, and
251their values are not either if they refer to other header names (such as the
252"Connection:" header).
253
254The end of the headers is indicated by the first empty line. People often say
255that it's a double line feed, which is not exact, even if a double line feed
256is one valid form of empty line.
257
258Fortunately, HAProxy takes care of all these complex combinations when indexing
259headers, checking values and counting them, so there is no reason to worry
260about the way they could be written, but it is important not to accuse an
261application of being buggy if it does unusual, valid things.
262
263Important note:
264 As suggested by RFC2616, HAProxy normalizes headers by replacing line breaks
265 in the middle of headers by LWS in order to join multi-line headers. This
266 is necessary for proper analysis and helps less capable HTTP parsers to work
267 correctly and not to be fooled by such complex constructs.
268
269
2701.3. HTTP response
271------------------
272
273An HTTP response looks very much like an HTTP request. Both are called HTTP
274messages. Let's consider this HTTP response :
275
276 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100277 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200278 1 HTTP/1.1 200 OK
279 2 Content-length: 350
280 3 Content-Type: text/html
281
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200282As a special case, HTTP supports so called "Informational responses" as status
283codes 1xx. These messages are special in that they don't convey any part of the
284response, they're just used as sort of a signaling message to ask a client to
Willy Tarreau5843d1a2010-02-01 15:13:32 +0100285continue to post its request for instance. In the case of a status 100 response
286the requested information will be carried by the next non-100 response message
287following the informational one. This implies that multiple responses may be
288sent to a single request, and that this only works when keep-alive is enabled
289(1xx messages are HTTP/1.1 only). HAProxy handles these messages and is able to
290correctly forward and skip them, and only process the next non-100 response. As
291such, these messages are neither logged nor transformed, unless explicitly
292state otherwise. Status 101 messages indicate that the protocol is changing
293over the same connection and that haproxy must switch to tunnel mode, just as
294if a CONNECT had occurred. Then the Upgrade header would contain additional
295information about the type of protocol the connection is switching to.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200296
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200297
2981.3.1. The Response line
299------------------------
300
301Line 1 is the "response line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
302
303 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
304 - a status code : 200
305 - a reason : OK
306
307The status code is always 3-digit. The first digit indicates a general status :
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200308 - 1xx = informational message to be skipped (eg: 100, 101)
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200309 - 2xx = OK, content is following (eg: 200, 206)
310 - 3xx = OK, no content following (eg: 302, 304)
311 - 4xx = error caused by the client (eg: 401, 403, 404)
312 - 5xx = error caused by the server (eg: 500, 502, 503)
313
314Please refer to RFC2616 for the detailed meaning of all such codes. The
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100315"reason" field is just a hint, but is not parsed by clients. Anything can be
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200316found there, but it's a common practice to respect the well-established
317messages. It can be composed of one or multiple words, such as "OK", "Found",
318or "Authentication Required".
319
320Haproxy may emit the following status codes by itself :
321
322 Code When / reason
323 200 access to stats page, and when replying to monitoring requests
324 301 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
325 302 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
326 303 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +0100327 307 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
328 308 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200329 400 for an invalid or too large request
330 401 when an authentication is required to perform the action (when
331 accessing the stats page)
332 403 when a request is forbidden by a "block" ACL or "reqdeny" filter
333 408 when the request timeout strikes before the request is complete
334 500 when haproxy encounters an unrecoverable internal error, such as a
335 memory allocation failure, which should never happen
336 502 when the server returns an empty, invalid or incomplete response, or
337 when an "rspdeny" filter blocks the response.
338 503 when no server was available to handle the request, or in response to
339 monitoring requests which match the "monitor fail" condition
340 504 when the response timeout strikes before the server responds
341
342The error 4xx and 5xx codes above may be customized (see "errorloc" in section
3434.2).
344
345
3461.3.2. The response headers
347---------------------------
348
349Response headers work exactly like request headers, and as such, HAProxy uses
350the same parsing function for both. Please refer to paragraph 1.2.2 for more
351details.
352
353
3542. Configuring HAProxy
355----------------------
356
3572.1. Configuration file format
358------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200359
360HAProxy's configuration process involves 3 major sources of parameters :
361
362 - the arguments from the command-line, which always take precedence
363 - the "global" section, which sets process-wide parameters
364 - the proxies sections which can take form of "defaults", "listen",
365 "frontend" and "backend".
366
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100367The configuration file syntax consists in lines beginning with a keyword
368referenced in this manual, optionally followed by one or several parameters
369delimited by spaces. If spaces have to be entered in strings, then they must be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100370preceded by a backslash ('\') to be escaped. Backslashes also have to be
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100371escaped by doubling them.
372
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200373
3742.2. Time format
375----------------
376
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100377Some parameters involve values representing time, such as timeouts. These
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100378values are generally expressed in milliseconds (unless explicitly stated
379otherwise) but may be expressed in any other unit by suffixing the unit to the
380numeric value. It is important to consider this because it will not be repeated
381for every keyword. Supported units are :
382
383 - us : microseconds. 1 microsecond = 1/1000000 second
384 - ms : milliseconds. 1 millisecond = 1/1000 second. This is the default.
385 - s : seconds. 1s = 1000ms
386 - m : minutes. 1m = 60s = 60000ms
387 - h : hours. 1h = 60m = 3600s = 3600000ms
388 - d : days. 1d = 24h = 1440m = 86400s = 86400000ms
389
390
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +02003912.3. Examples
392-------------
393
394 # Simple configuration for an HTTP proxy listening on port 80 on all
395 # interfaces and forwarding requests to a single backend "servers" with a
396 # single server "server1" listening on 127.0.0.1:8000
397 global
398 daemon
399 maxconn 256
400
401 defaults
402 mode http
403 timeout connect 5000ms
404 timeout client 50000ms
405 timeout server 50000ms
406
407 frontend http-in
408 bind *:80
409 default_backend servers
410
411 backend servers
412 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
413
414
415 # The same configuration defined with a single listen block. Shorter but
416 # less expressive, especially in HTTP mode.
417 global
418 daemon
419 maxconn 256
420
421 defaults
422 mode http
423 timeout connect 5000ms
424 timeout client 50000ms
425 timeout server 50000ms
426
427 listen http-in
428 bind *:80
429 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
430
431
432Assuming haproxy is in $PATH, test these configurations in a shell with:
433
Willy Tarreauccb289d2010-12-11 20:19:38 +0100434 $ sudo haproxy -f configuration.conf -c
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200435
436
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004373. Global parameters
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200438--------------------
439
440Parameters in the "global" section are process-wide and often OS-specific. They
441are generally set once for all and do not need being changed once correct. Some
442of them have command-line equivalents.
443
444The following keywords are supported in the "global" section :
445
446 * Process management and security
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200447 - ca-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200448 - chroot
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200449 - crt-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200450 - daemon
451 - gid
452 - group
453 - log
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100454 - log-send-hostname
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200455 - nbproc
456 - pidfile
457 - uid
458 - ulimit-n
459 - user
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200460 - stats
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +0100461 - ssl-server-verify
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +0200462 - node
463 - description
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100464 - unix-bind
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100465
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200466 * Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +0200467 - max-spread-checks
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200468 - maxconn
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +0200469 - maxconnrate
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +0100470 - maxcomprate
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +0100471 - maxcompcpuusage
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100472 - maxpipes
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +0200473 - maxsessrate
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +0200474 - maxsslconn
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +0200475 - maxsslrate
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200476 - noepoll
477 - nokqueue
478 - nopoll
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100479 - nosplice
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300480 - nogetaddrinfo
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200481 - spread-checks
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200482 - tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +0200483 - tune.chksize
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +0100484 - tune.comp.maxlevel
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +0100485 - tune.http.cookielen
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +0200486 - tune.http.maxhdr
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +0100487 - tune.idletimer
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100488 - tune.maxaccept
489 - tune.maxpollevents
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200490 - tune.maxrewrite
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +0200491 - tune.pipesize
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100492 - tune.rcvbuf.client
493 - tune.rcvbuf.server
494 - tune.sndbuf.client
495 - tune.sndbuf.server
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +0100496 - tune.ssl.cachesize
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100497 - tune.ssl.lifetime
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +0200498 - tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100499 - tune.ssl.maxrecord
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +0100500 - tune.zlib.memlevel
501 - tune.zlib.windowsize
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100502
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200503 * Debugging
504 - debug
505 - quiet
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200506
507
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005083.1. Process management and security
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200509------------------------------------
510
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200511ca-base <dir>
512 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL CA certificates and CRLs from when a
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +0200513 relative path is used with "ca-file" or "crl-file" directives. Absolute
514 locations specified in "ca-file" and "crl-file" prevail and ignore "ca-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200515
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200516chroot <jail dir>
517 Changes current directory to <jail dir> and performs a chroot() there before
518 dropping privileges. This increases the security level in case an unknown
519 vulnerability would be exploited, since it would make it very hard for the
520 attacker to exploit the system. This only works when the process is started
521 with superuser privileges. It is important to ensure that <jail_dir> is both
522 empty and unwritable to anyone.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100523
Willy Tarreaufc6c0322012-11-16 16:12:27 +0100524cpu-map <"all"|"odd"|"even"|process_num> <cpu-set>...
525 On Linux 2.6 and above, it is possible to bind a process to a specific CPU
526 set. This means that the process will never run on other CPUs. The "cpu-map"
527 directive specifies CPU sets for process sets. The first argument is the
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +0100528 process number to bind. This process must have a number between 1 and 32 or
529 64, depending on the machine's word size, and any process IDs above nbproc
530 are ignored. It is possible to specify all processes at once using "all",
531 only odd numbers using "odd" or even numbers using "even", just like with the
532 "bind-process" directive. The second and forthcoming arguments are CPU sets.
533 Each CPU set is either a unique number between 0 and 31 or 63 or a range with
534 two such numbers delimited by a dash ('-'). Multiple CPU numbers or ranges
535 may be specified, and the processes will be allowed to bind to all of them.
536 Obviously, multiple "cpu-map" directives may be specified. Each "cpu-map"
537 directive will replace the previous ones when they overlap.
Willy Tarreaufc6c0322012-11-16 16:12:27 +0100538
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200539crt-base <dir>
540 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL certificates from when a relative
541 path is used with "crtfile" directives. Absolute locations specified after
542 "crtfile" prevail and ignore "crt-base".
543
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200544daemon
545 Makes the process fork into background. This is the recommended mode of
546 operation. It is equivalent to the command line "-D" argument. It can be
547 disabled by the command line "-db" argument.
548
549gid <number>
550 Changes the process' group ID to <number>. It is recommended that the group
551 ID is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
552 be started with a user belonging to this group, or with superuser privileges.
Michael Schererab012dd2013-01-12 18:35:19 +0100553 Note that if haproxy is started from a user having supplementary groups, it
554 will only be able to drop these groups if started with superuser privileges.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200555 See also "group" and "uid".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100556
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200557group <group name>
558 Similar to "gid" but uses the GID of group name <group name> from /etc/group.
559 See also "gid" and "user".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100560
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +0200561log <address> <facility> [max level [min level]]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200562 Adds a global syslog server. Up to two global servers can be defined. They
563 will receive logs for startups and exits, as well as all logs from proxies
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100564 configured with "log global".
565
566 <address> can be one of:
567
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +0100568 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon and a UDP port. If
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100569 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
570 port).
571
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +0100572 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon and optionally a UDP port. If
573 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
574 port).
575
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100576 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
577 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible inside
578 the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is appropriately
579 writeable).
580
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +0100581 Any part of the address string may reference any number of environment
582 variables by preceding their name with a dollar sign ('$') and
583 optionally enclosing them with braces ('{}'), similarly to what is done
584 in Bourne shell.
585
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100586 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200587
588 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
589 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
590 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
591
592 An optional level can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By default,
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +0200593 all messages are sent. If a maximum level is specified, only messages with a
594 severity at least as important as this level will be sent. An optional minimum
595 level can be specified. If it is set, logs emitted with a more severe level
596 than this one will be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending
597 "emerg" messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
598 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200599
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200600 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200601
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100602log-send-hostname [<string>]
603 Sets the hostname field in the syslog header. If optional "string" parameter
604 is set the header is set to the string contents, otherwise uses the hostname
605 of the system. Generally used if one is not relaying logs through an
606 intermediate syslog server or for simply customizing the hostname printed in
607 the logs.
608
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +0000609log-tag <string>
610 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
611 program name as launched from the command line, which usually is "haproxy".
612 Sometimes it can be useful to differentiate between multiple processes
613 running on the same host.
614
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200615nbproc <number>
616 Creates <number> processes when going daemon. This requires the "daemon"
617 mode. By default, only one process is created, which is the recommended mode
618 of operation. For systems limited to small sets of file descriptors per
619 process, it may be needed to fork multiple daemons. USING MULTIPLE PROCESSES
620 IS HARDER TO DEBUG AND IS REALLY DISCOURAGED. See also "daemon".
621
622pidfile <pidfile>
623 Writes pids of all daemons into file <pidfile>. This option is equivalent to
624 the "-p" command line argument. The file must be accessible to the user
625 starting the process. See also "daemon".
626
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +0100627stats bind-process [ all | odd | even | <number 1-64>[-<number 1-64>] ] ...
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +0200628 Limits the stats socket to a certain set of processes numbers. By default the
629 stats socket is bound to all processes, causing a warning to be emitted when
630 nbproc is greater than 1 because there is no way to select the target process
631 when connecting. However, by using this setting, it becomes possible to pin
632 the stats socket to a specific set of processes, typically the first one. The
633 warning will automatically be disabled when this setting is used, whatever
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +0100634 the number of processes used. The maximum process ID depends on the machine's
Willy Tarreauae302532014-05-07 19:22:24 +0200635 word size (32 or 64). A better option consists in using the "process" setting
636 of the "stats socket" line to force the process on each line.
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +0200637
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +0100638ssl-default-bind-ciphers <ciphers>
639 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
640 the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite")
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300641 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake for all "bind" lines which
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +0100642 do not explicitly define theirs. The format of the string is defined in
643 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages, and can be for instance a string such
644 as "AES:ALL:!aNULL:!eNULL:+RC4:@STRENGTH" (without quotes). Please check the
645 "bind" keyword for more information.
646
647ssl-default-server-ciphers <ciphers>
648 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
649 sets the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300650 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with the server, for all "server"
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +0100651 lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of the string is
652 defined in "man 1 ciphers". Please check the "server" keyword for more
653 information.
654
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +0100655ssl-server-verify [none|required]
656 The default behavior for SSL verify on servers side. If specified to 'none',
657 servers certificates are not verified. The default is 'required' except if
658 forced using cmdline option '-dV'.
659
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +0200660stats socket [<address:port>|<path>] [param*]
661 Binds a UNIX socket to <path> or a TCPv4/v6 address to <address:port>.
662 Connections to this socket will return various statistics outputs and even
663 allow some commands to be issued to change some runtime settings. Please
664 consult section 9.2 "Unix Socket commands" for more details.
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +0200665
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +0200666 All parameters supported by "bind" lines are supported, for instance to
667 restrict access to some users or their access rights. Please consult
668 section 5.1 for more information.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200669
670stats timeout <timeout, in milliseconds>
671 The default timeout on the stats socket is set to 10 seconds. It is possible
672 to change this value with "stats timeout". The value must be passed in
Willy Tarreaubefdff12007-12-02 22:27:38 +0100673 milliseconds, or be suffixed by a time unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200674
675stats maxconn <connections>
676 By default, the stats socket is limited to 10 concurrent connections. It is
677 possible to change this value with "stats maxconn".
678
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200679uid <number>
680 Changes the process' user ID to <number>. It is recommended that the user ID
681 is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
682 be started with superuser privileges in order to be able to switch to another
683 one. See also "gid" and "user".
684
685ulimit-n <number>
686 Sets the maximum number of per-process file-descriptors to <number>. By
687 default, it is automatically computed, so it is recommended not to use this
688 option.
689
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100690unix-bind [ prefix <prefix> ] [ mode <mode> ] [ user <user> ] [ uid <uid> ]
691 [ group <group> ] [ gid <gid> ]
692
693 Fixes common settings to UNIX listening sockets declared in "bind" statements.
694 This is mainly used to simplify declaration of those UNIX sockets and reduce
695 the risk of errors, since those settings are most commonly required but are
696 also process-specific. The <prefix> setting can be used to force all socket
697 path to be relative to that directory. This might be needed to access another
698 component's chroot. Note that those paths are resolved before haproxy chroots
699 itself, so they are absolute. The <mode>, <user>, <uid>, <group> and <gid>
700 all have the same meaning as their homonyms used by the "bind" statement. If
701 both are specified, the "bind" statement has priority, meaning that the
702 "unix-bind" settings may be seen as process-wide default settings.
703
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200704user <user name>
705 Similar to "uid" but uses the UID of user name <user name> from /etc/passwd.
706 See also "uid" and "group".
707
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +0200708node <name>
709 Only letters, digits, hyphen and underscore are allowed, like in DNS names.
710
711 This statement is useful in HA configurations where two or more processes or
712 servers share the same IP address. By setting a different node-name on all
713 nodes, it becomes easy to immediately spot what server is handling the
714 traffic.
715
716description <text>
717 Add a text that describes the instance.
718
719 Please note that it is required to escape certain characters (# for example)
720 and this text is inserted into a html page so you should avoid using
721 "<" and ">" characters.
722
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200723
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007243.2. Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200725-----------------------
726
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +0200727max-spread-checks <delay in milliseconds>
728 By default, haproxy tries to spread the start of health checks across the
729 smallest health check interval of all the servers in a farm. The principle is
730 to avoid hammering services running on the same server. But when using large
731 check intervals (10 seconds or more), the last servers in the farm take some
732 time before starting to be tested, which can be a problem. This parameter is
733 used to enforce an upper bound on delay between the first and the last check,
734 even if the servers' check intervals are larger. When servers run with
735 shorter intervals, their intervals will be respected though.
736
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200737maxconn <number>
738 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent connections to <number>. It
739 is equivalent to the command-line argument "-n". Proxies will stop accepting
740 connections when this limit is reached. The "ulimit-n" parameter is
741 automatically adjusted according to this value. See also "ulimit-n".
742
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +0200743maxconnrate <number>
744 Sets the maximum per-process number of connections per second to <number>.
745 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
746 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
747 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
748 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
749 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
750 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
751 fairness.
752
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +0100753maxcomprate <number>
754 Sets the maximum per-process input compression rate to <number> kilobytes
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300755 per second. For each session, if the maximum is reached, the compression
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +0100756 level will be decreased during the session. If the maximum is reached at the
757 beginning of a session, the session will not compress at all. If the maximum
758 is not reached, the compression level will be increased up to
759 tune.comp.maxlevel. A value of zero means there is no limit, this is the
760 default value.
761
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +0100762maxcompcpuusage <number>
763 Sets the maximum CPU usage HAProxy can reach before stopping the compression
764 for new requests or decreasing the compression level of current requests.
765 It works like 'maxcomprate' but measures CPU usage instead of incoming data
766 bandwidth. The value is expressed in percent of the CPU used by haproxy. In
767 case of multiple processes (nbproc > 1), each process manages its individual
768 usage. A value of 100 disable the limit. The default value is 100. Setting
769 a lower value will prevent the compression work from slowing the whole
770 process down and from introducing high latencies.
771
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100772maxpipes <number>
773 Sets the maximum per-process number of pipes to <number>. Currently, pipes
774 are only used by kernel-based tcp splicing. Since a pipe contains two file
775 descriptors, the "ulimit-n" value will be increased accordingly. The default
776 value is maxconn/4, which seems to be more than enough for most heavy usages.
777 The splice code dynamically allocates and releases pipes, and can fall back
778 to standard copy, so setting this value too low may only impact performance.
779
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +0200780maxsessrate <number>
781 Sets the maximum per-process number of sessions per second to <number>.
782 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
783 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
784 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
785 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
786 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
787 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
788 fairness.
789
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +0200790maxsslconn <number>
791 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent SSL connections to
792 <number>. By default there is no SSL-specific limit, which means that the
793 global maxconn setting will apply to all connections. Setting this limit
794 avoids having openssl use too much memory and crash when malloc returns NULL
795 (since it unfortunately does not reliably check for such conditions). Note
796 that the limit applies both to incoming and outgoing connections, so one
797 connection which is deciphered then ciphered accounts for 2 SSL connections.
798
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +0200799maxsslrate <number>
800 Sets the maximum per-process number of SSL sessions per second to <number>.
801 SSL listeners will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It
802 can be used to limit the global SSL CPU usage regardless of each frontend
803 capacity. It is important to note that this can only be used as a service
804 protection measure, as there will not necessarily be a fair share between
805 frontends when the limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each
806 frontend to some value close to its expected share. It is also important to
807 note that the sessions are accounted before they enter the SSL stack and not
808 after, which also protects the stack against bad handshakes. Also, lowering
809 tune.maxaccept can improve fairness.
810
William Lallemand9d5f5482012-11-07 16:12:57 +0100811maxzlibmem <number>
812 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by the zlib.
813 When the maximum amount is reached, future sessions will not compress as long
814 as RAM is unavailable. When sets to 0, there is no limit.
William Lallemande3a7d992012-11-20 11:25:20 +0100815 The default value is 0. The value is available in bytes on the UNIX socket
816 with "show info" on the line "MaxZlibMemUsage", the memory used by zlib is
817 "ZlibMemUsage" in bytes.
818
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200819noepoll
820 Disables the use of the "epoll" event polling system on Linux. It is
821 equivalent to the command-line argument "-de". The next polling system
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +0100822 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200823
824nokqueue
825 Disables the use of the "kqueue" event polling system on BSD. It is
826 equivalent to the command-line argument "-dk". The next polling system
827 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
828
829nopoll
830 Disables the use of the "poll" event polling system. It is equivalent to the
831 command-line argument "-dp". The next polling system used will be "select".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100832 It should never be needed to disable "poll" since it's available on all
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +0100833 platforms supported by HAProxy. See also "nokqueue" and "noepoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200834
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100835nosplice
836 Disables the use of kernel tcp splicing between sockets on Linux. It is
837 equivalent to the command line argument "-dS". Data will then be copied
838 using conventional and more portable recv/send calls. Kernel tcp splicing is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100839 limited to some very recent instances of kernel 2.6. Most versions between
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100840 2.6.25 and 2.6.28 are buggy and will forward corrupted data, so they must not
841 be used. This option makes it easier to globally disable kernel splicing in
842 case of doubt. See also "option splice-auto", "option splice-request" and
843 "option splice-response".
844
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300845nogetaddrinfo
846 Disables the use of getaddrinfo(3) for name resolving. It is equivalent to
847 the command line argument "-dG". Deprecated gethostbyname(3) will be used.
848
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200849spread-checks <0..50, in percent>
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +0900850 Sometimes it is desirable to avoid sending agent and health checks to
851 servers at exact intervals, for instance when many logical servers are
852 located on the same physical server. With the help of this parameter, it
853 becomes possible to add some randomness in the check interval between 0
854 and +/- 50%. A value between 2 and 5 seems to show good results. The
855 default value remains at 0.
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200856
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200857tune.bufsize <number>
858 Sets the buffer size to this size (in bytes). Lower values allow more
859 sessions to coexist in the same amount of RAM, and higher values allow some
860 applications with very large cookies to work. The default value is 16384 and
861 can be changed at build time. It is strongly recommended not to change this
862 from the default value, as very low values will break some services such as
863 statistics, and values larger than default size will increase memory usage,
864 possibly causing the system to run out of memory. At least the global maxconn
865 parameter should be decreased by the same factor as this one is increased.
Dmitry Sivachenkof6f4f7b2012-10-21 18:10:25 +0400866 If HTTP request is larger than (tune.bufsize - tune.maxrewrite), haproxy will
867 return HTTP 400 (Bad Request) error. Similarly if an HTTP response is larger
868 than this size, haproxy will return HTTP 502 (Bad Gateway).
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200869
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +0200870tune.chksize <number>
871 Sets the check buffer size to this size (in bytes). Higher values may help
872 find string or regex patterns in very large pages, though doing so may imply
873 more memory and CPU usage. The default value is 16384 and can be changed at
874 build time. It is not recommended to change this value, but to use better
875 checks whenever possible.
876
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +0100877tune.comp.maxlevel <number>
878 Sets the maximum compression level. The compression level affects CPU
879 usage during compression. This value affects CPU usage during compression.
880 Each session using compression initializes the compression algorithm with
881 this value. The default value is 1.
882
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +0100883tune.http.cookielen <number>
884 Sets the maximum length of captured cookies. This is the maximum value that
885 the "capture cookie xxx len yyy" will be allowed to take, and any upper value
886 will automatically be truncated to this one. It is important not to set too
887 high a value because all cookie captures still allocate this size whatever
888 their configured value (they share a same pool). This value is per request
889 per response, so the memory allocated is twice this value per connection.
890 When not specified, the limit is set to 63 characters. It is recommended not
891 to change this value.
892
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +0200893tune.http.maxhdr <number>
894 Sets the maximum number of headers in a request. When a request comes with a
895 number of headers greater than this value (including the first line), it is
896 rejected with a "400 Bad Request" status code. Similarly, too large responses
897 are blocked with "502 Bad Gateway". The default value is 101, which is enough
898 for all usages, considering that the widely deployed Apache server uses the
899 same limit. It can be useful to push this limit further to temporarily allow
900 a buggy application to work by the time it gets fixed. Keep in mind that each
901 new header consumes 32bits of memory for each session, so don't push this
902 limit too high.
903
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +0100904tune.idletimer <timeout>
905 Sets the duration after which haproxy will consider that an empty buffer is
906 probably associated with an idle stream. This is used to optimally adjust
907 some packet sizes while forwarding large and small data alternatively. The
908 decision to use splice() or to send large buffers in SSL is modulated by this
909 parameter. The value is in milliseconds between 0 and 65535. A value of zero
910 means that haproxy will not try to detect idle streams. The default is 1000,
911 which seems to correctly detect end user pauses (eg: read a page before
912 clicking). There should be not reason for changing this value. Please check
913 tune.ssl.maxrecord below.
914
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100915tune.maxaccept <number>
Willy Tarreau16a21472012-11-19 12:39:59 +0100916 Sets the maximum number of consecutive connections a process may accept in a
917 row before switching to other work. In single process mode, higher numbers
918 give better performance at high connection rates. However in multi-process
919 modes, keeping a bit of fairness between processes generally is better to
920 increase performance. This value applies individually to each listener, so
921 that the number of processes a listener is bound to is taken into account.
922 This value defaults to 64. In multi-process mode, it is divided by twice
923 the number of processes the listener is bound to. Setting this value to -1
924 completely disables the limitation. It should normally not be needed to tweak
925 this value.
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100926
927tune.maxpollevents <number>
928 Sets the maximum amount of events that can be processed at once in a call to
929 the polling system. The default value is adapted to the operating system. It
930 has been noticed that reducing it below 200 tends to slightly decrease
931 latency at the expense of network bandwidth, and increasing it above 200
932 tends to trade latency for slightly increased bandwidth.
933
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200934tune.maxrewrite <number>
935 Sets the reserved buffer space to this size in bytes. The reserved space is
936 used for header rewriting or appending. The first reads on sockets will never
937 fill more than bufsize-maxrewrite. Historically it has defaulted to half of
938 bufsize, though that does not make much sense since there are rarely large
939 numbers of headers to add. Setting it too high prevents processing of large
940 requests or responses. Setting it too low prevents addition of new headers
941 to already large requests or to POST requests. It is generally wise to set it
942 to about 1024. It is automatically readjusted to half of bufsize if it is
943 larger than that. This means you don't have to worry about it when changing
944 bufsize.
945
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +0200946tune.pipesize <number>
947 Sets the kernel pipe buffer size to this size (in bytes). By default, pipes
948 are the default size for the system. But sometimes when using TCP splicing,
949 it can improve performance to increase pipe sizes, especially if it is
950 suspected that pipes are not filled and that many calls to splice() are
951 performed. This has an impact on the kernel's memory footprint, so this must
952 not be changed if impacts are not understood.
953
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100954tune.rcvbuf.client <number>
955tune.rcvbuf.server <number>
956 Forces the kernel socket receive buffer size on the client or the server side
957 to the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
958 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
959 the kernel autotune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
960 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (eg: 4096) in
961 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
962 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
963
964tune.sndbuf.client <number>
965tune.sndbuf.server <number>
966 Forces the kernel socket send buffer size on the client or the server side to
967 the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
968 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
969 the kernel autotune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
970 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (eg: 4096) in
971 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
972 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
973 Another use case is to prevent write timeouts with extremely slow clients due
974 to the kernel waiting for a large part of the buffer to be read before
975 notifying haproxy again.
976
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +0100977tune.ssl.cachesize <number>
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +0100978 Sets the size of the global SSL session cache, in a number of blocks. A block
979 is large enough to contain an encoded session without peer certificate.
980 An encoded session with peer certificate is stored in multiple blocks
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300981 depending on the size of the peer certificate. A block uses approximately
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +0100982 200 bytes of memory. The default value may be forced at build time, otherwise
983 defaults to 20000. When the cache is full, the most idle entries are purged
984 and reassigned. Higher values reduce the occurrence of such a purge, hence
985 the number of CPU-intensive SSL handshakes by ensuring that all users keep
986 their session as long as possible. All entries are pre-allocated upon startup
Emeric Brun22890a12012-12-28 14:41:32 +0100987 and are shared between all processes if "nbproc" is greater than 1. Setting
988 this value to 0 disables the SSL session cache.
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +0100989
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +0200990tune.ssl.force-private-cache
991 This boolean disables SSL session cache sharing between all processes. It
992 should normally not be used since it will force many renegotiations due to
993 clients hitting a random process. But it may be required on some operating
994 systems where none of the SSL cache synchronization method may be used. In
995 this case, adding a first layer of hash-based load balancing before the SSL
996 layer might limit the impact of the lack of session sharing.
997
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +0100998tune.ssl.lifetime <timeout>
999 Sets how long a cached SSL session may remain valid. This time is expressed
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001000 in seconds and defaults to 300 (5 min). It is important to understand that it
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01001001 does not guarantee that sessions will last that long, because if the cache is
1002 full, the longest idle sessions will be purged despite their configured
1003 lifetime. The real usefulness of this setting is to prevent sessions from
1004 being used for too long.
1005
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01001006tune.ssl.maxrecord <number>
1007 Sets the maximum amount of bytes passed to SSL_write() at a time. Default
1008 value 0 means there is no limit. Over SSL/TLS, the client can decipher the
1009 data only once it has received a full record. With large records, it means
1010 that clients might have to download up to 16kB of data before starting to
1011 process them. Limiting the value can improve page load times on browsers
1012 located over high latency or low bandwidth networks. It is suggested to find
1013 optimal values which fit into 1 or 2 TCP segments (generally 1448 bytes over
1014 Ethernet with TCP timestamps enabled, or 1460 when timestamps are disabled),
1015 keeping in mind that SSL/TLS add some overhead. Typical values of 1419 and
1016 2859 gave good results during tests. Use "strace -e trace=write" to find the
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001017 best value. Haproxy will automatically switch to this setting after an idle
1018 stream has been detected (see tune.idletimer above).
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01001019
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01001020tune.zlib.memlevel <number>
1021 Sets the memLevel parameter in zlib initialization for each session. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001022 defines how much memory should be allocated for the internal compression
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01001023 state. A value of 1 uses minimum memory but is slow and reduces compression
1024 ratio, a value of 9 uses maximum memory for optimal speed. Can be a value
1025 between 1 and 9. The default value is 8.
1026
1027tune.zlib.windowsize <number>
1028 Sets the window size (the size of the history buffer) as a parameter of the
1029 zlib initialization for each session. Larger values of this parameter result
1030 in better compression at the expense of memory usage. Can be a value between
1031 8 and 15. The default value is 15.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001032
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010333.3. Debugging
1034--------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001035
1036debug
1037 Enables debug mode which dumps to stdout all exchanges, and disables forking
1038 into background. It is the equivalent of the command-line argument "-d". It
1039 should never be used in a production configuration since it may prevent full
1040 system startup.
1041
1042quiet
1043 Do not display any message during startup. It is equivalent to the command-
1044 line argument "-q".
1045
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001046
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010010473.4. Userlists
1048--------------
1049It is possible to control access to frontend/backend/listen sections or to
1050http stats by allowing only authenticated and authorized users. To do this,
1051it is required to create at least one userlist and to define users.
1052
1053userlist <listname>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01001054 Creates new userlist with name <listname>. Many independent userlists can be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001055 used to store authentication & authorization data for independent customers.
1056
1057group <groupname> [users <user>,<user>,(...)]
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01001058 Adds group <groupname> to the current userlist. It is also possible to
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001059 attach users to this group by using a comma separated list of names
1060 proceeded by "users" keyword.
1061
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001062user <username> [password|insecure-password <password>]
1063 [groups <group>,<group>,(...)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001064 Adds user <username> to the current userlist. Both secure (encrypted) and
1065 insecure (unencrypted) passwords can be used. Encrypted passwords are
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01001066 evaluated using the crypt(3) function so depending of the system's
1067 capabilities, different algorithms are supported. For example modern Glibc
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001068 based Linux system supports MD5, SHA-256, SHA-512 and of course classic,
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001069 DES-based method of encrypting passwords.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001070
1071
1072 Example:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001073 userlist L1
1074 group G1 users tiger,scott
1075 group G2 users xdb,scott
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001076
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001077 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx9za9667qe4(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91
1078 user scott insecure-password elgato
1079 user xdb insecure-password hello
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001080
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001081 userlist L2
1082 group G1
1083 group G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001084
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001085 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91 groups G1
1086 user scott insecure-password elgato groups G1,G2
1087 user xdb insecure-password hello groups G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001088
1089 Please note that both lists are functionally identical.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001090
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001091
10923.5. Peers
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001093----------
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001094It is possible to synchronize server entries in stick tables between several
1095haproxy instances over TCP connections in a multi-master fashion. Each instance
1096pushes its local updates and insertions to remote peers. Server IDs are used to
1097identify servers remotely, so it is important that configurations look similar
1098or at least that the same IDs are forced on each server on all participants.
1099Interrupted exchanges are automatically detected and recovered from the last
1100known point. In addition, during a soft restart, the old process connects to
1101the new one using such a TCP connection to push all its entries before the new
1102process tries to connect to other peers. That ensures very fast replication
1103during a reload, it typically takes a fraction of a second even for large
1104tables.
1105
1106peers <peersect>
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04001107 Creates a new peer list with name <peersect>. It is an independent section,
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001108 which is referenced by one or more stick-tables.
1109
1110peer <peername> <ip>:<port>
1111 Defines a peer inside a peers section.
1112 If <peername> is set to the local peer name (by default hostname, or forced
1113 using "-L" command line option), haproxy will listen for incoming remote peer
1114 connection on <ip>:<port>. Otherwise, <ip>:<port> defines where to connect to
1115 to join the remote peer, and <peername> is used at the protocol level to
1116 identify and validate the remote peer on the server side.
1117
1118 During a soft restart, local peer <ip>:<port> is used by the old instance to
1119 connect the new one and initiate a complete replication (teaching process).
1120
1121 It is strongly recommended to have the exact same peers declaration on all
1122 peers and to only rely on the "-L" command line argument to change the local
1123 peer name. This makes it easier to maintain coherent configuration files
1124 across all peers.
1125
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01001126 Any part of the address string may reference any number of environment
1127 variables by preceding their name with a dollar sign ('$') and optionally
1128 enclosing them with braces ('{}'), similarly to what is done in Bourne shell.
1129
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001130 Example:
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001131 peers mypeers
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01001132 peer haproxy1 192.168.0.1:1024
1133 peer haproxy2 192.168.0.2:1024
1134 peer haproxy3 10.2.0.1:1024
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001135
1136 backend mybackend
1137 mode tcp
1138 balance roundrobin
1139 stick-table type ip size 20k peers mypeers
1140 stick on src
1141
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01001142 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
1143 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001144
1145
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011464. Proxies
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001147----------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001148
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001149Proxy configuration can be located in a set of sections :
1150 - defaults <name>
1151 - frontend <name>
1152 - backend <name>
1153 - listen <name>
1154
1155A "defaults" section sets default parameters for all other sections following
1156its declaration. Those default parameters are reset by the next "defaults"
1157section. See below for the list of parameters which can be set in a "defaults"
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001158section. The name is optional but its use is encouraged for better readability.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001159
1160A "frontend" section describes a set of listening sockets accepting client
1161connections.
1162
1163A "backend" section describes a set of servers to which the proxy will connect
1164to forward incoming connections.
1165
1166A "listen" section defines a complete proxy with its frontend and backend
1167parts combined in one section. It is generally useful for TCP-only traffic.
1168
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001169All proxy names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits,
1170'-' (dash), '_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are
1171case-sensitive, which means that "www" and "WWW" are two different proxies.
1172
1173Historically, all proxy names could overlap, it just caused troubles in the
1174logs. Since the introduction of content switching, it is mandatory that two
1175proxies with overlapping capabilities (frontend/backend) have different names.
1176However, it is still permitted that a frontend and a backend share the same
1177name, as this configuration seems to be commonly encountered.
1178
1179Right now, two major proxy modes are supported : "tcp", also known as layer 4,
1180and "http", also known as layer 7. In layer 4 mode, HAProxy simply forwards
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001181bidirectional traffic between two sides. In layer 7 mode, HAProxy analyzes the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001182protocol, and can interact with it by allowing, blocking, switching, adding,
1183modifying, or removing arbitrary contents in requests or responses, based on
1184arbitrary criteria.
1185
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01001186In HTTP mode, the processing applied to requests and responses flowing over
1187a connection depends in the combination of the frontend's HTTP options and
1188the backend's. HAProxy supports 5 connection modes :
1189
1190 - KAL : keep alive ("option http-keep-alive") which is the default mode : all
1191 requests and responses are processed, and connections remain open but idle
1192 between responses and new requests.
1193
1194 - TUN: tunnel ("option http-tunnel") : this was the default mode for versions
1195 1.0 to 1.5-dev21 : only the first request and response are processed, and
1196 everything else is forwarded with no analysis at all. This mode should not
1197 be used as it creates lots of trouble with logging and HTTP processing.
1198
1199 - PCL: passive close ("option httpclose") : exactly the same as tunnel mode,
1200 but with "Connection: close" appended in both directions to try to make
1201 both ends close after the first request/response exchange.
1202
1203 - SCL: server close ("option http-server-close") : the server-facing
1204 connection is closed after the end of the response is received, but the
1205 client-facing connection remains open.
1206
1207 - FCL: forced close ("option forceclose") : the connection is actively closed
1208 after the end of the response.
1209
1210The effective mode that will be applied to a connection passing through a
1211frontend and a backend can be determined by both proxy modes according to the
1212following matrix, but in short, the modes are symmetric, keep-alive is the
1213weakest option and force close is the strongest.
1214
1215 Backend mode
1216
1217 | KAL | TUN | PCL | SCL | FCL
1218 ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1219 KAL | KAL | TUN | PCL | SCL | FCL
1220 ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1221 TUN | TUN | TUN | PCL | SCL | FCL
1222 Frontend ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1223 mode PCL | PCL | PCL | PCL | FCL | FCL
1224 ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1225 SCL | SCL | SCL | FCL | SCL | FCL
1226 ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1227 FCL | FCL | FCL | FCL | FCL | FCL
1228
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001229
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01001230
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012314.1. Proxy keywords matrix
1232--------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001233
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001234The following list of keywords is supported. Most of them may only be used in a
1235limited set of section types. Some of them are marked as "deprecated" because
1236they are inherited from an old syntax which may be confusing or functionally
1237limited, and there are new recommended keywords to replace them. Keywords
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001238marked with "(*)" can be optionally inverted using the "no" prefix, eg. "no
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001239option contstats". This makes sense when the option has been enabled by default
Willy Tarreau3842f002009-06-14 11:39:52 +02001240and must be disabled for a specific instance. Such options may also be prefixed
1241with "default" in order to restore default settings regardless of what has been
1242specified in a previous "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001243
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001244
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001245 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
1246------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
1247acl - X X X
1248appsession - - X X
1249backlog X X X -
1250balance X - X X
1251bind - X X -
1252bind-process X X X X
1253block - X X X
1254capture cookie - X X -
1255capture request header - X X -
1256capture response header - X X -
1257clitimeout (deprecated) X X X -
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02001258compression X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001259contimeout (deprecated) X - X X
1260cookie X - X X
1261default-server X - X X
1262default_backend X X X -
1263description - X X X
1264disabled X X X X
1265dispatch - - X X
1266enabled X X X X
1267errorfile X X X X
1268errorloc X X X X
1269errorloc302 X X X X
1270-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1271errorloc303 X X X X
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02001272force-persist - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001273fullconn X - X X
1274grace X X X X
1275hash-type X - X X
1276http-check disable-on-404 X - X X
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01001277http-check expect - - X X
Willy Tarreau7ab6aff2010-10-12 06:30:16 +02001278http-check send-state X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001279http-request - X X X
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02001280http-response - X X X
Baptiste Assmann2c42ef52013-10-09 21:57:02 +02001281http-send-name-header - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001282id - X X X
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02001283ignore-persist - X X X
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02001284log (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02001285max-keep-alive-queue X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001286maxconn X X X -
1287mode X X X X
1288monitor fail - X X -
1289monitor-net X X X -
1290monitor-uri X X X -
1291option abortonclose (*) X - X X
1292option accept-invalid-http-request (*) X X X -
1293option accept-invalid-http-response (*) X - X X
1294option allbackups (*) X - X X
1295option checkcache (*) X - X X
1296option clitcpka (*) X X X -
1297option contstats (*) X X X -
1298option dontlog-normal (*) X X X -
1299option dontlognull (*) X X X -
1300option forceclose (*) X X X X
1301-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1302option forwardfor X X X X
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01001303option http-keep-alive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02001304option http-no-delay (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02001305option http-pretend-keepalive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001306option http-server-close (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01001307option http-tunnel (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001308option http-use-proxy-header (*) X X X -
1309option httpchk X - X X
1310option httpclose (*) X X X X
1311option httplog X X X X
1312option http_proxy (*) X X X X
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04001313option independent-streams (*) X X X X
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02001314option ldap-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001315option log-health-checks (*) X - X X
1316option log-separate-errors (*) X X X -
1317option logasap (*) X X X -
1318option mysql-check X - X X
Rauf Kuliyev38b41562011-01-04 15:14:13 +01001319option pgsql-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001320option nolinger (*) X X X X
1321option originalto X X X X
1322option persist (*) X - X X
1323option redispatch (*) X - X X
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02001324option redis-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001325option smtpchk X - X X
1326option socket-stats (*) X X X -
1327option splice-auto (*) X X X X
1328option splice-request (*) X X X X
1329option splice-response (*) X X X X
1330option srvtcpka (*) X - X X
1331option ssl-hello-chk X - X X
1332-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01001333option tcp-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001334option tcp-smart-accept (*) X X X -
1335option tcp-smart-connect (*) X - X X
1336option tcpka X X X X
1337option tcplog X X X X
1338option transparent (*) X - X X
1339persist rdp-cookie X - X X
1340rate-limit sessions X X X -
1341redirect - X X X
1342redisp (deprecated) X - X X
1343redispatch (deprecated) X - X X
1344reqadd - X X X
1345reqallow - X X X
1346reqdel - X X X
1347reqdeny - X X X
1348reqiallow - X X X
1349reqidel - X X X
1350reqideny - X X X
1351reqipass - X X X
1352reqirep - X X X
1353reqisetbe - X X X
1354reqitarpit - X X X
1355reqpass - X X X
1356reqrep - X X X
1357-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1358reqsetbe - X X X
1359reqtarpit - X X X
1360retries X - X X
1361rspadd - X X X
1362rspdel - X X X
1363rspdeny - X X X
1364rspidel - X X X
1365rspideny - X X X
1366rspirep - X X X
1367rsprep - X X X
1368server - - X X
1369source X - X X
1370srvtimeout (deprecated) X - X X
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02001371stats admin - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001372stats auth X - X X
1373stats enable X - X X
1374stats hide-version X - X X
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02001375stats http-request - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001376stats realm X - X X
1377stats refresh X - X X
1378stats scope X - X X
1379stats show-desc X - X X
1380stats show-legends X - X X
1381stats show-node X - X X
1382stats uri X - X X
1383-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1384stick match - - X X
1385stick on - - X X
1386stick store-request - - X X
Willy Tarreaud8dc99f2011-07-01 11:33:25 +02001387stick store-response - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001388stick-table - - X X
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02001389tcp-check connect - - X X
1390tcp-check expect - - X X
1391tcp-check send - - X X
1392tcp-check send-binary - - X X
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02001393tcp-request connection - X X -
1394tcp-request content - X X X
Willy Tarreaua56235c2010-09-14 11:31:36 +02001395tcp-request inspect-delay - X X X
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02001396tcp-response content - - X X
1397tcp-response inspect-delay - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001398timeout check X - X X
1399timeout client X X X -
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02001400timeout client-fin X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001401timeout clitimeout (deprecated) X X X -
1402timeout connect X - X X
1403timeout contimeout (deprecated) X - X X
1404timeout http-keep-alive X X X X
1405timeout http-request X X X X
1406timeout queue X - X X
1407timeout server X - X X
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02001408timeout server-fin X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001409timeout srvtimeout (deprecated) X - X X
1410timeout tarpit X X X X
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02001411timeout tunnel X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001412transparent (deprecated) X - X X
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01001413unique-id-format X X X -
1414unique-id-header X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001415use_backend - X X -
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02001416use-server - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001417------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
1418 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001419
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001420
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014214.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
1422---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001423
1424This section provides a description of each keyword and its usage.
1425
1426
1427acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
1428 Declare or complete an access list.
1429 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1430 no | yes | yes | yes
1431 Example:
1432 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
1433 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
1434 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
1435
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001436 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001437
1438
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001439appsession <cookie> len <length> timeout <holdtime>
1440 [request-learn] [prefix] [mode <path-parameters|query-string>]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001441 Define session stickiness on an existing application cookie.
1442 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1443 no | no | yes | yes
1444 Arguments :
1445 <cookie> this is the name of the cookie used by the application and which
1446 HAProxy will have to learn for each new session.
1447
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001448 <length> this is the max number of characters that will be memorized and
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001449 checked in each cookie value.
1450
1451 <holdtime> this is the time after which the cookie will be removed from
1452 memory if unused. If no unit is specified, this time is in
1453 milliseconds.
1454
Cyril Bontébf47aeb2009-10-15 00:15:40 +02001455 request-learn
1456 If this option is specified, then haproxy will be able to learn
1457 the cookie found in the request in case the server does not
1458 specify any in response. This is typically what happens with
1459 PHPSESSID cookies, or when haproxy's session expires before
1460 the application's session and the correct server is selected.
1461 It is recommended to specify this option to improve reliability.
1462
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001463 prefix When this option is specified, haproxy will match on the cookie
1464 prefix (or URL parameter prefix). The appsession value is the
1465 data following this prefix.
1466
1467 Example :
1468 appsession ASPSESSIONID len 64 timeout 3h prefix
1469
1470 This will match the cookie ASPSESSIONIDXXXX=XXXXX,
1471 the appsession value will be XXXX=XXXXX.
1472
1473 mode This option allows to change the URL parser mode.
1474 2 modes are currently supported :
1475 - path-parameters :
1476 The parser looks for the appsession in the path parameters
1477 part (each parameter is separated by a semi-colon), which is
1478 convenient for JSESSIONID for example.
1479 This is the default mode if the option is not set.
1480 - query-string :
1481 In this mode, the parser will look for the appsession in the
1482 query string.
1483
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001484 When an application cookie is defined in a backend, HAProxy will check when
1485 the server sets such a cookie, and will store its value in a table, and
1486 associate it with the server's identifier. Up to <length> characters from
1487 the value will be retained. On each connection, haproxy will look for this
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01001488 cookie both in the "Cookie:" headers, and as a URL parameter (depending on
1489 the mode used). If a known value is found, the client will be directed to the
1490 server associated with this value. Otherwise, the load balancing algorithm is
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001491 applied. Cookies are automatically removed from memory when they have been
1492 unused for a duration longer than <holdtime>.
1493
1494 The definition of an application cookie is limited to one per backend.
1495
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01001496 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
1497 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
1498 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
1499
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001500 Example :
1501 appsession JSESSIONID len 52 timeout 3h
1502
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01001503 See also : "cookie", "capture cookie", "balance", "stick", "stick-table",
1504 "ignore-persist", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001505
1506
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01001507backlog <conns>
1508 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
1509 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1510 yes | yes | yes | no
1511 Arguments :
1512 <conns> is the number of pending connections. Depending on the operating
1513 system, it may represent the number of already acknowledged
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001514 connections, of non-acknowledged ones, or both.
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01001515
1516 In order to protect against SYN flood attacks, one solution is to increase
1517 the system's SYN backlog size. Depending on the system, sometimes it is just
1518 tunable via a system parameter, sometimes it is not adjustable at all, and
1519 sometimes the system relies on hints given by the application at the time of
1520 the listen() syscall. By default, HAProxy passes the frontend's maxconn value
1521 to the listen() syscall. On systems which can make use of this value, it can
1522 sometimes be useful to be able to specify a different value, hence this
1523 backlog parameter.
1524
1525 On Linux 2.4, the parameter is ignored by the system. On Linux 2.6, it is
1526 used as a hint and the system accepts up to the smallest greater power of
1527 two, and never more than some limits (usually 32768).
1528
1529 See also : "maxconn" and the target operating system's tuning guide.
1530
1531
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001532balance <algorithm> [ <arguments> ]
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02001533balance url_param <param> [check_post]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001534 Define the load balancing algorithm to be used in a backend.
1535 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1536 yes | no | yes | yes
1537 Arguments :
1538 <algorithm> is the algorithm used to select a server when doing load
1539 balancing. This only applies when no persistence information
1540 is available, or when a connection is redispatched to another
1541 server. <algorithm> may be one of the following :
1542
1543 roundrobin Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
1544 This is the smoothest and fairest algorithm when the server's
1545 processing time remains equally distributed. This algorithm
1546 is dynamic, which means that server weights may be adjusted
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02001547 on the fly for slow starts for instance. It is limited by
Godbacha34bdc02013-07-22 07:44:53 +08001548 design to 4095 active servers per backend. Note that in some
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02001549 large farms, when a server becomes up after having been down
1550 for a very short time, it may sometimes take a few hundreds
1551 requests for it to be re-integrated into the farm and start
1552 receiving traffic. This is normal, though very rare. It is
1553 indicated here in case you would have the chance to observe
1554 it, so that you don't worry.
1555
1556 static-rr Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
1557 This algorithm is as similar to roundrobin except that it is
1558 static, which means that changing a server's weight on the
1559 fly will have no effect. On the other hand, it has no design
1560 limitation on the number of servers, and when a server goes
1561 up, it is always immediately reintroduced into the farm, once
1562 the full map is recomputed. It also uses slightly less CPU to
1563 run (around -1%).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001564
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01001565 leastconn The server with the lowest number of connections receives the
1566 connection. Round-robin is performed within groups of servers
1567 of the same load to ensure that all servers will be used. Use
1568 of this algorithm is recommended where very long sessions are
1569 expected, such as LDAP, SQL, TSE, etc... but is not very well
1570 suited for protocols using short sessions such as HTTP. This
1571 algorithm is dynamic, which means that server weights may be
1572 adjusted on the fly for slow starts for instance.
1573
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01001574 first The first server with available connection slots receives the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001575 connection. The servers are chosen from the lowest numeric
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01001576 identifier to the highest (see server parameter "id"), which
1577 defaults to the server's position in the farm. Once a server
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02001578 reaches its maxconn value, the next server is used. It does
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01001579 not make sense to use this algorithm without setting maxconn.
1580 The purpose of this algorithm is to always use the smallest
1581 number of servers so that extra servers can be powered off
1582 during non-intensive hours. This algorithm ignores the server
1583 weight, and brings more benefit to long session such as RDP
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02001584 or IMAP than HTTP, though it can be useful there too. In
1585 order to use this algorithm efficiently, it is recommended
1586 that a cloud controller regularly checks server usage to turn
1587 them off when unused, and regularly checks backend queue to
1588 turn new servers on when the queue inflates. Alternatively,
1589 using "http-check send-state" may inform servers on the load.
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01001590
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001591 source The source IP address is hashed and divided by the total
1592 weight of the running servers to designate which server will
1593 receive the request. This ensures that the same client IP
1594 address will always reach the same server as long as no
1595 server goes down or up. If the hash result changes due to the
1596 number of running servers changing, many clients will be
1597 directed to a different server. This algorithm is generally
1598 used in TCP mode where no cookie may be inserted. It may also
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001599 be used on the Internet to provide a best-effort stickiness
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001600 to clients which refuse session cookies. This algorithm is
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001601 static by default, which means that changing a server's
1602 weight on the fly will have no effect, but this can be
1603 changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001604
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01001605 uri This algorithm hashes either the left part of the URI (before
1606 the question mark) or the whole URI (if the "whole" parameter
1607 is present) and divides the hash value by the total weight of
1608 the running servers. The result designates which server will
1609 receive the request. This ensures that the same URI will
1610 always be directed to the same server as long as no server
1611 goes up or down. This is used with proxy caches and
1612 anti-virus proxies in order to maximize the cache hit rate.
1613 Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP backend.
1614 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
1615 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
1616 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001617
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01001618 This algorithm supports two optional parameters "len" and
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02001619 "depth", both followed by a positive integer number. These
1620 options may be helpful when it is needed to balance servers
1621 based on the beginning of the URI only. The "len" parameter
1622 indicates that the algorithm should only consider that many
1623 characters at the beginning of the URI to compute the hash.
1624 Note that having "len" set to 1 rarely makes sense since most
1625 URIs start with a leading "/".
1626
1627 The "depth" parameter indicates the maximum directory depth
1628 to be used to compute the hash. One level is counted for each
1629 slash in the request. If both parameters are specified, the
1630 evaluation stops when either is reached.
1631
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001632 url_param The URL parameter specified in argument will be looked up in
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001633 the query string of each HTTP GET request.
1634
1635 If the modifier "check_post" is used, then an HTTP POST
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001636 request entity will be searched for the parameter argument,
1637 when it is not found in a query string after a question mark
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02001638 ('?') in the URL. The message body will only start to be
1639 analyzed once either the advertised amount of data has been
1640 received or the request buffer is full. In the unlikely event
1641 that chunked encoding is used, only the first chunk is
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001642 scanned. Parameter values separated by a chunk boundary, may
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02001643 be randomly balanced if at all. This keyword used to support
1644 an optional <max_wait> parameter which is now ignored.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001645
1646 If the parameter is found followed by an equal sign ('=') and
1647 a value, then the value is hashed and divided by the total
1648 weight of the running servers. The result designates which
1649 server will receive the request.
1650
1651 This is used to track user identifiers in requests and ensure
1652 that a same user ID will always be sent to the same server as
1653 long as no server goes up or down. If no value is found or if
1654 the parameter is not found, then a round robin algorithm is
1655 applied. Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001656 backend. This algorithm is static by default, which means
1657 that changing a server's weight on the fly will have no
1658 effect, but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001659
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001660 hdr(<name>) The HTTP header <name> will be looked up in each HTTP
1661 request. Just as with the equivalent ACL 'hdr()' function,
1662 the header name in parenthesis is not case sensitive. If the
1663 header is absent or if it does not contain any value, the
1664 roundrobin algorithm is applied instead.
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01001665
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001666 An optional 'use_domain_only' parameter is available, for
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01001667 reducing the hash algorithm to the main domain part with some
1668 specific headers such as 'Host'. For instance, in the Host
1669 value "haproxy.1wt.eu", only "1wt" will be considered.
1670
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001671 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
1672 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
1673 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
1674
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02001675 rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02001676 rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02001677 The RDP cookie <name> (or "mstshash" if omitted) will be
1678 looked up and hashed for each incoming TCP request. Just as
1679 with the equivalent ACL 'req_rdp_cookie()' function, the name
1680 is not case-sensitive. This mechanism is useful as a degraded
1681 persistence mode, as it makes it possible to always send the
1682 same user (or the same session ID) to the same server. If the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001683 cookie is not found, the normal roundrobin algorithm is
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02001684 used instead.
1685
1686 Note that for this to work, the frontend must ensure that an
1687 RDP cookie is already present in the request buffer. For this
1688 you must use 'tcp-request content accept' rule combined with
1689 a 'req_rdp_cookie_cnt' ACL.
1690
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001691 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
1692 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
1693 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
1694
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001695 See also the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09001696
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001697 <arguments> is an optional list of arguments which may be needed by some
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02001698 algorithms. Right now, only "url_param" and "uri" support an
1699 optional argument.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001700
Willy Tarreau3cd9af22009-03-15 14:06:41 +01001701 The load balancing algorithm of a backend is set to roundrobin when no other
1702 algorithm, mode nor option have been set. The algorithm may only be set once
1703 for each backend.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001704
1705 Examples :
1706 balance roundrobin
1707 balance url_param userid
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001708 balance url_param session_id check_post 64
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01001709 balance hdr(User-Agent)
1710 balance hdr(host)
1711 balance hdr(Host) use_domain_only
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001712
1713 Note: the following caveats and limitations on using the "check_post"
1714 extension with "url_param" must be considered :
1715
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001716 - all POST requests are eligible for consideration, because there is no way
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001717 to determine if the parameters will be found in the body or entity which
1718 may contain binary data. Therefore another method may be required to
1719 restrict consideration of POST requests that have no URL parameters in
1720 the body. (see acl reqideny http_end)
1721
1722 - using a <max_wait> value larger than the request buffer size does not
1723 make sense and is useless. The buffer size is set at build time, and
1724 defaults to 16 kB.
1725
1726 - Content-Encoding is not supported, the parameter search will probably
1727 fail; and load balancing will fall back to Round Robin.
1728
1729 - Expect: 100-continue is not supported, load balancing will fall back to
1730 Round Robin.
1731
1732 - Transfer-Encoding (RFC2616 3.6.1) is only supported in the first chunk.
1733 If the entire parameter value is not present in the first chunk, the
1734 selection of server is undefined (actually, defined by how little
1735 actually appeared in the first chunk).
1736
1737 - This feature does not support generation of a 100, 411 or 501 response.
1738
1739 - In some cases, requesting "check_post" MAY attempt to scan the entire
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001740 contents of a message body. Scanning normally terminates when linear
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02001741 white space or control characters are found, indicating the end of what
1742 might be a URL parameter list. This is probably not a concern with SGML
1743 type message bodies.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001744
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02001745 See also : "dispatch", "cookie", "appsession", "transparent", "hash-type" and
1746 "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001747
1748
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02001749bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
1750bind /<path> [, ...] [param*]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001751 Define one or several listening addresses and/or ports in a frontend.
1752 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1753 no | yes | yes | no
1754 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01001755 <address> is optional and can be a host name, an IPv4 address, an IPv6
1756 address, or '*'. It designates the address the frontend will
1757 listen on. If unset, all IPv4 addresses of the system will be
1758 listened on. The same will apply for '*' or the system's
David du Colombier9c938da2011-03-17 10:40:27 +01001759 special address "0.0.0.0". The IPv6 equivalent is '::'.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01001760 Optionally, an address family prefix may be used before the
1761 address to force the family regardless of the address format,
1762 which can be useful to specify a path to a unix socket with
1763 no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
1764 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
1765 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
1766 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02001767 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
Willy Tarreau40aa0702013-03-10 23:51:38 +01001768 - 'fd@<n>' -> use file descriptor <n> inherited from the
1769 parent. The fd must be bound and may or may not already
1770 be listening.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01001771 Any part of the address string may reference any number of
1772 environment variables by preceding their name with a dollar
1773 sign ('$') and optionally enclosing them with braces ('{}'),
1774 similarly to what is done in Bourne shell.
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01001775
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01001776 <port_range> is either a unique TCP port, or a port range for which the
1777 proxy will accept connections for the IP address specified
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001778 above. The port is mandatory for TCP listeners. Note that in
1779 the case of an IPv6 address, the port is always the number
1780 after the last colon (':'). A range can either be :
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01001781 - a numerical port (ex: '80')
1782 - a dash-delimited ports range explicitly stating the lower
1783 and upper bounds (ex: '2000-2100') which are included in
1784 the range.
1785
1786 Particular care must be taken against port ranges, because
1787 every <address:port> couple consumes one socket (= a file
1788 descriptor), so it's easy to consume lots of descriptors
1789 with a simple range, and to run out of sockets. Also, each
1790 <address:port> couple must be used only once among all
1791 instances running on a same system. Please note that binding
1792 to ports lower than 1024 generally require particular
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04001793 privileges to start the program, which are independent of
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01001794 the 'uid' parameter.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001795
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001796 <path> is a UNIX socket path beginning with a slash ('/'). This is
1797 alternative to the TCP listening port. Haproxy will then
1798 receive UNIX connections on the socket located at this place.
1799 The path must begin with a slash and by default is absolute.
1800 It can be relative to the prefix defined by "unix-bind" in
1801 the global section. Note that the total length of the prefix
1802 followed by the socket path cannot exceed some system limits
1803 for UNIX sockets, which commonly are set to 107 characters.
1804
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02001805 <param*> is a list of parameters common to all sockets declared on the
1806 same line. These numerous parameters depend on OS and build
1807 options and have a complete section dedicated to them. Please
1808 refer to section 5 to for more details.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02001809
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001810 It is possible to specify a list of address:port combinations delimited by
1811 commas. The frontend will then listen on all of these addresses. There is no
1812 fixed limit to the number of addresses and ports which can be listened on in
1813 a frontend, as well as there is no limit to the number of "bind" statements
1814 in a frontend.
1815
1816 Example :
1817 listen http_proxy
1818 bind :80,:443
1819 bind 10.0.0.1:10080,10.0.0.1:10443
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001820 bind /var/run/ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001821
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02001822 listen http_https_proxy
1823 bind :80
Cyril Bonté0d44fc62012-10-09 22:45:33 +02001824 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02001825
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01001826 listen http_https_proxy_explicit
1827 bind ipv6@:80
1828 bind ipv4@public_ssl:443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
1829 bind unix@ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
1830
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01001831 listen external_bind_app1
1832 bind fd@${FD_APP1}
1833
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001834 See also : "source", "option forwardfor", "unix-bind" and the PROXY protocol
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02001835 documentation, and section 5 about bind options.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001836
1837
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01001838bind-process [ all | odd | even | <number 1-64>[-<number 1-64>] ] ...
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001839 Limit visibility of an instance to a certain set of processes numbers.
1840 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1841 yes | yes | yes | yes
1842 Arguments :
1843 all All process will see this instance. This is the default. It
1844 may be used to override a default value.
1845
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01001846 odd This instance will be enabled on processes 1,3,5,...63. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001847 option may be combined with other numbers.
1848
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01001849 even This instance will be enabled on processes 2,4,6,...64. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001850 option may be combined with other numbers. Do not use it
1851 with less than 2 processes otherwise some instances might be
1852 missing from all processes.
1853
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01001854 number The instance will be enabled on this process number or range,
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01001855 whose values must all be between 1 and 32 or 64 depending on
Willy Tarreau102df612014-05-07 23:56:38 +02001856 the machine's word size. If a proxy is bound to process
1857 numbers greater than the configured global.nbproc, it will
1858 either be forced to process #1 if a single process was
1859 specified, or to all processes otherwise.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001860
1861 This keyword limits binding of certain instances to certain processes. This
1862 is useful in order not to have too many processes listening to the same
1863 ports. For instance, on a dual-core machine, it might make sense to set
1864 'nbproc 2' in the global section, then distributes the listeners among 'odd'
1865 and 'even' instances.
1866
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01001867 At the moment, it is not possible to reference more than 32 or 64 processes
1868 using this keyword, but this should be more than enough for most setups.
1869 Please note that 'all' really means all processes regardless of the machine's
1870 word size, and is not limited to the first 32 or 64.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001871
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02001872 Each "bind" line may further be limited to a subset of the proxy's processes,
1873 please consult the "process" bind keyword in section 5.1.
1874
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001875 If some backends are referenced by frontends bound to other processes, the
1876 backend automatically inherits the frontend's processes.
1877
1878 Example :
1879 listen app_ip1
1880 bind 10.0.0.1:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02001881 bind-process odd
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001882
1883 listen app_ip2
1884 bind 10.0.0.2:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02001885 bind-process even
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001886
1887 listen management
1888 bind 10.0.0.3:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02001889 bind-process 1 2 3 4
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001890
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01001891 listen management
1892 bind 10.0.0.4:80
1893 bind-process 1-4
1894
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02001895 See also : "nbproc" in global section, and "process" in section 5.1.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01001896
1897
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001898block { if | unless } <condition>
1899 Block a layer 7 request if/unless a condition is matched
1900 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1901 no | yes | yes | yes
1902
1903 The HTTP request will be blocked very early in the layer 7 processing
1904 if/unless <condition> is matched. A 403 error will be returned if the request
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001905 is blocked. The condition has to reference ACLs (see section 7). This is
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02001906 typically used to deny access to certain sensitive resources if some
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001907 conditions are met or not met. There is no fixed limit to the number of
1908 "block" statements per instance.
1909
1910 Example:
1911 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
1912 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
1913 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
1914 block if invalid_src || local_dst
1915
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001916 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001917
1918
1919capture cookie <name> len <length>
1920 Capture and log a cookie in the request and in the response.
1921 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1922 no | yes | yes | no
1923 Arguments :
1924 <name> is the beginning of the name of the cookie to capture. In order
1925 to match the exact name, simply suffix the name with an equal
1926 sign ('='). The full name will appear in the logs, which is
1927 useful with application servers which adjust both the cookie name
1928 and value (eg: ASPSESSIONXXXXX).
1929
1930 <length> is the maximum number of characters to report in the logs, which
1931 include the cookie name, the equal sign and the value, all in the
1932 standard "name=value" form. The string will be truncated on the
1933 right if it exceeds <length>.
1934
1935 Only the first cookie is captured. Both the "cookie" request headers and the
1936 "set-cookie" response headers are monitored. This is particularly useful to
1937 check for application bugs causing session crossing or stealing between
1938 users, because generally the user's cookies can only change on a login page.
1939
1940 When the cookie was not presented by the client, the associated log column
1941 will report "-". When a request does not cause a cookie to be assigned by the
1942 server, a "-" is reported in the response column.
1943
1944 The capture is performed in the frontend only because it is necessary that
1945 the log format does not change for a given frontend depending on the
1946 backends. This may change in the future. Note that there can be only one
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01001947 "capture cookie" statement in a frontend. The maximum capture length is set
1948 by the global "tune.http.cookielen" setting and defaults to 63 characters. It
1949 is not possible to specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001950
1951 Example:
1952 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
1953
1954 See also : "capture request header", "capture response header" as well as
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001955 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001956
1957
1958capture request header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01001959 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified request header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001960 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
1961 no | yes | yes | no
1962 Arguments :
1963 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01001964 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001965 appear in the requests, with the first letter of each word in
1966 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
1967 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
1968
1969 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
1970 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
1971 it exceeds <length>.
1972
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01001973 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001974 value will be added to the logs between braces ('{}'). If multiple headers
1975 are captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar ('|') and will appear
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01001976 in the same order they were declared in the configuration. Non-existent
1977 headers will be logged just as an empty string. Common uses for request
1978 header captures include the "Host" field in virtual hosting environments, the
1979 "Content-length" when uploads are supported, "User-agent" to quickly
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001980 differentiate between real users and robots, and "X-Forwarded-For" in proxied
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01001981 environments to find where the request came from.
1982
1983 Note that when capturing headers such as "User-agent", some spaces may be
1984 logged, making the log analysis more difficult. Thus be careful about what
1985 you log if you know your log parser is not smart enough to rely on the
1986 braces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001987
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01001988 There is no limit to the number of captured request headers nor to their
1989 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
1990 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
1991 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
1992 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001993
1994 Example:
1995 capture request header Host len 15
1996 capture request header X-Forwarded-For len 15
1997 capture request header Referrer len 15
1998
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001999 See also : "capture cookie", "capture response header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002000 about logging.
2001
2002
2003capture response header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01002004 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified response header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002005 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2006 no | yes | yes | no
2007 Arguments :
2008 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002009 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002010 appear in the response, with the first letter of each word in
2011 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
2012 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
2013
2014 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
2015 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
2016 it exceeds <length>.
2017
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01002018 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002019 result will be added to the logs between braces ('{}') after the captured
2020 request headers. If multiple headers are captured, they will be delimited by
2021 a vertical bar ('|') and will appear in the same order they were declared in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01002022 the configuration. Non-existent headers will be logged just as an empty
2023 string. Common uses for response header captures include the "Content-length"
2024 header which indicates how many bytes are expected to be returned, the
2025 "Location" header to track redirections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002026
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01002027 There is no limit to the number of captured response headers nor to their
2028 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
2029 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
2030 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
2031 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002032
2033 Example:
2034 capture response header Content-length len 9
2035 capture response header Location len 15
2036
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002037 See also : "capture cookie", "capture request header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002038 about logging.
2039
2040
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002041clitimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002042 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
2043 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2044 yes | yes | yes | no
2045 Arguments :
2046 <timeout> is the timeout value is specified in milliseconds by default, but
2047 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
2048 as explained at the top of this document.
2049
2050 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
2051 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
2052 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
2053 response while it is reading data sent by the server. The value is specified
2054 in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
2055 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
2056 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
2057 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002058 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002059 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
2060 (eg: 4 or 5 seconds).
2061
2062 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
2063 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
2064 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
2065 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
2066 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
2067 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
2068
2069 This parameter is provided for compatibility but is currently deprecated.
2070 Please use "timeout client" instead.
2071
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01002072 See also : "timeout client", "timeout http-request", "timeout server", and
2073 "srvtimeout".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002074
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002075compression algo <algorithm> ...
2076compression type <mime type> ...
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02002077compression offload
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002078 Enable HTTP compression.
2079 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2080 yes | yes | yes | yes
2081 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002082 algo is followed by the list of supported compression algorithms.
2083 type is followed by the list of MIME types that will be compressed.
2084 offload makes haproxy work as a compression offloader only (see notes).
2085
2086 The currently supported algorithms are :
Dmitry Sivachenko87c208b2012-11-22 20:03:26 +04002087 identity this is mostly for debugging, and it was useful for developing
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002088 the compression feature. Identity does not apply any change on
2089 data.
2090
2091 gzip applies gzip compression. This setting is only available when
2092 support for zlib was built in.
2093
2094 deflate same as gzip, but with deflate algorithm and zlib format.
2095 Note that this algorithm has ambiguous support on many browsers
2096 and no support at all from recent ones. It is strongly
2097 recommended not to use it for anything else than experimentation.
2098 This setting is only available when support for zlib was built
2099 in.
2100
Dmitry Sivachenko87c208b2012-11-22 20:03:26 +04002101 Compression will be activated depending on the Accept-Encoding request
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002102 header. With identity, it does not take care of that header.
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04002103 If backend servers support HTTP compression, these directives
2104 will be no-op: haproxy will see the compressed response and will not
2105 compress again. If backend servers do not support HTTP compression and
2106 there is Accept-Encoding header in request, haproxy will compress the
2107 matching response.
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02002108
2109 The "offload" setting makes haproxy remove the Accept-Encoding header to
2110 prevent backend servers from compressing responses. It is strongly
2111 recommended not to do this because this means that all the compression work
2112 will be done on the single point where haproxy is located. However in some
2113 deployment scenarios, haproxy may be installed in front of a buggy gateway
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04002114 with broken HTTP compression implementation which can't be turned off.
2115 In that case haproxy can be used to prevent that gateway from emitting
2116 invalid payloads. In this case, simply removing the header in the
2117 configuration does not work because it applies before the header is parsed,
2118 so that prevents haproxy from compressing. The "offload" setting should
2119 then be used for such scenarios.
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002120
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01002121 Compression is disabled when:
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01002122 * the request does not advertise a supported compression algorithm in the
2123 "Accept-Encoding" header
2124 * the response message is not HTTP/1.1
William Lallemandd3002612012-11-26 14:34:47 +01002125 * HTTP status code is not 200
William Lallemand8bb4e342013-12-10 17:28:48 +01002126 * response header "Transfer-Encoding" contains "chunked" (Temporary
2127 Workaround)
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01002128 * response contain neither a "Content-Length" header nor a
2129 "Transfer-Encoding" whose last value is "chunked"
2130 * response contains a "Content-Type" header whose first value starts with
2131 "multipart"
2132 * the response contains the "no-transform" value in the "Cache-control"
2133 header
2134 * User-Agent matches "Mozilla/4" unless it is MSIE 6 with XP SP2, or MSIE 7
2135 and later
2136 * The response contains a "Content-Encoding" header, indicating that the
2137 response is already compressed (see compression offload)
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01002138
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01002139 Note: The compression does not rewrite Etag headers, and does not emit the
2140 Warning header.
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01002141
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002142 Examples :
2143 compression algo gzip
2144 compression type text/html text/plain
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002145
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002146contimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002147 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
2148 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2149 yes | no | yes | yes
2150 Arguments :
2151 <timeout> is the timeout value is specified in milliseconds by default, but
2152 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
2153 as explained at the top of this document.
2154
2155 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002156 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01002157 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002158 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
2159 connect timeout also presets the queue timeout to the same value if this one
2160 has not been specified. Historically, the contimeout was also used to set the
2161 tarpit timeout in a listen section, which is not possible in a pure frontend.
2162
2163 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
2164 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
2165 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
2166 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
2167 during startup because it may results in accumulation of failed sessions in
2168 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
2169
2170 This parameter is provided for backwards compatibility but is currently
2171 deprecated. Please use "timeout connect", "timeout queue" or "timeout tarpit"
2172 instead.
2173
2174 See also : "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout tarpit",
2175 "timeout server", "contimeout".
2176
2177
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02002178cookie <name> [ rewrite | insert | prefix ] [ indirect ] [ nocache ]
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02002179 [ postonly ] [ preserve ] [ httponly ] [ secure ]
2180 [ domain <domain> ]* [ maxidle <idle> ] [ maxlife <life> ]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002181 Enable cookie-based persistence in a backend.
2182 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2183 yes | no | yes | yes
2184 Arguments :
2185 <name> is the name of the cookie which will be monitored, modified or
2186 inserted in order to bring persistence. This cookie is sent to
2187 the client via a "Set-Cookie" header in the response, and is
2188 brought back by the client in a "Cookie" header in all requests.
2189 Special care should be taken to choose a name which does not
2190 conflict with any likely application cookie. Also, if the same
2191 backends are subject to be used by the same clients (eg:
2192 HTTP/HTTPS), care should be taken to use different cookie names
2193 between all backends if persistence between them is not desired.
2194
2195 rewrite This keyword indicates that the cookie will be provided by the
2196 server and that haproxy will have to modify its value to set the
2197 server's identifier in it. This mode is handy when the management
2198 of complex combinations of "Set-cookie" and "Cache-control"
2199 headers is left to the application. The application can then
2200 decide whether or not it is appropriate to emit a persistence
2201 cookie. Since all responses should be monitored, this mode only
2202 works in HTTP close mode. Unless the application behaviour is
2203 very complex and/or broken, it is advised not to start with this
2204 mode for new deployments. This keyword is incompatible with
2205 "insert" and "prefix".
2206
2207 insert This keyword indicates that the persistence cookie will have to
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02002208 be inserted by haproxy in server responses if the client did not
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002209
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02002210 already have a cookie that would have permitted it to access this
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002211 server. When used without the "preserve" option, if the server
2212 emits a cookie with the same name, it will be remove before
2213 processing. For this reason, this mode can be used to upgrade
2214 existing configurations running in the "rewrite" mode. The cookie
2215 will only be a session cookie and will not be stored on the
2216 client's disk. By default, unless the "indirect" option is added,
2217 the server will see the cookies emitted by the client. Due to
2218 caching effects, it is generally wise to add the "nocache" or
2219 "postonly" keywords (see below). The "insert" keyword is not
2220 compatible with "rewrite" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002221
2222 prefix This keyword indicates that instead of relying on a dedicated
2223 cookie for the persistence, an existing one will be completed.
2224 This may be needed in some specific environments where the client
2225 does not support more than one single cookie and the application
2226 already needs it. In this case, whenever the server sets a cookie
2227 named <name>, it will be prefixed with the server's identifier
2228 and a delimiter. The prefix will be removed from all client
2229 requests so that the server still finds the cookie it emitted.
2230 Since all requests and responses are subject to being modified,
2231 this mode requires the HTTP close mode. The "prefix" keyword is
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02002232 not compatible with "rewrite" and "insert". Note: it is highly
2233 recommended not to use "indirect" with "prefix", otherwise server
2234 cookie updates would not be sent to clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002235
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02002236 indirect When this option is specified, no cookie will be emitted to a
2237 client which already has a valid one for the server which has
2238 processed the request. If the server sets such a cookie itself,
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002239 it will be removed, unless the "preserve" option is also set. In
2240 "insert" mode, this will additionally remove cookies from the
2241 requests transmitted to the server, making the persistence
2242 mechanism totally transparent from an application point of view.
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02002243 Note: it is highly recommended not to use "indirect" with
2244 "prefix", otherwise server cookie updates would not be sent to
2245 clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002246
2247 nocache This option is recommended in conjunction with the insert mode
2248 when there is a cache between the client and HAProxy, as it
2249 ensures that a cacheable response will be tagged non-cacheable if
2250 a cookie needs to be inserted. This is important because if all
2251 persistence cookies are added on a cacheable home page for
2252 instance, then all customers will then fetch the page from an
2253 outer cache and will all share the same persistence cookie,
2254 leading to one server receiving much more traffic than others.
2255 See also the "insert" and "postonly" options.
2256
2257 postonly This option ensures that cookie insertion will only be performed
2258 on responses to POST requests. It is an alternative to the
2259 "nocache" option, because POST responses are not cacheable, so
2260 this ensures that the persistence cookie will never get cached.
2261 Since most sites do not need any sort of persistence before the
2262 first POST which generally is a login request, this is a very
2263 efficient method to optimize caching without risking to find a
2264 persistence cookie in the cache.
2265 See also the "insert" and "nocache" options.
2266
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002267 preserve This option may only be used with "insert" and/or "indirect". It
2268 allows the server to emit the persistence cookie itself. In this
2269 case, if a cookie is found in the response, haproxy will leave it
2270 untouched. This is useful in order to end persistence after a
2271 logout request for instance. For this, the server just has to
2272 emit a cookie with an invalid value (eg: empty) or with a date in
2273 the past. By combining this mechanism with the "disable-on-404"
2274 check option, it is possible to perform a completely graceful
2275 shutdown because users will definitely leave the server after
2276 they logout.
2277
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02002278 httponly This option tells haproxy to add an "HttpOnly" cookie attribute
2279 when a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a
2280 user agent doesn't share the cookie with non-HTTP components.
2281 Please check RFC6265 for more information on this attribute.
2282
2283 secure This option tells haproxy to add a "Secure" cookie attribute when
2284 a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a user agent
2285 never emits this cookie over non-secure channels, which means
2286 that a cookie learned with this flag will be presented only over
2287 SSL/TLS connections. Please check RFC6265 for more information on
2288 this attribute.
2289
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02002290 domain This option allows to specify the domain at which a cookie is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002291 inserted. It requires exactly one parameter: a valid domain
Willy Tarreau68a897b2009-12-03 23:28:34 +01002292 name. If the domain begins with a dot, the browser is allowed to
2293 use it for any host ending with that name. It is also possible to
2294 specify several domain names by invoking this option multiple
2295 times. Some browsers might have small limits on the number of
2296 domains, so be careful when doing that. For the record, sending
2297 10 domains to MSIE 6 or Firefox 2 works as expected.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02002298
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02002299 maxidle This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some idle
2300 time. It only works with insert-mode cookies. When a cookie is
2301 sent to the client, the date this cookie was emitted is sent too.
2302 Upon further presentations of this cookie, if the date is older
2303 than the delay indicated by the parameter (in seconds), it will
2304 be ignored. Otherwise, it will be refreshed if needed when the
2305 response is sent to the client. This is particularly useful to
2306 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
2307 too long on the same server (eg: after a farm size change). When
2308 this option is set and a cookie has no date, it is always
2309 accepted, but gets refreshed in the response. This maintains the
2310 ability for admins to access their sites. Cookies that have a
2311 date in the future further than 24 hours are ignored. Doing so
2312 lets admins fix timezone issues without risking kicking users off
2313 the site.
2314
2315 maxlife This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some life
2316 time, whether they're in use or not. It only works with insert
2317 mode cookies. When a cookie is first sent to the client, the date
2318 this cookie was emitted is sent too. Upon further presentations
2319 of this cookie, if the date is older than the delay indicated by
2320 the parameter (in seconds), it will be ignored. If the cookie in
2321 the request has no date, it is accepted and a date will be set.
2322 Cookies that have a date in the future further than 24 hours are
2323 ignored. Doing so lets admins fix timezone issues without risking
2324 kicking users off the site. Contrary to maxidle, this value is
2325 not refreshed, only the first visit date counts. Both maxidle and
2326 maxlife may be used at the time. This is particularly useful to
2327 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
2328 too long on the same server (eg: after a farm size change). This
2329 is stronger than the maxidle method in that it forces a
2330 redispatch after some absolute delay.
2331
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002332 There can be only one persistence cookie per HTTP backend, and it can be
2333 declared in a defaults section. The value of the cookie will be the value
2334 indicated after the "cookie" keyword in a "server" statement. If no cookie
2335 is declared for a given server, the cookie is not set.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002336
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002337 Examples :
2338 cookie JSESSIONID prefix
2339 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
2340 cookie SRV insert postonly indirect
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02002341 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache maxidle 30m maxlife 8h
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002342
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02002343 See also : "appsession", "balance source", "capture cookie", "server"
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02002344 and "ignore-persist".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002345
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002346
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01002347default-server [param*]
2348 Change default options for a server in a backend
2349 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2350 yes | no | yes | yes
2351 Arguments:
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002352 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
2353 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
2354 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
2355 details.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01002356
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002357 Example :
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01002358 default-server inter 1000 weight 13
2359
2360 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002361
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002362
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002363default_backend <backend>
2364 Specify the backend to use when no "use_backend" rule has been matched.
2365 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2366 yes | yes | yes | no
2367 Arguments :
2368 <backend> is the name of the backend to use.
2369
2370 When doing content-switching between frontend and backends using the
2371 "use_backend" keyword, it is often useful to indicate which backend will be
2372 used when no rule has matched. It generally is the dynamic backend which
2373 will catch all undetermined requests.
2374
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002375 Example :
2376
2377 use_backend dynamic if url_dyn
2378 use_backend static if url_css url_img extension_img
2379 default_backend dynamic
2380
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002381 See also : "use_backend", "reqsetbe", "reqisetbe"
2382
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002383
Baptiste Assmann27f51342013-10-09 06:51:49 +02002384description <string>
2385 Describe a listen, frontend or backend.
2386 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2387 no | yes | yes | yes
2388 Arguments : string
2389
2390 Allows to add a sentence to describe the related object in the HAProxy HTML
2391 stats page. The description will be printed on the right of the object name
2392 it describes.
2393 No need to backslash spaces in the <string> arguments.
2394
2395
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002396disabled
2397 Disable a proxy, frontend or backend.
2398 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2399 yes | yes | yes | yes
2400 Arguments : none
2401
2402 The "disabled" keyword is used to disable an instance, mainly in order to
2403 liberate a listening port or to temporarily disable a service. The instance
2404 will still be created and its configuration will be checked, but it will be
2405 created in the "stopped" state and will appear as such in the statistics. It
2406 will not receive any traffic nor will it send any health-checks or logs. It
2407 is possible to disable many instances at once by adding the "disabled"
2408 keyword in a "defaults" section.
2409
2410 See also : "enabled"
2411
2412
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02002413dispatch <address>:<port>
2414 Set a default server address
2415 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2416 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02002417 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02002418
2419 <address> is the IPv4 address of the default server. Alternatively, a
2420 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
2421 during start-up.
2422
2423 <ports> is a mandatory port specification. All connections will be sent
2424 to this port, and it is not permitted to use port offsets as is
2425 possible with normal servers.
2426
Willy Tarreau787aed52011-04-15 06:45:37 +02002427 The "dispatch" keyword designates a default server for use when no other
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02002428 server can take the connection. In the past it was used to forward non
2429 persistent connections to an auxiliary load balancer. Due to its simple
2430 syntax, it has also been used for simple TCP relays. It is recommended not to
2431 use it for more clarity, and to use the "server" directive instead.
2432
2433 See also : "server"
2434
2435
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002436enabled
2437 Enable a proxy, frontend or backend.
2438 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2439 yes | yes | yes | yes
2440 Arguments : none
2441
2442 The "enabled" keyword is used to explicitly enable an instance, when the
2443 defaults has been set to "disabled". This is very rarely used.
2444
2445 See also : "disabled"
2446
2447
2448errorfile <code> <file>
2449 Return a file contents instead of errors generated by HAProxy
2450 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2451 yes | yes | yes | yes
2452 Arguments :
2453 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002454 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 408, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002455
2456 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002457 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002458 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002459 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
2460 before any chroot is performed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002461
2462 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
2463 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
2464 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
2465
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002466 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
2467
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002468 The files are returned verbatim on the TCP socket. This allows any trick such
2469 as redirections to another URL or site, as well as tricks to clean cookies,
2470 force enable or disable caching, etc... The package provides default error
2471 files returning the same contents as default errors.
2472
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002473 The files should not exceed the configured buffer size (BUFSIZE), which
2474 generally is 8 or 16 kB, otherwise they will be truncated. It is also wise
2475 not to put any reference to local contents (eg: images) in order to avoid
2476 loops between the client and HAProxy when all servers are down, causing an
2477 error to be returned instead of an image. For better HTTP compliance, it is
2478 recommended that all header lines end with CR-LF and not LF alone.
2479
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002480 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
2481 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
2482 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running. A
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01002483 simple method for developing those files consists in associating them to the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002484 403 status code and interrogating a blocked URL.
2485
2486 See also : "errorloc", "errorloc302", "errorloc303"
2487
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002488 Example :
2489 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/400badreq.http
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +02002490 errorfile 408 /dev/null # workaround Chrome pre-connect bug
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01002491 errorfile 403 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/403forbid.http
2492 errorfile 503 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/503sorry.http
2493
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002494
2495errorloc <code> <url>
2496errorloc302 <code> <url>
2497 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
2498 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2499 yes | yes | yes | yes
2500 Arguments :
2501 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002502 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 408, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002503
2504 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
2505 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
2506 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
2507 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
2508 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (eg: 500).
2509
2510 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
2511 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
2512 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
2513
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002514 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
2515
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002516 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 302 status code, which tells the
2517 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP method. This can be
2518 quite problematic in case of non-GET methods such as POST, because the URL
2519 sent to the client might not be allowed for something other than GET. To
2520 workaround this problem, please use "errorloc303" which send the HTTP 303
2521 status code, indicating to the client that the URL must be fetched with a GET
2522 request.
2523
2524 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc303"
2525
2526
2527errorloc303 <code> <url>
2528 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
2529 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2530 yes | yes | yes | yes
2531 Arguments :
2532 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
2533 generating codes 400, 403, 408, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
2534
2535 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
2536 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
2537 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
2538 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
2539 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (eg: 500).
2540
2541 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
2542 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
2543 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
2544
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02002545 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
2546
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002547 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 303 status code, which tells the
2548 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP GET method. This
2549 solves the usual problems associated with "errorloc" and the 302 code. It is
2550 possible that some very old browsers designed before HTTP/1.1 do not support
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002551 it, but no such problem has been reported till now.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002552
2553 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302"
2554
2555
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01002556force-persist { if | unless } <condition>
2557 Declare a condition to force persistence on down servers
2558 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2559 no | yes | yes | yes
2560
2561 By default, requests are not dispatched to down servers. It is possible to
2562 force this using "option persist", but it is unconditional and redispatches
2563 to a valid server if "option redispatch" is set. That leaves with very little
2564 possibilities to force some requests to reach a server which is artificially
2565 marked down for maintenance operations.
2566
2567 The "force-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
2568 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore the down status of
2569 a server and still try to connect to it. That makes it possible to start a
2570 server, still replying an error to the health checks, and run a specially
2571 configured browser to test the service. Among the handy methods, one could
2572 use a specific source IP address, or a specific cookie. The cookie also has
2573 the advantage that it can easily be added/removed on the browser from a test
2574 page. Once the service is validated, it is then possible to open the service
2575 to the world by returning a valid response to health checks.
2576
2577 The forced persistence is enabled when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
2578 "unless" condition is met. The final redispatch is always disabled when this
2579 is used.
2580
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02002581 See also : "option redispatch", "ignore-persist", "persist",
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02002582 and section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01002583
2584
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002585fullconn <conns>
2586 Specify at what backend load the servers will reach their maxconn
2587 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2588 yes | no | yes | yes
2589 Arguments :
2590 <conns> is the number of connections on the backend which will make the
2591 servers use the maximal number of connections.
2592
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01002593 When a server has a "maxconn" parameter specified, it means that its number
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002594 of concurrent connections will never go higher. Additionally, if it has a
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01002595 "minconn" parameter, it indicates a dynamic limit following the backend's
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002596 load. The server will then always accept at least <minconn> connections,
2597 never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on the ramp between both
2598 values when the backend has less than <conns> concurrent connections. This
2599 makes it possible to limit the load on the servers during normal loads, but
2600 push it further for important loads without overloading the servers during
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002601 exceptional loads.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002602
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02002603 Since it's hard to get this value right, haproxy automatically sets it to
2604 10% of the sum of the maxconns of all frontends that may branch to this
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01002605 backend (based on "use_backend" and "default_backend" rules). That way it's
2606 safe to leave it unset. However, "use_backend" involving dynamic names are
2607 not counted since there is no way to know if they could match or not.
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02002608
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002609 Example :
2610 # The servers will accept between 100 and 1000 concurrent connections each
2611 # and the maximum of 1000 will be reached when the backend reaches 10000
2612 # connections.
2613 backend dynamic
2614 fullconn 10000
2615 server srv1 dyn1:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
2616 server srv2 dyn2:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
2617
2618 See also : "maxconn", "server"
2619
2620
2621grace <time>
2622 Maintain a proxy operational for some time after a soft stop
2623 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté99ed3272010-01-24 23:29:44 +01002624 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002625 Arguments :
2626 <time> is the time (by default in milliseconds) for which the instance
2627 will remain operational with the frontend sockets still listening
2628 when a soft-stop is received via the SIGUSR1 signal.
2629
2630 This may be used to ensure that the services disappear in a certain order.
2631 This was designed so that frontends which are dedicated to monitoring by an
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002632 external equipment fail immediately while other ones remain up for the time
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002633 needed by the equipment to detect the failure.
2634
2635 Note that currently, there is very little benefit in using this parameter,
2636 and it may in fact complicate the soft-reconfiguration process more than
2637 simplify it.
2638
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002639
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05002640hash-type <method> <function> <modifier>
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002641 Specify a method to use for mapping hashes to servers
2642 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2643 yes | no | yes | yes
2644 Arguments :
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04002645 <method> is the method used to select a server from the hash computed by
2646 the <function> :
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002647
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04002648 map-based the hash table is a static array containing all alive servers.
2649 The hashes will be very smooth, will consider weights, but
2650 will be static in that weight changes while a server is up
2651 will be ignored. This means that there will be no slow start.
2652 Also, since a server is selected by its position in the array,
2653 most mappings are changed when the server count changes. This
2654 means that when a server goes up or down, or when a server is
2655 added to a farm, most connections will be redistributed to
2656 different servers. This can be inconvenient with caches for
2657 instance.
Willy Tarreau798a39c2010-11-24 15:04:29 +01002658
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04002659 consistent the hash table is a tree filled with many occurrences of each
2660 server. The hash key is looked up in the tree and the closest
2661 server is chosen. This hash is dynamic, it supports changing
2662 weights while the servers are up, so it is compatible with the
2663 slow start feature. It has the advantage that when a server
2664 goes up or down, only its associations are moved. When a
2665 server is added to the farm, only a few part of the mappings
2666 are redistributed, making it an ideal method for caches.
2667 However, due to its principle, the distribution will never be
2668 very smooth and it may sometimes be necessary to adjust a
2669 server's weight or its ID to get a more balanced distribution.
2670 In order to get the same distribution on multiple load
2671 balancers, it is important that all servers have the exact
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05002672 same IDs. Note: consistent hash uses sdbm and avalanche if no
2673 hash function is specified.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04002674
2675 <function> is the hash function to be used :
2676
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002677 sdbm this function was created initially for sdbm (a public-domain
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04002678 reimplementation of ndbm) database library. It was found to do
2679 well in scrambling bits, causing better distribution of the keys
2680 and fewer splits. It also happens to be a good general hashing
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05002681 function with good distribution, unless the total server weight
2682 is a multiple of 64, in which case applying the avalanche
2683 modifier may help.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04002684
2685 djb2 this function was first proposed by Dan Bernstein many years ago
2686 on comp.lang.c. Studies have shown that for certain workload this
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05002687 function provides a better distribution than sdbm. It generally
2688 works well with text-based inputs though it can perform extremely
2689 poorly with numeric-only input or when the total server weight is
2690 a multiple of 33, unless the avalanche modifier is also used.
2691
Willy Tarreaua0f42712013-11-14 14:30:35 +01002692 wt6 this function was designed for haproxy while testing other
2693 functions in the past. It is not as smooth as the other ones, but
2694 is much less sensible to the input data set or to the number of
2695 servers. It can make sense as an alternative to sdbm+avalanche or
2696 djb2+avalanche for consistent hashing or when hashing on numeric
2697 data such as a source IP address or a visitor identifier in a URL
2698 parameter.
2699
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05002700 <modifier> indicates an optional method applied after hashing the key :
2701
2702 avalanche This directive indicates that the result from the hash
2703 function above should not be used in its raw form but that
2704 a 4-byte full avalanche hash must be applied first. The
2705 purpose of this step is to mix the resulting bits from the
2706 previous hash in order to avoid any undesired effect when
2707 the input contains some limited values or when the number of
2708 servers is a multiple of one of the hash's components (64
2709 for SDBM, 33 for DJB2). Enabling avalanche tends to make the
2710 result less predictable, but it's also not as smooth as when
2711 using the original function. Some testing might be needed
2712 with some workloads. This hash is one of the many proposed
2713 by Bob Jenkins.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002714
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04002715 The default hash type is "map-based" and is recommended for most usages. The
2716 default function is "sdbm", the selection of a function should be based on
2717 the range of the values being hashed.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002718
2719 See also : "balance", "server"
2720
2721
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002722http-check disable-on-404
2723 Enable a maintenance mode upon HTTP/404 response to health-checks
2724 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002725 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002726 Arguments : none
2727
2728 When this option is set, a server which returns an HTTP code 404 will be
2729 excluded from further load-balancing, but will still receive persistent
2730 connections. This provides a very convenient method for Web administrators
2731 to perform a graceful shutdown of their servers. It is also important to note
2732 that a server which is detected as failed while it was in this mode will not
2733 generate an alert, just a notice. If the server responds 2xx or 3xx again, it
2734 will immediately be reinserted into the farm. The status on the stats page
2735 reports "NOLB" for a server in this mode. It is important to note that this
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002736 option only works in conjunction with the "httpchk" option. If this option
2737 is used with "http-check expect", then it has precedence over it so that 404
2738 responses will still be considered as soft-stop.
2739
2740 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check expect"
2741
2742
2743http-check expect [!] <match> <pattern>
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002744 Make HTTP health checks consider response contents or specific status codes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002745 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau1ee51a62011-08-19 20:04:17 +02002746 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002747 Arguments :
2748 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
2749 response. The keyword may be one of "status", "rstatus",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002750 "string", or "rstring". The keyword may be preceded by an
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002751 exclamation mark ("!") to negate the match. Spaces are allowed
2752 between the exclamation mark and the keyword. See below for more
2753 details on the supported keywords.
2754
2755 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
2756 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
2757 with the usual backslash ('\').
2758
2759 By default, "option httpchk" considers that response statuses 2xx and 3xx
2760 are valid, and that others are invalid. When "http-check expect" is used,
2761 it defines what is considered valid or invalid. Only one "http-check"
2762 statement is supported in a backend. If a server fails to respond or times
2763 out, the check obviously fails. The available matches are :
2764
2765 status <string> : test the exact string match for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002766 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002767 response's status code is exactly this string. If the
2768 "status" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
2769 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
2770
2771 rstatus <regex> : test a regular expression for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002772 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002773 response's status code matches the expression. If the
2774 "rstatus" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
2775 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
2776 This is mostly used to check for multiple codes.
2777
2778 string <string> : test the exact string match in the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002779 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002780 response's body contains this exact string. If the
2781 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
2782 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
2783 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory word at
2784 the end of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a
2785 specific error appears on the check page (eg: a stack
2786 trace).
2787
2788 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002789 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002790 response's body matches this expression. If the "rstring"
2791 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
2792 considered invalid if the body matches the expression.
2793 This can be used to look for a mandatory word at the end
2794 of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a specific
2795 error appears on the check page (eg: a stack trace).
2796
2797 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
2798 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
2799 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
2800 "string" or "rstring". If a large response is absolutely required, it is
2801 possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
2802 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
2803 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
2804 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources.
2805
2806 Last, if "http-check expect" is combined with "http-check disable-on-404",
2807 then this last one has precedence when the server responds with 404.
2808
2809 Examples :
2810 # only accept status 200 as valid
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01002811 http-check expect status 200
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002812
2813 # consider SQL errors as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01002814 http-check expect ! string SQL\ Error
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002815
2816 # consider status 5xx only as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01002817 http-check expect ! rstatus ^5
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002818
2819 # check that we have a correct hexadecimal tag before /html
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01002820 http-check expect rstring <!--tag:[0-9a-f]*</html>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002821
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002822 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002823
2824
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01002825http-check send-state
2826 Enable emission of a state header with HTTP health checks
2827 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2828 yes | no | yes | yes
2829 Arguments : none
2830
2831 When this option is set, haproxy will systematically send a special header
2832 "X-Haproxy-Server-State" with a list of parameters indicating to each server
2833 how they are seen by haproxy. This can be used for instance when a server is
2834 manipulated without access to haproxy and the operator needs to know whether
2835 haproxy still sees it up or not, or if the server is the last one in a farm.
2836
2837 The header is composed of fields delimited by semi-colons, the first of which
2838 is a word ("UP", "DOWN", "NOLB"), possibly followed by a number of valid
2839 checks on the total number before transition, just as appears in the stats
2840 interface. Next headers are in the form "<variable>=<value>", indicating in
2841 no specific order some values available in the stats interface :
2842 - a variable "name", containing the name of the backend followed by a slash
2843 ("/") then the name of the server. This can be used when a server is
2844 checked in multiple backends.
2845
2846 - a variable "node" containing the name of the haproxy node, as set in the
2847 global "node" variable, otherwise the system's hostname if unspecified.
2848
2849 - a variable "weight" indicating the weight of the server, a slash ("/")
2850 and the total weight of the farm (just counting usable servers). This
2851 helps to know if other servers are available to handle the load when this
2852 one fails.
2853
2854 - a variable "scur" indicating the current number of concurrent connections
2855 on the server, followed by a slash ("/") then the total number of
2856 connections on all servers of the same backend.
2857
2858 - a variable "qcur" indicating the current number of requests in the
2859 server's queue.
2860
2861 Example of a header received by the application server :
2862 >>> X-Haproxy-Server-State: UP 2/3; name=bck/srv2; node=lb1; weight=1/2; \
2863 scur=13/22; qcur=0
2864
2865 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
2866
Willy Tarreauccbcc372012-12-27 12:37:57 +01002867http-request { allow | deny | tarpit | auth [realm <realm>] | redirect <rule> |
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02002868 add-header <name> <fmt> | set-header <name> <fmt> |
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02002869 del-header <name> | set-nice <nice> | set-log-level <level> |
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02002870 set-tos <tos> | set-mark <mark> |
2871 add-acl(<file name>) <key fmt> |
2872 del-acl(<file name>) <key fmt> |
2873 del-map(<file name>) <key fmt> |
2874 set-map(<file name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
2875 }
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002876 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002877 Access control for Layer 7 requests
2878
2879 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2880 no | yes | yes | yes
2881
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01002882 The http-request statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
2883 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
2884 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
2885 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
2886 if the condition is true.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002887
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01002888 The first keyword is the rule's action. Currently supported actions include :
2889 - "allow" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the request
2890 pass the check. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
2891
2892 - "deny" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects
2893 the request and emits an HTTP 403 error. No further "http-request" rules
2894 are evaluated.
2895
Willy Tarreauccbcc372012-12-27 12:37:57 +01002896 - "tarpit" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately blocks
2897 the request without responding for a delay specified by "timeout tarpit"
2898 or "timeout connect" if the former is not set. After that delay, if the
2899 client is still connected, an HTTP error 500 is returned so that the
2900 client does not suspect it has been tarpitted. Logs will report the flags
2901 "PT". The goal of the tarpit rule is to slow down robots during an attack
2902 when they're limited on the number of concurrent requests. It can be very
2903 efficient against very dumb robots, and will significantly reduce the
2904 load on firewalls compared to a "deny" rule. But when facing "correctly"
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002905 developed robots, it can make things worse by forcing haproxy and the
Willy Tarreauccbcc372012-12-27 12:37:57 +01002906 front firewall to support insane number of concurrent connections.
2907
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01002908 - "auth" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately responds
2909 with an HTTP 401 or 407 error code to invite the user to present a valid
2910 user name and password. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated. An
2911 optional "realm" parameter is supported, it sets the authentication realm
2912 that is returned with the response (typically the application's name).
2913
Willy Tarreau81499eb2012-12-27 12:19:02 +01002914 - "redirect" : this performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule.
2915 This is exactly the same as the "redirect" statement except that it
2916 inserts a redirect rule which can be processed in the middle of other
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01002917 "http-request" rules and that these rules use the "log-format" strings.
2918 See the "redirect" keyword for the rule's syntax.
Willy Tarreau81499eb2012-12-27 12:19:02 +01002919
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01002920 - "add-header" appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in
2921 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format
2922 rules (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly
2923 useful to pass connection-specific information to the server (eg: the
2924 client's SSL certificate), or to combine several headers into one. This
2925 rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules. Note
2926 that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse
2927 the resulting header from a previous rule.
2928
2929 - "set-header" does the same as "add-header" except that the header name
2930 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
2931 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
2932 external users.
2933
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02002934 - "del-header" removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in
2935 <name>.
2936
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02002937 - "set-nice" sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed.
2938 It only has effect against the other requests being processed at the same
2939 time. The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the
2940 "bind" line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the
2941 nicest the request will be. Lower values will make the request more
2942 important than other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of
2943 some requests, or lower the priority of non-important requests. Using
2944 this setting without prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
2945
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02002946 - "set-log-level" is used to change the log level of the current request
2947 when a certain condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels
2948 (see the "log" keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables
2949 logging for this request. This rule is not final so the last matching
2950 rule wins. This rule can be useful to disable health checks coming from
2951 another equipment.
2952
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02002953 - "set-tos" is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to
2954 the client to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this.
2955 This value represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be
2956 expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note
2957 that only the 6 higher bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower
2958 bits are always 0. This can be used to adjust some routing behaviour on
2959 border routers based on some information from the request. See RFC 2474,
2960 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
2961
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02002962 - "set-mark" is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the
2963 client to the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This
2964 value is an unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and
2965 by the routing table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal
2966 format (prefixed by "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to
2967 take a different route (for example a cheaper network path for bulk
2968 downloads). This works on Linux kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires
2969 admin privileges.
2970
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02002971 - "add-acl" is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded
2972 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be
2973 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
2974 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It
2975 performs a lookup in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
2976 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
2977 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the
2978 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
2979
2980 - "del-acl" is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded
2981 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be
2982 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
2983 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
2984 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but
2985 can be triggered by an HTTP request.
2986
2987 - "del-map" is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded
2988 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be
2989 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
2990 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
2991 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
2992 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
2993
2994 - "set-map" is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded
2995 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be
2996 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>,
2997 which follows log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>,
2998 which follows log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry.
2999 It performs a lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
3000 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
3001 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the
3002 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
3003
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003004 There is no limit to the number of http-request statements per instance.
3005
3006 It is important to know that http-request rules are processed very early in
3007 the HTTP processing, just after "block" rules and before "reqdel" or "reqrep"
3008 rules. That way, headers added by "add-header"/"set-header" are visible by
3009 almost all further ACL rules.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003010
3011 Example:
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01003012 acl nagios src 192.168.129.3
3013 acl local_net src 192.168.0.0/16
3014 acl auth_ok http_auth(L1)
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003015
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01003016 http-request allow if nagios
3017 http-request allow if local_net auth_ok
3018 http-request auth realm Gimme if local_net auth_ok
3019 http-request deny
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003020
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01003021 Example:
3022 acl auth_ok http_auth_group(L1) G1
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01003023 http-request auth unless auth_ok
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003024
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003025 Example:
3026 http-request set-header X-Haproxy-Current-Date %T
3027 http-request set-header X-SSL %[ssl_fc]
3028 http-request set-header X-SSL-Session_ID %[ssl_fc_session_id]
3029 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-Verify %[ssl_c_verify]
3030 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-DN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn]
3031 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-CN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn(cn)]
3032 http-request set-header X-SSL-Issuer %{+Q}[ssl_c_i_dn]
3033 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotBefore %{+Q}[ssl_c_notbefore]
3034 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotAfter %{+Q}[ssl_c_notafter]
3035
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003036 Example:
3037 acl key req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key) -m found
3038 acl add path /addacl
3039 acl del path /delacl
3040
3041 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
3042
3043 http-request add-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key add
3044 http-request del-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key del
3045
3046 Example:
3047 acl value req.hdr(X-Value) -m found
3048 acl setmap path /setmap
3049 acl delmap path /delmap
3050
3051 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
3052
3053 http-request set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[req.hdr(X-Value)] if setmap value
3054 http-request del-map(map.lst) %[src] if delmap
3055
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02003056 See also : "stats http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
3057 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01003058
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02003059http-response { allow | deny | add-header <name> <fmt> | set-nice <nice> |
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02003060 set-header <name> <fmt> | del-header <name> |
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003061 set-log-level <level> | set-mark <mark> | set-tos <tos> |
3062 add-acl(<file name>) <key fmt> |
3063 del-acl(<file name>) <key fmt> |
3064 del-map(<file name>) <key fmt> |
3065 set-map(<file name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
3066 }
Lukas Tribus2dd1d1a2013-06-19 23:34:41 +02003067 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02003068 Access control for Layer 7 responses
3069
3070 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3071 no | yes | yes | yes
3072
3073 The http-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
3074 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
3075 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
3076 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
3077 if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
3078 rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
3079
3080 The first keyword is the rule's action. Currently supported actions include :
3081 - "allow" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response
3082 pass the check. No further "http-response" rules are evaluated for the
3083 current section.
3084
3085 - "deny" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects
3086 the response and emits an HTTP 502 error. No further "http-response"
3087 rules are evaluated.
3088
3089 - "add-header" appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in
3090 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format
3091 rules (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This may be used to send
3092 a cookie to a client for example, or to pass some internal information.
3093 This rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules.
3094 Note that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might
3095 reuse the resulting header from a previous rule.
3096
3097 - "set-header" does the same as "add-header" except that the header name
3098 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
3099 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
3100 external users.
3101
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02003102 - "del-header" removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in
3103 <name>.
3104
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02003105 - "set-nice" sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed.
3106 It only has effect against the other requests being processed at the same
3107 time. The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the
3108 "bind" line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the
3109 nicest the request will be. Lower values will make the request more
3110 important than other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of
3111 some requests, or lower the priority of non-important requests. Using
3112 this setting without prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
3113
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02003114 - "set-log-level" is used to change the log level of the current request
3115 when a certain condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels
3116 (see the "log" keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables
3117 logging for this request. This rule is not final so the last matching
3118 rule wins. This rule can be useful to disable health checks coming from
3119 another equipment.
3120
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02003121 - "set-tos" is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to
3122 the client to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this.
3123 This value represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be
3124 expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note
3125 that only the 6 higher bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower
3126 bits are always 0. This can be used to adjust some routing behaviour on
3127 border routers based on some information from the request. See RFC 2474,
3128 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
3129
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02003130 - "set-mark" is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the
3131 client to the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This
3132 value is an unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and
3133 by the routing table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal
3134 format (prefixed by "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to
3135 take a different route (for example a cheaper network path for bulk
3136 downloads). This works on Linux kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires
3137 admin privileges.
3138
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003139 - "add-acl" is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded
3140 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be
3141 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
3142 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It
3143 performs a lookup in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
3144 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
3145 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the
3146 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
3147
3148 - "del-acl" is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded
3149 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be
3150 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
3151 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
3152 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but
3153 can be triggered by an HTTP response.
3154
3155 - "del-map" is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded
3156 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be
3157 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
3158 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
3159 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
3160 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
3161
3162 - "set-map" is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded
3163 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be
3164 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>,
3165 which follows log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>,
3166 which follows log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry.
3167 It performs a lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
3168 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
3169 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the
3170 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
3171
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02003172 There is no limit to the number of http-response statements per instance.
3173
Godbach09250262013-07-02 01:19:15 +08003174 It is important to know that http-response rules are processed very early in
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02003175 the HTTP processing, before "reqdel" or "reqrep" rules. That way, headers
3176 added by "add-header"/"set-header" are visible by almost all further ACL
3177 rules.
3178
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003179 Example:
3180 acl key_acl res.hdr(X-Acl-Key) -m found
3181
3182 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
3183
3184 http-response add-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
3185 http-response del-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
3186
3187 Example:
3188 acl value res.hdr(X-Value) -m found
3189
3190 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
3191
3192 http-response set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[res.hdr(X-Value)] if value
3193 http-response del-map(map.lst) %[src] if ! value
3194
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02003195 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
3196 ACL usage.
3197
Baptiste Assmann5ecb77f2013-10-06 23:24:13 +02003198
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05003199http-send-name-header [<header>]
3200 Add the server name to a request. Use the header string given by <header>
3201
3202 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3203 yes | no | yes | yes
3204
3205 Arguments :
3206
3207 <header> The header string to use to send the server name
3208
3209 The "http-send-name-header" statement causes the name of the target
3210 server to be added to the headers of an HTTP request. The name
3211 is added with the header string proved.
3212
3213 See also : "server"
3214
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01003215id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02003216 Set a persistent ID to a proxy.
3217 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3218 no | yes | yes | yes
3219 Arguments : none
3220
3221 Set a persistent ID for the proxy. This ID must be unique and positive.
3222 An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first assigned
3223 value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01003224
3225
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02003226ignore-persist { if | unless } <condition>
3227 Declare a condition to ignore persistence
3228 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3229 no | yes | yes | yes
3230
3231 By default, when cookie persistence is enabled, every requests containing
3232 the cookie are unconditionally persistent (assuming the target server is up
3233 and running).
3234
3235 The "ignore-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
3236 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore persistence.
3237 This is sometimes useful to load balance requests for static files, which
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03003238 often don't require persistence. This can also be used to fully disable
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02003239 persistence for a specific User-Agent (for example, some web crawler bots).
3240
3241 Combined with "appsession", it can also help reduce HAProxy memory usage, as
3242 the appsession table won't grow if persistence is ignored.
3243
3244 The persistence is ignored when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
3245 "unless" condition is met.
3246
3247 See also : "force-persist", "cookie", and section 7 about ACL usage.
3248
3249
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003250log global
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02003251log <address> <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02003252no log
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003253 Enable per-instance logging of events and traffic.
3254 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3255 yes | yes | yes | yes
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02003256
3257 Prefix :
3258 no should be used when the logger list must be flushed. For example,
3259 if you don't want to inherit from the default logger list. This
3260 prefix does not allow arguments.
3261
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003262 Arguments :
3263 global should be used when the instance's logging parameters are the
3264 same as the global ones. This is the most common usage. "global"
3265 replaces <address>, <facility> and <level> with those of the log
3266 entries found in the "global" section. Only one "log global"
3267 statement may be used per instance, and this form takes no other
3268 parameter.
3269
3270 <address> indicates where to send the logs. It takes the same format as
3271 for the "global" section's logs, and can be one of :
3272
3273 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon (':') and a UDP
3274 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
3275 standard syslog port).
3276
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +01003277 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon (':') and optionally a UDP
3278 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
3279 standard syslog port).
3280
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003281 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
3282 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible
3283 inside the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is
3284 appropriately writeable).
3285
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01003286 Any part of the address string may reference any number of
3287 environment variables by preceding their name with a dollar
3288 sign ('$') and optionally enclosing them with braces ('{}'),
3289 similarly to what is done in Bourne shell.
3290
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003291 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
3292
3293 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
3294 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
3295 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
3296
3297 <level> is optional and can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By
3298 default, all messages are sent. If a level is specified, only
3299 messages with a severity at least as important as this level
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02003300 will be sent. An optional minimum level can be specified. If it
3301 is set, logs emitted with a more severe level than this one will
3302 be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending "emerg"
3303 messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
3304 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003305
3306 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
3307
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02003308 It is important to keep in mind that it is the frontend which decides what to
3309 log from a connection, and that in case of content switching, the log entries
3310 from the backend will be ignored. Connections are logged at level "info".
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01003311
3312 However, backend log declaration define how and where servers status changes
3313 will be logged. Level "notice" will be used to indicate a server going up,
3314 "warning" will be used for termination signals and definitive service
3315 termination, and "alert" will be used for when a server goes down.
3316
3317 Note : According to RFC3164, messages are truncated to 1024 bytes before
3318 being emitted.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003319
3320 Example :
3321 log global
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02003322 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice # only send important events
3323 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice notice # same but limit output level
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01003324 log ${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514 local0 notice # send to local server
3325
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003326
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01003327log-format <string>
3328 Allows you to custom a log line.
3329
3330 See also : Custom Log Format (8.2.4)
3331
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003332
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02003333max-keep-alive-queue <value>
3334 Set the maximum server queue size for maintaining keep-alive connections
3335 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3336 yes | no | yes | yes
3337
3338 HTTP keep-alive tries to reuse the same server connection whenever possible,
3339 but sometimes it can be counter-productive, for example if a server has a lot
3340 of connections while other ones are idle. This is especially true for static
3341 servers.
3342
3343 The purpose of this setting is to set a threshold on the number of queued
3344 connections at which haproxy stops trying to reuse the same server and prefers
3345 to find another one. The default value, -1, means there is no limit. A value
3346 of zero means that keep-alive requests will never be queued. For very close
3347 servers which can be reached with a low latency and which are not sensible to
3348 breaking keep-alive, a low value is recommended (eg: local static server can
3349 use a value of 10 or less). For remote servers suffering from a high latency,
3350 higher values might be needed to cover for the latency and/or the cost of
3351 picking a different server.
3352
3353 Note that this has no impact on responses which are maintained to the same
3354 server consecutively to a 401 response. They will still go to the same server
3355 even if they have to be queued.
3356
3357 See also : "option http-server-close", "option prefer-last-server", server
3358 "maxconn" and cookie persistence.
3359
3360
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003361maxconn <conns>
3362 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a frontend
3363 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3364 yes | yes | yes | no
3365 Arguments :
3366 <conns> is the maximum number of concurrent connections the frontend will
3367 accept to serve. Excess connections will be queued by the system
3368 in the socket's listen queue and will be served once a connection
3369 closes.
3370
3371 If the system supports it, it can be useful on big sites to raise this limit
3372 very high so that haproxy manages connection queues, instead of leaving the
3373 clients with unanswered connection attempts. This value should not exceed the
3374 global maxconn. Also, keep in mind that a connection contains two buffers
3375 of 8kB each, as well as some other data resulting in about 17 kB of RAM being
3376 consumed per established connection. That means that a medium system equipped
3377 with 1GB of RAM can withstand around 40000-50000 concurrent connections if
3378 properly tuned.
3379
3380 Also, when <conns> is set to large values, it is possible that the servers
3381 are not sized to accept such loads, and for this reason it is generally wise
3382 to assign them some reasonable connection limits.
3383
Vincent Bernat6341be52012-06-27 17:18:30 +02003384 By default, this value is set to 2000.
3385
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003386 See also : "server", global section's "maxconn", "fullconn"
3387
3388
3389mode { tcp|http|health }
3390 Set the running mode or protocol of the instance
3391 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3392 yes | yes | yes | yes
3393 Arguments :
3394 tcp The instance will work in pure TCP mode. A full-duplex connection
3395 will be established between clients and servers, and no layer 7
3396 examination will be performed. This is the default mode. It
3397 should be used for SSL, SSH, SMTP, ...
3398
3399 http The instance will work in HTTP mode. The client request will be
3400 analyzed in depth before connecting to any server. Any request
3401 which is not RFC-compliant will be rejected. Layer 7 filtering,
3402 processing and switching will be possible. This is the mode which
3403 brings HAProxy most of its value.
3404
3405 health The instance will work in "health" mode. It will just reply "OK"
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02003406 to incoming connections and close the connection. Alternatively,
3407 If the "httpchk" option is set, "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" will be sent
3408 instead. Nothing will be logged in either case. This mode is used
3409 to reply to external components health checks. This mode is
3410 deprecated and should not be used anymore as it is possible to do
3411 the same and even better by combining TCP or HTTP modes with the
3412 "monitor" keyword.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003413
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02003414 When doing content switching, it is mandatory that the frontend and the
3415 backend are in the same mode (generally HTTP), otherwise the configuration
3416 will be refused.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003417
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02003418 Example :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003419 defaults http_instances
3420 mode http
3421
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02003422 See also : "monitor", "monitor-net"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003423
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003424
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01003425monitor fail { if | unless } <condition>
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003426 Add a condition to report a failure to a monitor HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003427 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3428 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003429 Arguments :
3430 if <cond> the monitor request will fail if the condition is satisfied,
3431 and will succeed otherwise. The condition should describe a
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003432 combined test which must induce a failure if all conditions
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003433 are met, for instance a low number of servers both in a
3434 backend and its backup.
3435
3436 unless <cond> the monitor request will succeed only if the condition is
3437 satisfied, and will fail otherwise. Such a condition may be
3438 based on a test on the presence of a minimum number of active
3439 servers in a list of backends.
3440
3441 This statement adds a condition which can force the response to a monitor
3442 request to report a failure. By default, when an external component queries
3443 the URI dedicated to monitoring, a 200 response is returned. When one of the
3444 conditions above is met, haproxy will return 503 instead of 200. This is
3445 very useful to report a site failure to an external component which may base
3446 routing advertisements between multiple sites on the availability reported by
3447 haproxy. In this case, one would rely on an ACL involving the "nbsrv"
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003448 criterion. Note that "monitor fail" only works in HTTP mode. Both status
3449 messages may be tweaked using "errorfile" or "errorloc" if needed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003450
3451 Example:
3452 frontend www
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003453 mode http
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003454 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
3455 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
3456 monitor-uri /site_alive
3457 monitor fail if site_dead
3458
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003459 See also : "monitor-net", "monitor-uri", "errorfile", "errorloc"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003460
3461
3462monitor-net <source>
3463 Declare a source network which is limited to monitor requests
3464 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3465 yes | yes | yes | no
3466 Arguments :
3467 <source> is the source IPv4 address or network which will only be able to
3468 get monitor responses to any request. It can be either an IPv4
3469 address, a host name, or an address followed by a slash ('/')
3470 followed by a mask.
3471
3472 In TCP mode, any connection coming from a source matching <source> will cause
3473 the connection to be immediately closed without any log. This allows another
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003474 equipment to probe the port and verify that it is still listening, without
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003475 forwarding the connection to a remote server.
3476
3477 In HTTP mode, a connection coming from a source matching <source> will be
3478 accepted, the following response will be sent without waiting for a request,
3479 then the connection will be closed : "HTTP/1.0 200 OK". This is normally
3480 enough for any front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02003481 running without forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that this
3482 response is sent in raw format, without any transformation. This is important
3483 as it means that it will not be SSL-encrypted on SSL listeners.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003484
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02003485 Monitor requests are processed very early, just after tcp-request connection
3486 ACLs which are the only ones able to block them. These connections are short
3487 lived and never wait for any data from the client. They cannot be logged, and
3488 it is the intended purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to
3489 an upper component, nothing more. Please note that "monitor fail" rules do
3490 not apply to connections intercepted by "monitor-net".
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003491
Willy Tarreau95cd2832010-03-04 23:36:33 +01003492 Last, please note that only one "monitor-net" statement can be specified in
3493 a frontend. If more than one is found, only the last one will be considered.
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02003494
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003495 Example :
3496 # addresses .252 and .253 are just probing us.
3497 frontend www
3498 monitor-net 192.168.0.252/31
3499
3500 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-uri"
3501
3502
3503monitor-uri <uri>
3504 Intercept a URI used by external components' monitor requests
3505 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3506 yes | yes | yes | no
3507 Arguments :
3508 <uri> is the exact URI which we want to intercept to return HAProxy's
3509 health status instead of forwarding the request.
3510
3511 When an HTTP request referencing <uri> will be received on a frontend,
3512 HAProxy will not forward it nor log it, but instead will return either
3513 "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" or "HTTP/1.0 503 Service unavailable", depending on failure
3514 conditions defined with "monitor fail". This is normally enough for any
3515 front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and running without
3516 forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that the HTTP method, the
3517 version and all headers are ignored, but the request must at least be valid
3518 at the HTTP level. This keyword may only be used with an HTTP-mode frontend.
3519
3520 Monitor requests are processed very early. It is not possible to block nor
3521 divert them using ACLs. They cannot be logged either, and it is the intended
3522 purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to an upper component,
3523 nothing more. However, it is possible to add any number of conditions using
3524 "monitor fail" and ACLs so that the result can be adjusted to whatever check
3525 can be imagined (most often the number of available servers in a backend).
3526
3527 Example :
3528 # Use /haproxy_test to report haproxy's status
3529 frontend www
3530 mode http
3531 monitor-uri /haproxy_test
3532
3533 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-net"
3534
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003535
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003536option abortonclose
3537no option abortonclose
3538 Enable or disable early dropping of aborted requests pending in queues.
3539 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3540 yes | no | yes | yes
3541 Arguments : none
3542
3543 In presence of very high loads, the servers will take some time to respond.
3544 The per-instance connection queue will inflate, and the response time will
3545 increase respective to the size of the queue times the average per-session
3546 response time. When clients will wait for more than a few seconds, they will
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003547 often hit the "STOP" button on their browser, leaving a useless request in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003548 the queue, and slowing down other users, and the servers as well, because the
3549 request will eventually be served, then aborted at the first error
3550 encountered while delivering the response.
3551
3552 As there is no way to distinguish between a full STOP and a simple output
3553 close on the client side, HTTP agents should be conservative and consider
3554 that the client might only have closed its output channel while waiting for
3555 the response. However, this introduces risks of congestion when lots of users
3556 do the same, and is completely useless nowadays because probably no client at
3557 all will close the session while waiting for the response. Some HTTP agents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003558 support this behaviour (Squid, Apache, HAProxy), and others do not (TUX, most
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003559 hardware-based load balancers). So the probability for a closed input channel
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003560 to represent a user hitting the "STOP" button is close to 100%, and the risk
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003561 of being the single component to break rare but valid traffic is extremely
3562 low, which adds to the temptation to be able to abort a session early while
3563 still not served and not pollute the servers.
3564
3565 In HAProxy, the user can choose the desired behaviour using the option
3566 "abortonclose". By default (without the option) the behaviour is HTTP
3567 compliant and aborted requests will be served. But when the option is
3568 specified, a session with an incoming channel closed will be aborted while
3569 it is still possible, either pending in the queue for a connection slot, or
3570 during the connection establishment if the server has not yet acknowledged
3571 the connection request. This considerably reduces the queue size and the load
3572 on saturated servers when users are tempted to click on STOP, which in turn
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003573 reduces the response time for other users.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003574
3575 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3576 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3577
3578 See also : "timeout queue" and server's "maxconn" and "maxqueue" parameters
3579
3580
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02003581option accept-invalid-http-request
3582no option accept-invalid-http-request
3583 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP request parsing
3584 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3585 yes | yes | yes | no
3586 Arguments : none
3587
3588 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC2616 in terms of message parsing. This
3589 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
3590 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behaviour as such
3591 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
3592 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
3593 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
3594 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
3595 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01003596 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. Similarly, the
3597 list of characters allowed to appear in a URI is well defined by RFC3986, and
3598 chars 0-31, 32 (space), 34 ('"'), 60 ('<'), 62 ('>'), 92 ('\'), 94 ('^'), 96
3599 ('`'), 123 ('{'), 124 ('|'), 125 ('}'), 127 (delete) and anything above are
3600 not allowed at all. Haproxy always blocks a number of them (0..32, 127). The
3601 remaining ones are blocked by default unless this option is enabled.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02003602
3603 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
3604 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
3605 been confirmed.
3606
3607 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
3608 requests, but the complete request will be captured in order to permit later
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01003609 analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket. Similarly,
3610 requests containing invalid chars in the URI part will be logged. Doing this
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02003611 also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
3612
3613 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3614 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3615
3616 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-response" and "show errors" on the
3617 stats socket.
3618
3619
3620option accept-invalid-http-response
3621no option accept-invalid-http-response
3622 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP response parsing
3623 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3624 yes | no | yes | yes
3625 Arguments : none
3626
3627 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC2616 in terms of message parsing. This
3628 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
3629 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behaviour as such
3630 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
3631 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
3632 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
3633 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
3634 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
3635 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option.
3636
3637 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
3638 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
3639 been confirmed.
3640
3641 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
3642 responses, but the complete response will be captured in order to permit
3643 later analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket.
3644 Doing this also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
3645
3646 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3647 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3648
3649 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-request" and "show errors" on the
3650 stats socket.
3651
3652
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003653option allbackups
3654no option allbackups
3655 Use either all backup servers at a time or only the first one
3656 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3657 yes | no | yes | yes
3658 Arguments : none
3659
3660 By default, the first operational backup server gets all traffic when normal
3661 servers are all down. Sometimes, it may be preferred to use multiple backups
3662 at once, because one will not be enough. When "option allbackups" is enabled,
3663 the load balancing will be performed among all backup servers when all normal
3664 ones are unavailable. The same load balancing algorithm will be used and the
3665 servers' weights will be respected. Thus, there will not be any priority
3666 order between the backup servers anymore.
3667
3668 This option is mostly used with static server farms dedicated to return a
3669 "sorry" page when an application is completely offline.
3670
3671 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3672 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3673
3674
3675option checkcache
3676no option checkcache
Godbach7056a352013-12-11 20:01:07 +08003677 Analyze all server responses and block responses with cacheable cookies
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003678 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3679 yes | no | yes | yes
3680 Arguments : none
3681
3682 Some high-level frameworks set application cookies everywhere and do not
3683 always let enough control to the developer to manage how the responses should
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003684 be cached. When a session cookie is returned on a cacheable object, there is a
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003685 high risk of session crossing or stealing between users traversing the same
3686 caches. In some situations, it is better to block the response than to let
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02003687 some sensitive session information go in the wild.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003688
3689 The option "checkcache" enables deep inspection of all server responses for
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003690 strict compliance with HTTP specification in terms of cacheability. It
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003691 carefully checks "Cache-control", "Pragma" and "Set-cookie" headers in server
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003692 response to check if there's a risk of caching a cookie on a client-side
3693 proxy. When this option is enabled, the only responses which can be delivered
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003694 to the client are :
3695 - all those without "Set-Cookie" header ;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003696 - all those with a return code other than 200, 203, 206, 300, 301, 410,
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003697 provided that the server has not set a "Cache-control: public" header ;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003698 - all those that come from a POST request, provided that the server has not
3699 set a 'Cache-Control: public' header ;
3700 - those with a 'Pragma: no-cache' header
3701 - those with a 'Cache-control: private' header
3702 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-store' header
3703 - those with a 'Cache-control: max-age=0' header
3704 - those with a 'Cache-control: s-maxage=0' header
3705 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache' header
3706 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie"' header
3707 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie,' header
3708 (allowing other fields after set-cookie)
3709
3710 If a response doesn't respect these requirements, then it will be blocked
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003711 just as if it was from an "rspdeny" filter, with an "HTTP 502 bad gateway".
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003712 The session state shows "PH--" meaning that the proxy blocked the response
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003713 during headers processing. Additionally, an alert will be sent in the logs so
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003714 that admins are informed that there's something to be fixed.
3715
3716 Due to the high impact on the application, the application should be tested
3717 in depth with the option enabled before going to production. It is also a
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003718 good practice to always activate it during tests, even if it is not used in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003719 production, as it will report potentially dangerous application behaviours.
3720
3721 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3722 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3723
3724
3725option clitcpka
3726no option clitcpka
3727 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the client side
3728 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3729 yes | yes | yes | no
3730 Arguments : none
3731
3732 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
3733 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
3734 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
3735 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
3736
3737 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
3738 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
3739 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
3740 operating system and its tuning parameters.
3741
3742 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
3743 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
3744 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
3745 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
3746 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
3747
3748 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
3749
3750 Using option "clitcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
3751 client side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
3752 noticed between HAProxy and a client.
3753
3754 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3755 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3756
3757 See also : "option srvtcpka", "option tcpka"
3758
3759
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003760option contstats
3761 Enable continuous traffic statistics updates
3762 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3763 yes | yes | yes | no
3764 Arguments : none
3765
3766 By default, counters used for statistics calculation are incremented
3767 only when a session finishes. It works quite well when serving small
3768 objects, but with big ones (for example large images or archives) or
3769 with A/V streaming, a graph generated from haproxy counters looks like
3770 a hedgehog. With this option enabled counters get incremented continuously,
3771 during a whole session. Recounting touches a hotpath directly so
3772 it is not enabled by default, as it has small performance impact (~0.5%).
3773
3774
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02003775option dontlog-normal
3776no option dontlog-normal
3777 Enable or disable logging of normal, successful connections
3778 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3779 yes | yes | yes | no
3780 Arguments : none
3781
3782 There are large sites dealing with several thousand connections per second
3783 and for which logging is a major pain. Some of them are even forced to turn
3784 logs off and cannot debug production issues. Setting this option ensures that
3785 normal connections, those which experience no error, no timeout, no retry nor
3786 redispatch, will not be logged. This leaves disk space for anomalies. In HTTP
3787 mode, the response status code is checked and return codes 5xx will still be
3788 logged.
3789
3790 It is strongly discouraged to use this option as most of the time, the key to
3791 complex issues is in the normal logs which will not be logged here. If you
3792 need to separate logs, see the "log-separate-errors" option instead.
3793
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003794 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "log-separate-errors" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02003795 logging.
3796
3797
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003798option dontlognull
3799no option dontlognull
3800 Enable or disable logging of null connections
3801 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3802 yes | yes | yes | no
3803 Arguments : none
3804
3805 In certain environments, there are components which will regularly connect to
3806 various systems to ensure that they are still alive. It can be the case from
3807 another load balancer as well as from monitoring systems. By default, even a
3808 simple port probe or scan will produce a log. If those connections pollute
3809 the logs too much, it is possible to enable option "dontlognull" to indicate
3810 that a connection on which no data has been transferred will not be logged,
3811 which typically corresponds to those probes.
3812
3813 It is generally recommended not to use this option in uncontrolled
3814 environments (eg: internet), otherwise scans and other malicious activities
3815 would not be logged.
3816
3817 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3818 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3819
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003820 See also : "log", "monitor-net", "monitor-uri" and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003821
3822
3823option forceclose
3824no option forceclose
3825 Enable or disable active connection closing after response is transferred.
3826 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaua31e5df2009-12-30 01:10:35 +01003827 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003828 Arguments : none
3829
3830 Some HTTP servers do not necessarily close the connections when they receive
3831 the "Connection: close" set by "option httpclose", and if the client does not
3832 close either, then the connection remains open till the timeout expires. This
3833 causes high number of simultaneous connections on the servers and shows high
3834 global session times in the logs.
3835
3836 When this happens, it is possible to use "option forceclose". It will
Willy Tarreau82eeaf22009-12-29 12:09:05 +01003837 actively close the outgoing server channel as soon as the server has finished
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01003838 to respond and release some resources earlier than with "option httpclose".
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003839
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02003840 This option may also be combined with "option http-pretend-keepalive", which
3841 will disable sending of the "Connection: close" header, but will still cause
3842 the connection to be closed once the whole response is received.
3843
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01003844 This option disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose", "option
3845 http-server-close", "option http-keep-alive", or "option http-tunnel".
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01003846
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003847 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
3848 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
3849
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02003850 See also : "option httpclose" and "option http-pretend-keepalive"
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01003851
3852
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02003853option forwardfor [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ] [ if-none ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003854 Enable insertion of the X-Forwarded-For header to requests sent to servers
3855 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3856 yes | yes | yes | yes
3857 Arguments :
3858 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
3859 matching <network>
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003860 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Forwarded-For"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003861 header name.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003862
3863 Since HAProxy works in reverse-proxy mode, the servers see its IP address as
3864 their client address. This is sometimes annoying when the client's IP address
3865 is expected in server logs. To solve this problem, the well-known HTTP header
3866 "X-Forwarded-For" may be added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server.
3867 This header contains a value representing the client's IP address. Since this
3868 header is always appended at the end of the existing header list, the server
3869 must be configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. See
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003870 the server's manual to find how to enable use of this standard header. Note
3871 that only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
3872 possible that the client has already brought one.
3873
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003874 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003875 the default "X-Forwarded-For". This can be useful where you might already
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003876 have a "X-Forwarded-For" header from a different application (eg: stunnel),
3877 and you need preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003878 "X-Forwarded-For" header and requires different one (eg: Zeus Web Servers
3879 require "X-Cluster-Client-IP").
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003880
3881 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
3882 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
3883 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
3884 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
3885 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
3886 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
3887 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
3888
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02003889 Alternatively, the keyword "if-none" states that the header will only be
3890 added if it is not present. This should only be used in perfectly trusted
3891 environment, as this might cause a security issue if headers reaching haproxy
3892 are under the control of the end-user.
3893
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003894 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003895 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
3896 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02003897 both are defined. In the case of the "if-none" argument, if at least one of
3898 the frontend or the backend does not specify it, it wants the addition to be
3899 mandatory, so it wins.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003900
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003901 Examples :
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003902 # Public HTTP address also used by stunnel on the same machine
3903 frontend www
3904 mode http
3905 option forwardfor except 127.0.0.1 # stunnel already adds the header
3906
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02003907 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client
3908 backend www
3909 mode http
3910 option forwardfor header X-Client
3911
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02003912 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003913 "option forceclose", "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003914
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02003915
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01003916option http-keep-alive
3917no option http-keep-alive
3918 Enable or disable HTTP keep-alive from client to server
3919 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3920 yes | yes | yes | yes
3921 Arguments : none
3922
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003923 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
3924 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
3925 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and the
3926 start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such as
3927 "option http-server-close", "option forceclose", "option httpclose" or
3928 "option http-tunnel". This option allows to set back the keep-alive mode,
3929 which can be useful when another mode was used in a defaults section.
3930
3931 Setting "option http-keep-alive" enables HTTP keep-alive mode on the client-
3932 and server- sides. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01003933 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side at the expense
3934 of maintaining idle connections to the servers. In general, it is possible
3935 with this option to achieve approximately twice the request rate that the
3936 "http-server-close" option achieves on small objects. There are mainly two
3937 situations where this option may be useful :
3938
3939 - when the server is non-HTTP compliant and authenticates the connection
3940 instead of requests (eg: NTLM authentication)
3941
3942 - when the cost of establishing the connection to the server is significant
3943 compared to the cost of retrieving the associated object from the server.
3944
3945 This last case can happen when the server is a fast static server of cache.
3946 In this case, the server will need to be properly tuned to support high enough
3947 connection counts because connections will last until the client sends another
3948 request.
3949
3950 If the client request has to go to another backend or another server due to
3951 content switching or the load balancing algorithm, the idle connection will
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01003952 immediately be closed and a new one re-opened. Option "prefer-last-server" is
3953 available to try optimize server selection so that if the server currently
3954 attached to an idle connection is usable, it will be used.
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01003955
3956 In general it is preferred to use "option http-server-close" with application
3957 servers, and some static servers might benefit from "option http-keep-alive".
3958
3959 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
3960 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
3961 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
3962 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
3963 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
3964 not set.
3965
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01003966 This option disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose", "option
3967 http-server-close", "option forceclose" or "option http-tunnel". When backend
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003968 and frontend options differ, all of these 4 options have precedence over
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01003969 "option http-keep-alive".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01003970
3971 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close",
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01003972 "option prefer-last-server", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
3973 "option httpclose", and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01003974
3975
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02003976option http-no-delay
3977no option http-no-delay
3978 Instruct the system to favor low interactive delays over performance in HTTP
3979 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3980 yes | yes | yes | yes
3981 Arguments : none
3982
3983 In HTTP, each payload is unidirectional and has no notion of interactivity.
3984 Any agent is expected to queue data somewhat for a reasonably low delay.
3985 There are some very rare server-to-server applications that abuse the HTTP
3986 protocol and expect the payload phase to be highly interactive, with many
3987 interleaved data chunks in both directions within a single request. This is
3988 absolutely not supported by the HTTP specification and will not work across
3989 most proxies or servers. When such applications attempt to do this through
3990 haproxy, it works but they will experience high delays due to the network
3991 optimizations which favor performance by instructing the system to wait for
3992 enough data to be available in order to only send full packets. Typical
3993 delays are around 200 ms per round trip. Note that this only happens with
3994 abnormal uses. Normal uses such as CONNECT requests nor WebSockets are not
3995 affected.
3996
3997 When "option http-no-delay" is present in either the frontend or the backend
3998 used by a connection, all such optimizations will be disabled in order to
3999 make the exchanges as fast as possible. Of course this offers no guarantee on
4000 the functionality, as it may break at any other place. But if it works via
4001 HAProxy, it will work as fast as possible. This option should never be used
4002 by default, and should never be used at all unless such a buggy application
4003 is discovered. The impact of using this option is an increase of bandwidth
4004 usage and CPU usage, which may significantly lower performance in high
4005 latency environments.
4006
4007
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02004008option http-pretend-keepalive
4009no option http-pretend-keepalive
4010 Define whether haproxy will announce keepalive to the server or not
4011 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4012 yes | yes | yes | yes
4013 Arguments : none
4014
4015 When running with "option http-server-close" or "option forceclose", haproxy
4016 adds a "Connection: close" header to the request forwarded to the server.
4017 Unfortunately, when some servers see this header, they automatically refrain
4018 from using the chunked encoding for responses of unknown length, while this
4019 is totally unrelated. The immediate effect is that this prevents haproxy from
4020 maintaining the client connection alive. A second effect is that a client or
4021 a cache could receive an incomplete response without being aware of it, and
4022 consider the response complete.
4023
4024 By setting "option http-pretend-keepalive", haproxy will make the server
4025 believe it will keep the connection alive. The server will then not fall back
4026 to the abnormal undesired above. When haproxy gets the whole response, it
4027 will close the connection with the server just as it would do with the
4028 "forceclose" option. That way the client gets a normal response and the
4029 connection is correctly closed on the server side.
4030
4031 It is recommended not to enable this option by default, because most servers
4032 will more efficiently close the connection themselves after the last packet,
4033 and release its buffers slightly earlier. Also, the added packet on the
4034 network could slightly reduce the overall peak performance. However it is
4035 worth noting that when this option is enabled, haproxy will have slightly
4036 less work to do. So if haproxy is the bottleneck on the whole architecture,
4037 enabling this option might save a few CPU cycles.
4038
4039 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
4040 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004041 This option may be combined with "option httpclose", which will cause
Willy Tarreau22a95342010-09-29 14:31:41 +02004042 keepalive to be announced to the server and close to be announced to the
4043 client. This practice is discouraged though.
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02004044
4045 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4046 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4047
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01004048 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close", and
4049 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02004050
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004051
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01004052option http-server-close
4053no option http-server-close
4054 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing on the server side
4055 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4056 yes | yes | yes | yes
4057 Arguments : none
4058
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004059 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
4060 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
4061 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
4062 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
4063 as "option http-server-close", "option forceclose", "option httpclose" or
4064 "option http-tunnel". Setting "option http-server-close" enables HTTP
4065 connection-close mode on the server side while keeping the ability to support
4066 HTTP keep-alive and pipelining on the client side. This provides the lowest
4067 latency on the client side (slow network) and the fastest session reuse on
4068 the server side to save server resources, similarly to "option forceclose".
4069 It also permits non-keepalive capable servers to be served in keep-alive mode
4070 to the clients if they conform to the requirements of RFC2616. Please note
4071 that some servers do not always conform to those requirements when they see
4072 "Connection: close" in the request. The effect will be that keep-alive will
4073 never be used. A workaround consists in enabling "option
4074 http-pretend-keepalive".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01004075
4076 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
4077 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
4078 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
4079 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01004080 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
4081 not set.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01004082
4083 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
4084 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01004085 It disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose", "option forceclose",
4086 "option http-tunnel" or "option http-keep-alive". Please check section 4
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004087 ("Proxies") to see how this option combines with others when frontend and
4088 backend options differ.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01004089
4090 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4091 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4092
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02004093 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01004094 "option httpclose", "option http-keep-alive", and
4095 "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01004096
4097
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01004098option http-tunnel
4099no option http-tunnel
4100 Disable or enable HTTP connection processing after first transaction
4101 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4102 yes | yes | yes | yes
4103 Arguments : none
4104
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004105 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
4106 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
4107 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
4108 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
4109 as "option http-server-close", "option forceclose", "option httpclose" or
4110 "option http-tunnel".
4111
4112 Option "http-tunnel" disables any HTTP processing past the first request and
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03004113 the first response. This is the mode which was used by default in versions
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004114 1.0 to 1.5-dev21. It is the mode with the lowest processing overhead, which
4115 is normally not needed anymore unless in very specific cases such as when
4116 using an in-house protocol that looks like HTTP but is not compatible, or
4117 just to log one request per client in order to reduce log size. Note that
4118 everything which works at the HTTP level, including header parsing/addition,
4119 cookie processing or content switching will only work for the first request
4120 and will be ignored after the first response.
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01004121
4122 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4123 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4124
4125 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close",
4126 "option httpclose", "option http-keep-alive", and
4127 "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
4128
4129
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01004130option http-use-proxy-header
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01004131no option http-use-proxy-header
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01004132 Make use of non-standard Proxy-Connection header instead of Connection
4133 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4134 yes | yes | yes | no
4135 Arguments : none
4136
4137 While RFC2616 explicitly states that HTTP/1.1 agents must use the
4138 Connection header to indicate their wish of persistent or non-persistent
4139 connections, both browsers and proxies ignore this header for proxied
4140 connections and make use of the undocumented, non-standard Proxy-Connection
4141 header instead. The issue begins when trying to put a load balancer between
4142 browsers and such proxies, because there will be a difference between what
4143 haproxy understands and what the client and the proxy agree on.
4144
4145 By setting this option in a frontend, haproxy can automatically switch to use
4146 that non-standard header if it sees proxied requests. A proxied request is
4147 defined here as one where the URI begins with neither a '/' nor a '*'. The
4148 choice of header only affects requests passing through proxies making use of
4149 one of the "httpclose", "forceclose" and "http-server-close" options. Note
4150 that this option can only be specified in a frontend and will affect the
4151 request along its whole life.
4152
Willy Tarreau844a7e72010-01-31 21:46:18 +01004153 Also, when this option is set, a request which requires authentication will
4154 automatically switch to use proxy authentication headers if it is itself a
4155 proxied request. That makes it possible to check or enforce authentication in
4156 front of an existing proxy.
4157
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01004158 This option should normally never be used, except in front of a proxy.
4159
4160 See also : "option httpclose", "option forceclose" and "option
4161 http-server-close".
4162
4163
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01004164option httpchk
4165option httpchk <uri>
4166option httpchk <method> <uri>
4167option httpchk <method> <uri> <version>
4168 Enable HTTP protocol to check on the servers health
4169 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4170 yes | no | yes | yes
4171 Arguments :
4172 <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not set,
4173 the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires low server
4174 processing and is easy to filter out from the logs. Any method
4175 may be used, though it is not recommended to invent non-standard
4176 ones.
4177
4178 <uri> is the URI referenced in the HTTP requests. It defaults to " / "
4179 which is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
4180 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
4181
4182 <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to "HTTP/1.0"
4183 but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP 1.0, so turning
4184 it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that the Host field is
4185 mandatory in HTTP/1.1, and as a trick, it is possible to pass it
4186 after "\r\n" following the version string.
4187
4188 By default, server health checks only consist in trying to establish a TCP
4189 connection. When "option httpchk" is specified, a complete HTTP request is
4190 sent once the TCP connection is established, and responses 2xx and 3xx are
4191 considered valid, while all other ones indicate a server failure, including
4192 the lack of any response.
4193
4194 The port and interval are specified in the server configuration.
4195
4196 This option does not necessarily require an HTTP backend, it also works with
4197 plain TCP backends. This is particularly useful to check simple scripts bound
4198 to some dedicated ports using the inetd daemon.
4199
4200 Examples :
4201 # Relay HTTPS traffic to Apache instance and check service availability
4202 # using HTTP request "OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1" on port 80.
4203 backend https_relay
4204 mode tcp
4205 option httpchk OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1\r\nHost:\ www
4206 server apache1 192.168.1.1:443 check port 80
4207
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +09004208 See also : "option ssl-hello-chk", "option smtpchk", "option mysql-check",
4209 "option pgsql-check", "http-check" and the "check", "port" and
4210 "inter" server options.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01004211
4212
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004213option httpclose
4214no option httpclose
4215 Enable or disable passive HTTP connection closing
4216 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4217 yes | yes | yes | yes
4218 Arguments : none
4219
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004220 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
4221 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
4222 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
4223 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01004224 as "option http-server-close", "option forceclose", "option httpclose" or
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004225 "option http-tunnel".
4226
4227 If "option httpclose" is set, HAProxy will work in HTTP tunnel mode and check
4228 if a "Connection: close" header is already set in each direction, and will
4229 add one if missing. Each end should react to this by actively closing the TCP
4230 connection after each transfer, thus resulting in a switch to the HTTP close
4231 mode. Any "Connection" header different from "close" will also be removed.
4232 Note that this option is deprecated since what it does is very cheap but not
4233 reliable. Using "option http-server-close" or "option forceclose" is strongly
4234 recommended instead.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004235
4236 It seldom happens that some servers incorrectly ignore this header and do not
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004237 close the connection even though they reply "Connection: close". For this
Willy Tarreau0dfdf192010-01-05 11:33:11 +01004238 reason, they are not compatible with older HTTP 1.0 browsers. If this happens
4239 it is possible to use the "option forceclose" which actively closes the
4240 request connection once the server responds. Option "forceclose" also
4241 releases the server connection earlier because it does not have to wait for
4242 the client to acknowledge it.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004243
4244 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
4245 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01004246 It disables and replaces any previous "option http-server-close",
4247 "option forceclose", "option http-keep-alive" or "option http-tunnel". Please
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004248 check section 4 ("Proxies") to see how this option combines with others when
4249 frontend and backend options differ.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004250
4251 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4252 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4253
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02004254 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close" and
4255 "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004256
4257
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02004258option httplog [ clf ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004259 Enable logging of HTTP request, session state and timers
4260 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4261 yes | yes | yes | yes
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02004262 Arguments :
4263 clf if the "clf" argument is added, then the output format will be
4264 the CLF format instead of HAProxy's default HTTP format. You can
4265 use this when you need to feed HAProxy's logs through a specific
4266 log analyser which only support the CLF format and which is not
4267 extensible.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004268
4269 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
4270 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
4271 "option httplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including,
4272 but not limited to, the HTTP request, the connection timers, the session
4273 status, the connections numbers, the captured headers and cookies, the
4274 frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source address and
4275 ports.
4276
4277 This option may be set either in the frontend or the backend.
4278
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02004279 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4280 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it. Specifying
4281 only "option httplog" will automatically clear the 'clf' mode if it was set
4282 by default.
4283
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004284 See also : section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004285
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02004286
4287option http_proxy
4288no option http_proxy
4289 Enable or disable plain HTTP proxy mode
4290 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4291 yes | yes | yes | yes
4292 Arguments : none
4293
4294 It sometimes happens that people need a pure HTTP proxy which understands
4295 basic proxy requests without caching nor any fancy feature. In this case,
4296 it may be worth setting up an HAProxy instance with the "option http_proxy"
4297 set. In this mode, no server is declared, and the connection is forwarded to
4298 the IP address and port found in the URL after the "http://" scheme.
4299
4300 No host address resolution is performed, so this only works when pure IP
4301 addresses are passed. Since this option's usage perimeter is rather limited,
4302 it will probably be used only by experts who know they need exactly it. Last,
4303 if the clients are susceptible of sending keep-alive requests, it will be
Cyril Bonté2409e682010-12-14 22:47:51 +01004304 needed to add "option httpclose" to ensure that all requests will correctly
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02004305 be analyzed.
4306
4307 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4308 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4309
4310 Example :
4311 # this backend understands HTTP proxy requests and forwards them directly.
4312 backend direct_forward
4313 option httpclose
4314 option http_proxy
4315
4316 See also : "option httpclose"
4317
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02004318
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004319option independent-streams
4320no option independent-streams
4321 Enable or disable independent timeout processing for both directions
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02004322 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4323 yes | yes | yes | yes
4324 Arguments : none
4325
4326 By default, when data is sent over a socket, both the write timeout and the
4327 read timeout for that socket are refreshed, because we consider that there is
4328 activity on that socket, and we have no other means of guessing if we should
4329 receive data or not.
4330
4331 While this default behaviour is desirable for almost all applications, there
4332 exists a situation where it is desirable to disable it, and only refresh the
4333 read timeout if there are incoming data. This happens on sessions with large
4334 timeouts and low amounts of exchanged data such as telnet session. If the
4335 server suddenly disappears, the output data accumulates in the system's
4336 socket buffers, both timeouts are correctly refreshed, and there is no way
4337 to know the server does not receive them, so we don't timeout. However, when
4338 the underlying protocol always echoes sent data, it would be enough by itself
4339 to detect the issue using the read timeout. Note that this problem does not
4340 happen with more verbose protocols because data won't accumulate long in the
4341 socket buffers.
4342
4343 When this option is set on the frontend, it will disable read timeout updates
4344 on data sent to the client. There probably is little use of this case. When
4345 the option is set on the backend, it will disable read timeout updates on
4346 data sent to the server. Doing so will typically break large HTTP posts from
4347 slow lines, so use it with caution.
4348
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03004349 Note: older versions used to call this setting "option independent-streams"
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004350 with a spelling mistake. This spelling is still supported but
4351 deprecated.
4352
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02004353 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server" and "timeout tunnel"
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02004354
4355
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02004356option ldap-check
4357 Use LDAPv3 health checks for server testing
4358 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4359 yes | no | yes | yes
4360 Arguments : none
4361
4362 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks LDAPv3 instead of just
4363 testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set, an
4364 LDAPv3 anonymous simple bind message is sent to the server, and the response
4365 is analyzed to find an LDAPv3 bind response message.
4366
4367 The server is considered valid only when the LDAP response contains success
4368 resultCode (http://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc4511#section-4.1.9).
4369
4370 Logging of bind requests is server dependent see your documentation how to
4371 configure it.
4372
4373 Example :
4374 option ldap-check
4375
4376 See also : "option httpchk"
4377
4378
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02004379option log-health-checks
4380no option log-health-checks
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02004381 Enable or disable logging of health checks status updates
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02004382 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4383 yes | no | yes | yes
4384 Arguments : none
4385
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02004386 By default, failed health check are logged if server is UP and successful
4387 health checks are logged if server is DOWN, so the amount of additional
4388 information is limited.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02004389
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02004390 When this option is enabled, any change of the health check status or to
4391 the server's health will be logged, so that it becomes possible to know
4392 that a server was failing occasional checks before crashing, or exactly when
4393 it failed to respond a valid HTTP status, then when the port started to
4394 reject connections, then when the server stopped responding at all.
4395
4396 Note that status changes not caused by health checks (eg: enable/disable on
4397 the CLI) are intentionally not logged by this option.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02004398
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02004399 See also: "option httpchk", "option ldap-check", "option mysql-check",
4400 "option pgsql-check", "option redis-check", "option smtpchk",
4401 "option tcp-check", "log" and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02004402
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02004403
4404option log-separate-errors
4405no option log-separate-errors
4406 Change log level for non-completely successful connections
4407 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4408 yes | yes | yes | no
4409 Arguments : none
4410
4411 Sometimes looking for errors in logs is not easy. This option makes haproxy
4412 raise the level of logs containing potentially interesting information such
4413 as errors, timeouts, retries, redispatches, or HTTP status codes 5xx. The
4414 level changes from "info" to "err". This makes it possible to log them
4415 separately to a different file with most syslog daemons. Be careful not to
4416 remove them from the original file, otherwise you would lose ordering which
4417 provides very important information.
4418
4419 Using this option, large sites dealing with several thousand connections per
4420 second may log normal traffic to a rotating buffer and only archive smaller
4421 error logs.
4422
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004423 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "dontlog-normal" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02004424 logging.
4425
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004426
4427option logasap
4428no option logasap
4429 Enable or disable early logging of HTTP requests
4430 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4431 yes | yes | yes | no
4432 Arguments : none
4433
4434 By default, HTTP requests are logged upon termination so that the total
4435 transfer time and the number of bytes appear in the logs. When large objects
4436 are being transferred, it may take a while before the request appears in the
4437 logs. Using "option logasap", the request gets logged as soon as the server
4438 sends the complete headers. The only missing information in the logs will be
4439 the total number of bytes which will indicate everything except the amount
4440 of data transferred, and the total time which will not take the transfer
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004441 time into account. In such a situation, it's a good practice to capture the
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004442 "Content-Length" response header so that the logs at least indicate how many
4443 bytes are expected to be transferred.
4444
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01004445 Examples :
4446 listen http_proxy 0.0.0.0:80
4447 mode http
4448 option httplog
4449 option logasap
4450 log 192.168.2.200 local3
4451
4452 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
4453 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
4454 static/srv1 9/10/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/1/1/1/0 1/0 \
4455 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
4456
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004457 See also : "option httplog", "capture response header", and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004458 logging.
4459
4460
Nenad Merdanovic6639a7c2014-05-30 14:26:32 +02004461option mysql-check [ user <username> [ post-41 ] ]
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02004462 Use MySQL health checks for server testing
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01004463 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4464 yes | no | yes | yes
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02004465 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02004466 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to MySQL
4467 server.
Nenad Merdanovic6639a7c2014-05-30 14:26:32 +02004468 post-41 Send post v4.1 client compatible checks
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02004469
4470 If you specify a username, the check consists of sending two MySQL packet,
4471 one Client Authentication packet, and one QUIT packet, to correctly close
4472 MySQL session. We then parse the MySQL Handshake Initialisation packet and/or
4473 Error packet. It is a basic but useful test which does not produce error nor
4474 aborted connect on the server. However, it requires adding an authorization
4475 in the MySQL table, like this :
4476
4477 USE mysql;
4478 INSERT INTO user (Host,User) values ('<ip_of_haproxy>','<username>');
4479 FLUSH PRIVILEGES;
4480
4481 If you don't specify a username (it is deprecated and not recommended), the
4482 check only consists in parsing the Mysql Handshake Initialisation packet or
4483 Error packet, we don't send anything in this mode. It was reported that it
4484 can generate lockout if check is too frequent and/or if there is not enough
4485 traffic. In fact, you need in this case to check MySQL "max_connect_errors"
4486 value as if a connection is established successfully within fewer than MySQL
4487 "max_connect_errors" attempts after a previous connection was interrupted,
4488 the error count for the host is cleared to zero. If HAProxy's server get
4489 blocked, the "FLUSH HOSTS" statement is the only way to unblock it.
4490
4491 Remember that this does not check database presence nor database consistency.
4492 To do this, you can use an external check with xinetd for example.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01004493
Hervé COMMOWICK212f7782011-06-10 14:05:59 +02004494 The check requires MySQL >=3.22, for older version, please use TCP check.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01004495
4496 Most often, an incoming MySQL server needs to see the client's IP address for
4497 various purposes, including IP privilege matching and connection logging.
4498 When possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
4499 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
4500 which requires the cttproxy feature to be compiled in, and the MySQL server
4501 to route the client via the machine hosting haproxy.
4502
4503 See also: "option httpchk"
4504
4505
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004506option nolinger
4507no option nolinger
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004508 Enable or disable immediate session resource cleaning after close
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004509 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4510 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004511 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004512
4513 When clients or servers abort connections in a dirty way (eg: they are
4514 physically disconnected), the session timeouts triggers and the session is
4515 closed. But it will remain in FIN_WAIT1 state for some time in the system,
4516 using some resources and possibly limiting the ability to establish newer
4517 connections.
4518
4519 When this happens, it is possible to activate "option nolinger" which forces
4520 the system to immediately remove any socket's pending data on close. Thus,
4521 the session is instantly purged from the system's tables. This usually has
4522 side effects such as increased number of TCP resets due to old retransmits
4523 getting immediately rejected. Some firewalls may sometimes complain about
4524 this too.
4525
4526 For this reason, it is not recommended to use this option when not absolutely
4527 needed. You know that you need it when you have thousands of FIN_WAIT1
4528 sessions on your system (TIME_WAIT ones do not count).
4529
4530 This option may be used both on frontends and backends, depending on the side
4531 where it is required. Use it on the frontend for clients, and on the backend
4532 for servers.
4533
4534 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4535 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4536
4537
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02004538option originalto [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ]
4539 Enable insertion of the X-Original-To header to requests sent to servers
4540 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4541 yes | yes | yes | yes
4542 Arguments :
4543 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
4544 matching <network>
4545 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Original-To"
4546 header name.
4547
4548 Since HAProxy can work in transparent mode, every request from a client can
4549 be redirected to the proxy and HAProxy itself can proxy every request to a
4550 complex SQUID environment and the destination host from SO_ORIGINAL_DST will
4551 be lost. This is annoying when you want access rules based on destination ip
4552 addresses. To solve this problem, a new HTTP header "X-Original-To" may be
4553 added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server. This header contains a
4554 value representing the original destination IP address. Since this must be
4555 configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. Note that
4556 only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
4557 possible that the client has already brought one.
4558
4559 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
4560 the default "X-Original-To". This can be useful where you might already
4561 have a "X-Original-To" header from a different application, and you need
4562 preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the "X-Original-To"
4563 header and requires different one.
4564
4565 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
4566 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
4567 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
4568 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
4569 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
4570 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
4571 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
4572
4573 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
4574 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
4575 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
4576 both are defined.
4577
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02004578 Examples :
4579 # Original Destination address
4580 frontend www
4581 mode http
4582 option originalto except 127.0.0.1
4583
4584 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client-Dst
4585 backend www
4586 mode http
4587 option originalto header X-Client-Dst
4588
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02004589 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
4590 "option forceclose"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02004591
4592
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004593option persist
4594no option persist
4595 Enable or disable forced persistence on down servers
4596 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4597 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004598 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004599
4600 When an HTTP request reaches a backend with a cookie which references a dead
4601 server, by default it is redispatched to another server. It is possible to
4602 force the request to be sent to the dead server first using "option persist"
4603 if absolutely needed. A common use case is when servers are under extreme
4604 load and spend their time flapping. In this case, the users would still be
4605 directed to the server they opened the session on, in the hope they would be
4606 correctly served. It is recommended to use "option redispatch" in conjunction
4607 with this option so that in the event it would not be possible to connect to
4608 the server at all (server definitely dead), the client would finally be
4609 redirected to another valid server.
4610
4611 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4612 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4613
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01004614 See also : "option redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004615
4616
Willy Tarreau0c122822013-12-15 18:49:01 +01004617option pgsql-check [ user <username> ]
4618 Use PostgreSQL health checks for server testing
4619 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4620 yes | no | yes | yes
4621 Arguments :
4622 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to
4623 PostgreSQL server.
4624
4625 The check sends a PostgreSQL StartupMessage and waits for either
4626 Authentication request or ErrorResponse message. It is a basic but useful
4627 test which does not produce error nor aborted connect on the server.
4628 This check is identical with the "mysql-check".
4629
4630 See also: "option httpchk"
4631
4632
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01004633option prefer-last-server
4634no option prefer-last-server
4635 Allow multiple load balanced requests to remain on the same server
4636 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4637 yes | no | yes | yes
4638 Arguments : none
4639
4640 When the load balancing algorithm in use is not deterministic, and a previous
4641 request was sent to a server to which haproxy still holds a connection, it is
4642 sometimes desirable that subsequent requests on a same session go to the same
4643 server as much as possible. Note that this is different from persistence, as
4644 we only indicate a preference which haproxy tries to apply without any form
4645 of warranty. The real use is for keep-alive connections sent to servers. When
4646 this option is used, haproxy will try to reuse the same connection that is
4647 attached to the server instead of rebalancing to another server, causing a
4648 close of the connection. This can make sense for static file servers. It does
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01004649 not make much sense to use this in combination with hashing algorithms. Note,
4650 haproxy already automatically tries to stick to a server which sends a 401 or
4651 to a proxy which sends a 407 (authentication required). This is mandatory for
4652 use with the broken NTLM authentication challenge, and significantly helps in
4653 troubleshooting some faulty applications. Option prefer-last-server might be
4654 desirable in these environments as well, to avoid redistributing the traffic
4655 after every other response.
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01004656
4657 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4658 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4659
4660 See also: "option http-keep-alive"
4661
4662
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004663option redispatch
4664no option redispatch
4665 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
4666 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4667 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01004668 Arguments : none
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004669
4670 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
4671 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
4672 be able to access the service anymore.
4673
4674 Specifying "option redispatch" will allow the proxy to break their
4675 persistence and redistribute them to a working server.
4676
4677 It also allows to retry last connection to another server in case of multiple
4678 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
4679 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004680
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004681 This form is the preferred form, which replaces both the "redispatch" and
4682 "redisp" keywords.
4683
4684 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4685 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4686
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01004687 See also : "redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004688
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004689
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02004690option redis-check
4691 Use redis health checks for server testing
4692 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4693 yes | no | yes | yes
4694 Arguments : none
4695
4696 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks REDIS protocol instead
4697 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
4698 a PING redis command is sent to the server, and the response is analyzed to
4699 find the "+PONG" response message.
4700
4701 Example :
4702 option redis-check
4703
4704 See also : "option httpchk"
4705
4706
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004707option smtpchk
4708option smtpchk <hello> <domain>
4709 Use SMTP health checks for server testing
4710 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4711 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01004712 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004713 <hello> is an optional argument. It is the "hello" command to use. It can
4714 be either "HELO" (for SMTP) or "EHLO" (for ESTMP). All other
4715 values will be turned into the default command ("HELO").
4716
4717 <domain> is the domain name to present to the server. It may only be
4718 specified (and is mandatory) if the hello command has been
4719 specified. By default, "localhost" is used.
4720
4721 When "option smtpchk" is set, the health checks will consist in TCP
4722 connections followed by an SMTP command. By default, this command is
4723 "HELO localhost". The server's return code is analyzed and only return codes
4724 starting with a "2" will be considered as valid. All other responses,
4725 including a lack of response will constitute an error and will indicate a
4726 dead server.
4727
4728 This test is meant to be used with SMTP servers or relays. Depending on the
4729 request, it is possible that some servers do not log each connection attempt,
4730 so you may want to experiment to improve the behaviour. Using telnet on port
4731 25 is often easier than adjusting the configuration.
4732
4733 Most often, an incoming SMTP server needs to see the client's IP address for
4734 various purposes, including spam filtering, anti-spoofing and logging. When
4735 possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
4736 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
4737 which requires the cttproxy feature to be compiled in.
4738
4739 Example :
4740 option smtpchk HELO mydomain.org
4741
4742 See also : "option httpchk", "source"
4743
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01004744
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +02004745option socket-stats
4746no option socket-stats
4747
4748 Enable or disable collecting & providing separate statistics for each socket.
4749 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4750 yes | yes | yes | no
4751
4752 Arguments : none
4753
4754
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01004755option splice-auto
4756no option splice-auto
4757 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets in both directions
4758 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4759 yes | yes | yes | yes
4760 Arguments : none
4761
4762 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
4763 will automatically evaluate the opportunity to use kernel tcp splicing to
4764 forward data between the client and the server, in either direction. Haproxy
4765 uses heuristics to estimate if kernel splicing might improve performance or
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004766 not. Both directions are handled independently. Note that the heuristics used
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01004767 are not much aggressive in order to limit excessive use of splicing. This
4768 option requires splicing to be enabled at compile time, and may be globally
4769 disabled with the global option "nosplice". Since splice uses pipes, using it
4770 requires that there are enough spare pipes.
4771
4772 Important note: kernel-based TCP splicing is a Linux-specific feature which
4773 first appeared in kernel 2.6.25. It offers kernel-based acceleration to
4774 transfer data between sockets without copying these data to user-space, thus
4775 providing noticeable performance gains and CPU cycles savings. Since many
4776 early implementations are buggy, corrupt data and/or are inefficient, this
4777 feature is not enabled by default, and it should be used with extreme care.
4778 While it is not possible to detect the correctness of an implementation,
4779 2.6.29 is the first version offering a properly working implementation. In
4780 case of doubt, splicing may be globally disabled using the global "nosplice"
4781 keyword.
4782
4783 Example :
4784 option splice-auto
4785
4786 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4787 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4788
4789 See also : "option splice-request", "option splice-response", and global
4790 options "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
4791
4792
4793option splice-request
4794no option splice-request
4795 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for requests
4796 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4797 yes | yes | yes | yes
4798 Arguments : none
4799
4800 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004801 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01004802 the client to the server. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
4803 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
4804 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
4805 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
4806
4807 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
4808
4809 Example :
4810 option splice-request
4811
4812 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4813 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4814
4815 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-response", and global options
4816 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
4817
4818
4819option splice-response
4820no option splice-response
4821 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for responses
4822 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4823 yes | yes | yes | yes
4824 Arguments : none
4825
4826 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004827 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01004828 the server to the client. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
4829 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
4830 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
4831 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
4832
4833 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
4834
4835 Example :
4836 option splice-response
4837
4838 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4839 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4840
4841 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-request", and global options
4842 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
4843
4844
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004845option srvtcpka
4846no option srvtcpka
4847 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the server side
4848 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4849 yes | no | yes | yes
4850 Arguments : none
4851
4852 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
4853 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
4854 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
4855 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
4856
4857 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
4858 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
4859 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
4860 operating system and its tuning parameters.
4861
4862 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
4863 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
4864 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
4865 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
4866 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
4867
4868 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
4869
4870 Using option "srvtcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
4871 server side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
4872 noticed between HAProxy and a server.
4873
4874 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
4875 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
4876
4877 See also : "option clitcpka", "option tcpka"
4878
4879
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004880option ssl-hello-chk
4881 Use SSLv3 client hello health checks for server testing
4882 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4883 yes | no | yes | yes
4884 Arguments : none
4885
4886 When some SSL-based protocols are relayed in TCP mode through HAProxy, it is
4887 possible to test that the server correctly talks SSL instead of just testing
4888 that it accepts the TCP connection. When "option ssl-hello-chk" is set, pure
4889 SSLv3 client hello messages are sent once the connection is established to
4890 the server, and the response is analyzed to find an SSL server hello message.
4891 The server is considered valid only when the response contains this server
4892 hello message.
4893
4894 All servers tested till there correctly reply to SSLv3 client hello messages,
4895 and most servers tested do not even log the requests containing only hello
4896 messages, which is appreciable.
4897
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02004898 Note that this check works even when SSL support was not built into haproxy
4899 because it forges the SSL message. When SSL support is available, it is best
4900 to use native SSL health checks instead of this one.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004901
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02004902 See also: "option httpchk", "check-ssl"
4903
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01004904
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01004905option tcp-check
4906 Perform health checks using tcp-check send/expect sequences
4907 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4908 yes | no | yes | yes
4909
4910 This health check method is intended to be combined with "tcp-check" command
4911 lists in order to support send/expect types of health check sequences.
4912
4913 TCP checks currently support 4 modes of operations :
4914 - no "tcp-check" directive : the health check only consists in a connection
4915 attempt, which remains the default mode.
4916
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03004917 - "tcp-check send" or "tcp-check send-binary" only is mentioned : this is
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01004918 used to send a string along with a connection opening. With some
4919 protocols, it helps sending a "QUIT" message for example that prevents
4920 the server from logging a connection error for each health check. The
4921 check result will still be based on the ability to open the connection
4922 only.
4923
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03004924 - "tcp-check expect" only is mentioned : this is used to test a banner.
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01004925 The connection is opened and haproxy waits for the server to present some
4926 contents which must validate some rules. The check result will be based
4927 on the matching between the contents and the rules. This is suited for
4928 POP, IMAP, SMTP, FTP, SSH, TELNET.
4929
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03004930 - both "tcp-check send" and "tcp-check expect" are mentioned : this is
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01004931 used to test a hello-type protocol. Haproxy sends a message, the server
4932 responds and its response is analysed. the check result will be based on
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03004933 the matching between the response contents and the rules. This is often
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01004934 suited for protocols which require a binding or a request/response model.
4935 LDAP, MySQL, Redis and SSL are example of such protocols, though they
4936 already all have their dedicated checks with a deeper understanding of
4937 the respective protocols.
4938 In this mode, many questions may be sent and many answers may be
4939 analysed.
4940
4941 Examples :
4942 # perform a POP check (analyse only server's banner)
4943 option tcp-check
4944 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
4945
4946 # perform an IMAP check (analyse only server's banner)
4947 option tcp-check
4948 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
4949
4950 # look for the redis master server after ensuring it speaks well
4951 # redis protocol, then it exits properly.
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03004952 # (send a command then analyse the response 3 times)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01004953 option tcp-check
4954 tcp-check send PING\r\n
4955 tcp-check expect +PONG
4956 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
4957 tcp-check expect string role:master
4958 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
4959 tcp-check expect string +OK
4960
4961 forge a HTTP request, then analyse the response
4962 (send many headers before analyzing)
4963 option tcp-check
4964 tcp-check send HEAD\ /\ HTTP/1.1\r\n
4965 tcp-check send Host:\ www.mydomain.com\r\n
4966 tcp-check send User-Agent:\ HAProxy\ tcpcheck\r\n
4967 tcp-check send \r\n
4968 tcp-check expect rstring HTTP/1\..\ (2..|3..)
4969
4970
4971 See also : "tcp-check expect", "tcp-check send"
4972
4973
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02004974option tcp-smart-accept
4975no option tcp-smart-accept
4976 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the accept sequence
4977 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4978 yes | yes | yes | no
4979 Arguments : none
4980
4981 When an HTTP connection request comes in, the system acknowledges it on
4982 behalf of HAProxy, then the client immediately sends its request, and the
4983 system acknowledges it too while it is notifying HAProxy about the new
4984 connection. HAProxy then reads the request and responds. This means that we
4985 have one TCP ACK sent by the system for nothing, because the request could
4986 very well be acknowledged by HAProxy when it sends its response.
4987
4988 For this reason, in HTTP mode, HAProxy automatically asks the system to avoid
4989 sending this useless ACK on platforms which support it (currently at least
4990 Linux). It must not cause any problem, because the system will send it anyway
4991 after 40 ms if the response takes more time than expected to come.
4992
4993 During complex network debugging sessions, it may be desirable to disable
4994 this optimization because delayed ACKs can make troubleshooting more complex
4995 when trying to identify where packets are delayed. It is then possible to
4996 fall back to normal behaviour by specifying "no option tcp-smart-accept".
4997
4998 It is also possible to force it for non-HTTP proxies by simply specifying
4999 "option tcp-smart-accept". For instance, it can make sense with some services
5000 such as SMTP where the server speaks first.
5001
5002 It is recommended to avoid forcing this option in a defaults section. In case
5003 of doubt, consider setting it back to automatic values by prepending the
5004 "default" keyword before it, or disabling it using the "no" keyword.
5005
Willy Tarreaud88edf22009-06-14 15:48:17 +02005006 See also : "option tcp-smart-connect"
5007
5008
5009option tcp-smart-connect
5010no option tcp-smart-connect
5011 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the connect sequence
5012 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5013 yes | no | yes | yes
5014 Arguments : none
5015
5016 On certain systems (at least Linux), HAProxy can ask the kernel not to
5017 immediately send an empty ACK upon a connection request, but to directly
5018 send the buffer request instead. This saves one packet on the network and
5019 thus boosts performance. It can also be useful for some servers, because they
5020 immediately get the request along with the incoming connection.
5021
5022 This feature is enabled when "option tcp-smart-connect" is set in a backend.
5023 It is not enabled by default because it makes network troubleshooting more
5024 complex.
5025
5026 It only makes sense to enable it with protocols where the client speaks first
5027 such as HTTP. In other situations, if there is no data to send in place of
5028 the ACK, a normal ACK is sent.
5029
5030 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5031 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5032
5033 See also : "option tcp-smart-accept"
5034
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02005035
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005036option tcpka
5037 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on both sides
5038 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5039 yes | yes | yes | yes
5040 Arguments : none
5041
5042 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
5043 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
5044 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
5045 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
5046
5047 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
5048 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
5049 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
5050 operating system and its tuning parameters.
5051
5052 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
5053 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
5054 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
5055 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
5056 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
5057
5058 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
5059
5060 Using option "tcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on both
5061 the client and server sides of a connection. Note that this is meaningful
5062 only in "defaults" or "listen" sections. If this option is used in a
5063 frontend, only the client side will get keep-alives, and if this option is
5064 used in a backend, only the server side will get keep-alives. For this
5065 reason, it is strongly recommended to explicitly use "option clitcpka" and
5066 "option srvtcpka" when the configuration is split between frontends and
5067 backends.
5068
5069 See also : "option clitcpka", "option srvtcpka"
5070
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005071
5072option tcplog
5073 Enable advanced logging of TCP connections with session state and timers
5074 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5075 yes | yes | yes | yes
5076 Arguments : none
5077
5078 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
5079 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
5080 "option tcplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including, but
5081 not limited to, the connection timers, the session status, the connections
5082 numbers, the frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source
5083 address and ports. This option is useful for pure TCP proxies in order to
5084 find which of the client or server disconnects or times out. For normal HTTP
5085 proxies, it's better to use "option httplog" which is even more complete.
5086
5087 This option may be set either in the frontend or the backend.
5088
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005089 See also : "option httplog", and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005090
5091
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005092option transparent
5093no option transparent
5094 Enable client-side transparent proxying
5095 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01005096 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005097 Arguments : none
5098
5099 This option was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer 3
5100 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
5101 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
5102 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
5103 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
5104 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
5105 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
5106 appropriate server.
5107
5108 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
5109 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
5110
Willy Tarreaua1146052011-03-01 09:51:54 +01005111 See also: the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword, and the
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005112 "transparent" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005113
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005114
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02005115persist rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02005116persist rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02005117 Enable RDP cookie-based persistence
5118 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5119 yes | no | yes | yes
5120 Arguments :
5121 <name> is the optional name of the RDP cookie to check. If omitted, the
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02005122 default cookie name "msts" will be used. There currently is no
5123 valid reason to change this name.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02005124
5125 This statement enables persistence based on an RDP cookie. The RDP cookie
5126 contains all information required to find the server in the list of known
5127 servers. So when this option is set in the backend, the request is analysed
5128 and if an RDP cookie is found, it is decoded. If it matches a known server
5129 which is still UP (or if "option persist" is set), then the connection is
5130 forwarded to this server.
5131
5132 Note that this only makes sense in a TCP backend, but for this to work, the
5133 frontend must have waited long enough to ensure that an RDP cookie is present
5134 in the request buffer. This is the same requirement as with the "rdp-cookie"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005135 load-balancing method. Thus it is highly recommended to put all statements in
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02005136 a single "listen" section.
5137
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02005138 Also, it is important to understand that the terminal server will emit this
5139 RDP cookie only if it is configured for "token redirection mode", which means
5140 that the "IP address redirection" option is disabled.
5141
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02005142 Example :
5143 listen tse-farm
5144 bind :3389
5145 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
5146 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
5147 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
5148 # apply RDP cookie persistence
5149 persist rdp-cookie
5150 # if server is unknown, let's balance on the same cookie.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02005151 # alternatively, "balance leastconn" may be useful too.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02005152 balance rdp-cookie
5153 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
5154 server srv2 1.1.1.2:3389
5155
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09005156 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "tcp-request", the "req_rdp_cookie" ACL and
5157 the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02005158
5159
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01005160rate-limit sessions <rate>
5161 Set a limit on the number of new sessions accepted per second on a frontend
5162 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5163 yes | yes | yes | no
5164 Arguments :
5165 <rate> The <rate> parameter is an integer designating the maximum number
5166 of new sessions per second to accept on the frontend.
5167
5168 When the frontend reaches the specified number of new sessions per second, it
5169 stops accepting new connections until the rate drops below the limit again.
5170 During this time, the pending sessions will be kept in the socket's backlog
5171 (in system buffers) and haproxy will not even be aware that sessions are
5172 pending. When applying very low limit on a highly loaded service, it may make
5173 sense to increase the socket's backlog using the "backlog" keyword.
5174
5175 This feature is particularly efficient at blocking connection-based attacks
5176 or service abuse on fragile servers. Since the session rate is measured every
5177 millisecond, it is extremely accurate. Also, the limit applies immediately,
5178 no delay is needed at all to detect the threshold.
5179
5180 Example : limit the connection rate on SMTP to 10 per second max
5181 listen smtp
5182 mode tcp
5183 bind :25
5184 rate-limit sessions 10
5185 server 127.0.0.1:1025
5186
Willy Tarreaua17c2d92011-07-25 08:16:20 +02005187 Note : when the maximum rate is reached, the frontend's status is not changed
5188 but its sockets appear as "WAITING" in the statistics if the
5189 "socket-stats" option is enabled.
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01005190
5191 See also : the "backlog" keyword and the "fe_sess_rate" ACL criterion.
5192
5193
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02005194redirect location <loc> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
5195redirect prefix <pfx> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
5196redirect scheme <sch> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02005197 Return an HTTP redirection if/unless a condition is matched
5198 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5199 no | yes | yes | yes
5200
5201 If/unless the condition is matched, the HTTP request will lead to a redirect
Willy Tarreauf285f542010-01-03 20:03:03 +01005202 response. If no condition is specified, the redirect applies unconditionally.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02005203
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01005204 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02005205 <loc> With "redirect location", the exact value in <loc> is placed into
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01005206 the HTTP "Location" header. When used in an "http-request" rule,
5207 <loc> value follows the log-format rules and can include some
5208 dynamic values (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02005209
5210 <pfx> With "redirect prefix", the "Location" header is built from the
5211 concatenation of <pfx> and the complete URI path, including the
5212 query string, unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see
5213 below). As a special case, if <pfx> equals exactly "/", then
5214 nothing is inserted before the original URI. It allows one to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01005215 redirect to the same URL (for instance, to insert a cookie). When
5216 used in an "http-request" rule, <pfx> value follows the log-format
5217 rules and can include some dynamic values (see Custom Log Format
5218 in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02005219
5220 <sch> With "redirect scheme", then the "Location" header is built by
5221 concatenating <sch> with "://" then the first occurrence of the
5222 "Host" header, and then the URI path, including the query string
5223 unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see below). If no
5224 path is found or if the path is "*", then "/" is used instead. If
5225 no "Host" header is found, then an empty host component will be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005226 returned, which most recent browsers interpret as redirecting to
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02005227 the same host. This directive is mostly used to redirect HTTP to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01005228 HTTPS. When used in an "http-request" rule, <sch> value follows
5229 the log-format rules and can include some dynamic values (see
5230 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01005231
5232 <code> The code is optional. It indicates which type of HTTP redirection
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01005233 is desired. Only codes 301, 302, 303, 307 and 308 are supported,
5234 with 302 used by default if no code is specified. 301 means
5235 "Moved permanently", and a browser may cache the Location. 302
5236 means "Moved permanently" and means that the browser should not
5237 cache the redirection. 303 is equivalent to 302 except that the
5238 browser will fetch the location with a GET method. 307 is just
5239 like 302 but makes it clear that the same method must be reused.
5240 Likewise, 308 replaces 301 if the same method must be used.
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01005241
5242 <option> There are several options which can be specified to adjust the
5243 expected behaviour of a redirection :
5244
5245 - "drop-query"
5246 When this keyword is used in a prefix-based redirection, then the
5247 location will be set without any possible query-string, which is useful
5248 for directing users to a non-secure page for instance. It has no effect
5249 with a location-type redirect.
5250
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01005251 - "append-slash"
5252 This keyword may be used in conjunction with "drop-query" to redirect
5253 users who use a URL not ending with a '/' to the same one with the '/'.
5254 It can be useful to ensure that search engines will only see one URL.
5255 For this, a return code 301 is preferred.
5256
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01005257 - "set-cookie NAME[=value]"
5258 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "=value")
5259 to the response. This is sometimes used to indicate that a user has
5260 been seen, for instance to protect against some types of DoS. No other
5261 cookie option is added, so the cookie will be a session cookie. Note
5262 that for a browser, a sole cookie name without an equal sign is
5263 different from a cookie with an equal sign.
5264
5265 - "clear-cookie NAME[=]"
5266 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "="), but
5267 with the "Max-Age" attribute set to zero. This will tell the browser to
5268 delete this cookie. It is useful for instance on logout pages. It is
5269 important to note that clearing the cookie "NAME" will not remove a
5270 cookie set with "NAME=value". You have to clear the cookie "NAME=" for
5271 that, because the browser makes the difference.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02005272
5273 Example: move the login URL only to HTTPS.
5274 acl clear dst_port 80
5275 acl secure dst_port 8080
5276 acl login_page url_beg /login
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01005277 acl logout url_beg /logout
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01005278 acl uid_given url_reg /login?userid=[^&]+
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01005279 acl cookie_set hdr_sub(cookie) SEEN=1
5280
5281 redirect prefix https://mysite.com set-cookie SEEN=1 if !cookie_set
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01005282 redirect prefix https://mysite.com if login_page !secure
5283 redirect prefix http://mysite.com drop-query if login_page !uid_given
5284 redirect location http://mysite.com/ if !login_page secure
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01005285 redirect location / clear-cookie USERID= if logout
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02005286
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01005287 Example: send redirects for request for articles without a '/'.
5288 acl missing_slash path_reg ^/article/[^/]*$
5289 redirect code 301 prefix / drop-query append-slash if missing_slash
5290
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02005291 Example: redirect all HTTP traffic to HTTPS when SSL is handled by haproxy.
David BERARDe7153042012-11-03 00:11:31 +01005292 redirect scheme https if !{ ssl_fc }
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02005293
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01005294 Example: append 'www.' prefix in front of all hosts not having it
5295 http-request redirect code 301 location www.%[hdr(host)]%[req.uri] \
5296 unless { hdr_beg(host) -i www }
5297
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005298 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02005299
5300
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01005301redisp (deprecated)
5302redispatch (deprecated)
5303 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
5304 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5305 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005306 Arguments : none
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01005307
5308 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
5309 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
5310 be able to access the service anymore.
5311
5312 Specifying "redispatch" will allow the proxy to break their persistence and
5313 redistribute them to a working server.
5314
5315 It also allows to retry last connection to another server in case of multiple
5316 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
5317 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005318
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01005319 This form is deprecated, do not use it in any new configuration, use the new
5320 "option redispatch" instead.
5321
5322 See also : "option redispatch"
5323
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005324
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01005325reqadd <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005326 Add a header at the end of the HTTP request
5327 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5328 no | yes | yes | yes
5329 Arguments :
5330 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
5331 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005332 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005333
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01005334 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5335 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5336
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005337 A new line consisting in <string> followed by a line feed will be added after
5338 the last header of an HTTP request.
5339
5340 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
5341 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
5342 responses.
5343
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01005344 Example : add "X-Proto: SSL" to requests coming via port 81
5345 acl is-ssl dst_port 81
5346 reqadd X-Proto:\ SSL if is-ssl
5347
5348 See also: "rspadd", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and section 7
5349 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005350
5351
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005352reqallow <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5353reqiallow <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005354 Definitely allow an HTTP request if a line matches a regular expression
5355 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5356 no | yes | yes | yes
5357 Arguments :
5358 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5359 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
5360 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
5361 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
5362 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
5363 "reqallow" keyword strictly matches case while "reqiallow"
5364 ignores case.
5365
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005366 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5367 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5368
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005369 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
5370 <search> will mark the request as allowed, even if any later test would
5371 result in a deny. The test applies both to the request line and to request
5372 headers. Keep in mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005373 header names are not.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005374
5375 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
5376 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
5377
5378 Example :
5379 # allow www.* but refuse *.local
5380 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
5381 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
5382
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005383 See also: "reqdeny", "block", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and
5384 section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005385
5386
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005387reqdel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5388reqidel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005389 Delete all headers matching a regular expression in an HTTP request
5390 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5391 no | yes | yes | yes
5392 Arguments :
5393 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5394 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
5395 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
5396 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
5397 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The "reqdel"
5398 keyword strictly matches case while "reqidel" ignores case.
5399
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005400 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5401 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5402
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005403 Any header line matching extended regular expression <search> in the request
5404 will be completely deleted. Most common use of this is to remove unwanted
5405 and/or dangerous headers or cookies from a request before passing it to the
5406 next servers.
5407
5408 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
5409 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
5410 responses. Keep in mind that header names are not case-sensitive.
5411
5412 Example :
5413 # remove X-Forwarded-For header and SERVER cookie
5414 reqidel ^X-Forwarded-For:.*
5415 reqidel ^Cookie:.*SERVER=
5416
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005417 See also: "reqadd", "reqrep", "rspdel", section 6 about HTTP header
5418 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005419
5420
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005421reqdeny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5422reqideny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005423 Deny an HTTP request if a line matches a regular expression
5424 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5425 no | yes | yes | yes
5426 Arguments :
5427 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5428 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
5429 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
5430 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
5431 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
5432 "reqdeny" keyword strictly matches case while "reqideny" ignores
5433 case.
5434
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005435 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5436 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5437
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005438 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
5439 <search> will mark the request as denied, even if any later test would
5440 result in an allow. The test applies both to the request line and to request
5441 headers. Keep in mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005442 header names are not.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005443
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01005444 A denied request will generate an "HTTP 403 forbidden" response once the
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01005445 complete request has been parsed. This is consistent with what is practiced
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005446 using ACLs.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01005447
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005448 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
5449 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
5450
5451 Example :
5452 # refuse *.local, then allow www.*
5453 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
5454 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
5455
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005456 See also: "reqallow", "rspdeny", "block", section 6 about HTTP header
5457 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005458
5459
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005460reqpass <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5461reqipass <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005462 Ignore any HTTP request line matching a regular expression in next rules
5463 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5464 no | yes | yes | yes
5465 Arguments :
5466 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5467 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
5468 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
5469 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
5470 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
5471 "reqpass" keyword strictly matches case while "reqipass" ignores
5472 case.
5473
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005474 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5475 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5476
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005477 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
5478 <search> will skip next rules, without assigning any deny or allow verdict.
5479 The test applies both to the request line and to request headers. Keep in
5480 mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while header names are not.
5481
5482 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
5483 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
5484
5485 Example :
5486 # refuse *.local, then allow www.*, but ignore "www.private.local"
5487 reqipass ^Host:\ www.private\.local
5488 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
5489 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
5490
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005491 See also: "reqallow", "reqdeny", "block", section 6 about HTTP header
5492 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005493
5494
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005495reqrep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5496reqirep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005497 Replace a regular expression with a string in an HTTP request line
5498 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5499 no | yes | yes | yes
5500 Arguments :
5501 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5502 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
5503 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
5504 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
5505 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The "reqrep"
5506 keyword strictly matches case while "reqirep" ignores case.
5507
5508 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
5509 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). References to matched
5510 pattern groups are possible using the common \N form, with N
5511 being a single digit between 0 and 9. Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005512 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005513
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005514 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5515 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5516
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005517 Any line matching extended regular expression <search> in the request (both
5518 the request line and header lines) will be completely replaced with <string>.
5519 Most common use of this is to rewrite URLs or domain names in "Host" headers.
5520
5521 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
5522 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
5523 responses. Note that for increased readability, it is suggested to add enough
5524 spaces between the request and the response. Keep in mind that URLs in
5525 request line are case-sensitive while header names are not.
5526
5527 Example :
5528 # replace "/static/" with "/" at the beginning of any request path.
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04005529 reqrep ^([^\ :]*)\ /static/(.*) \1\ /\2
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005530 # replace "www.mydomain.com" with "www" in the host name.
5531 reqirep ^Host:\ www.mydomain.com Host:\ www
5532
Dmitry Sivachenkof6f4f7b2012-10-21 18:10:25 +04005533 See also: "reqadd", "reqdel", "rsprep", "tune.bufsize", section 6 about
5534 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005535
5536
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005537reqtarpit <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5538reqitarpit <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005539 Tarpit an HTTP request containing a line matching a regular expression
5540 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5541 no | yes | yes | yes
5542 Arguments :
5543 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5544 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
5545 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
5546 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
5547 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
5548 "reqtarpit" keyword strictly matches case while "reqitarpit"
5549 ignores case.
5550
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005551 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5552 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5553
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005554 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
5555 <search> will be tarpitted, which means that it will connect to nowhere, will
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01005556 be kept open for a pre-defined time, then will return an HTTP error 500 so
5557 that the attacker does not suspect it has been tarpitted. The status 500 will
5558 be reported in the logs, but the completion flags will indicate "PT". The
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005559 delay is defined by "timeout tarpit", or "timeout connect" if the former is
5560 not set.
5561
5562 The goal of the tarpit is to slow down robots attacking servers with
5563 identifiable requests. Many robots limit their outgoing number of connections
5564 and stay connected waiting for a reply which can take several minutes to
5565 come. Depending on the environment and attack, it may be particularly
5566 efficient at reducing the load on the network and firewalls.
5567
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005568 Examples :
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005569 # ignore user-agents reporting any flavour of "Mozilla" or "MSIE", but
5570 # block all others.
5571 reqipass ^User-Agent:\.*(Mozilla|MSIE)
5572 reqitarpit ^User-Agent:
5573
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01005574 # block bad guys
5575 acl badguys src 10.1.0.3 172.16.13.20/28
5576 reqitarpit . if badguys
5577
5578 See also: "reqallow", "reqdeny", "reqpass", section 6 about HTTP header
5579 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005580
5581
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02005582retries <value>
5583 Set the number of retries to perform on a server after a connection failure
5584 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5585 yes | no | yes | yes
5586 Arguments :
5587 <value> is the number of times a connection attempt should be retried on
5588 a server when a connection either is refused or times out. The
5589 default value is 3.
5590
5591 It is important to understand that this value applies to the number of
5592 connection attempts, not full requests. When a connection has effectively
5593 been established to a server, there will be no more retry.
5594
5595 In order to avoid immediate reconnections to a server which is restarting,
5596 a turn-around timer of 1 second is applied before a retry occurs.
5597
5598 When "option redispatch" is set, the last retry may be performed on another
5599 server even if a cookie references a different server.
5600
5601 See also : "option redispatch"
5602
5603
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005604rspadd <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005605 Add a header at the end of the HTTP response
5606 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5607 no | yes | yes | yes
5608 Arguments :
5609 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
5610 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005611 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005612
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005613 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5614 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5615
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005616 A new line consisting in <string> followed by a line feed will be added after
5617 the last header of an HTTP response.
5618
5619 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
5620 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
5621 responses.
5622
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005623 See also: "reqadd", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and section 7
5624 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005625
5626
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005627rspdel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5628rspidel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005629 Delete all headers matching a regular expression in an HTTP response
5630 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5631 no | yes | yes | yes
5632 Arguments :
5633 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5634 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
5635 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
5636 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
5637 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
5638 The "rspdel" keyword strictly matches case while "rspidel"
5639 ignores case.
5640
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005641 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5642 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5643
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005644 Any header line matching extended regular expression <search> in the response
5645 will be completely deleted. Most common use of this is to remove unwanted
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02005646 and/or sensitive headers or cookies from a response before passing it to the
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005647 client.
5648
5649 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
5650 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
5651 responses. Keep in mind that header names are not case-sensitive.
5652
5653 Example :
5654 # remove the Server header from responses
Willy Tarreau5e80e022013-05-25 08:31:25 +02005655 rspidel ^Server:.*
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005656
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005657 See also: "rspadd", "rsprep", "reqdel", section 6 about HTTP header
5658 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005659
5660
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005661rspdeny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5662rspideny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005663 Block an HTTP response if a line matches a regular expression
5664 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5665 no | yes | yes | yes
5666 Arguments :
5667 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5668 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
5669 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
5670 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
5671 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
5672 The "rspdeny" keyword strictly matches case while "rspideny"
5673 ignores case.
5674
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005675 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5676 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5677
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005678 A response containing any line which matches extended regular expression
5679 <search> will mark the request as denied. The test applies both to the
5680 response line and to response headers. Keep in mind that header names are not
5681 case-sensitive.
5682
5683 Main use of this keyword is to prevent sensitive information leak and to
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01005684 block the response before it reaches the client. If a response is denied, it
5685 will be replaced with an HTTP 502 error so that the client never retrieves
5686 any sensitive data.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005687
5688 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
5689 Rspdeny should be avoided in new designs.
5690
5691 Example :
5692 # Ensure that no content type matching ms-word will leak
5693 rspideny ^Content-type:\.*/ms-word
5694
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005695 See also: "reqdeny", "acl", "block", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation
5696 and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005697
5698
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005699rsprep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
5700rspirep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005701 Replace a regular expression with a string in an HTTP response line
5702 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5703 no | yes | yes | yes
5704 Arguments :
5705 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
5706 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
5707 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
5708 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
5709 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
5710 The "rsprep" keyword strictly matches case while "rspirep"
5711 ignores case.
5712
5713 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
5714 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). References to matched
5715 pattern groups are possible using the common \N form, with N
5716 being a single digit between 0 and 9. Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005717 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005718
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005719 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
5720 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
5721
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005722 Any line matching extended regular expression <search> in the response (both
5723 the response line and header lines) will be completely replaced with
5724 <string>. Most common use of this is to rewrite Location headers.
5725
5726 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
5727 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
5728 responses. Note that for increased readability, it is suggested to add enough
5729 spaces between the request and the response. Keep in mind that header names
5730 are not case-sensitive.
5731
5732 Example :
5733 # replace "Location: 127.0.0.1:8080" with "Location: www.mydomain.com"
5734 rspirep ^Location:\ 127.0.0.1:8080 Location:\ www.mydomain.com
5735
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01005736 See also: "rspadd", "rspdel", "reqrep", section 6 about HTTP header
5737 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01005738
5739
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01005740server <name> <address>[:[port]] [param*]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005741 Declare a server in a backend
5742 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5743 no | no | yes | yes
5744 Arguments :
5745 <name> is the internal name assigned to this server. This name will
Cyril Bonté941a0c62012-10-15 19:44:24 +02005746 appear in logs and alerts. If "http-send-name-header" is
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05005747 set, it will be added to the request header sent to the server.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005748
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01005749 <address> is the IPv4 or IPv6 address of the server. Alternatively, a
5750 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
5751 during start-up. Address "0.0.0.0" or "*" has a special meaning.
5752 It indicates that the connection will be forwarded to the same IP
Willy Tarreaud669a4f2010-07-13 14:49:50 +02005753 address as the one from the client connection. This is useful in
5754 transparent proxy architectures where the client's connection is
5755 intercepted and haproxy must forward to the original destination
5756 address. This is more or less what the "transparent" keyword does
5757 except that with a server it's possible to limit concurrency and
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01005758 to report statistics. Optionally, an address family prefix may be
5759 used before the address to force the family regardless of the
5760 address format, which can be useful to specify a path to a unix
5761 socket with no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
5762 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
5763 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
5764 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02005765 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01005766 Any part of the address string may reference any number of
5767 environment variables by preceding their name with a dollar
5768 sign ('$') and optionally enclosing them with braces ('{}'),
5769 similarly to what is done in Bourne shell.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005770
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02005771 <port> is an optional port specification. If set, all connections will
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005772 be sent to this port. If unset, the same port the client
5773 connected to will be used. The port may also be prefixed by a "+"
5774 or a "-". In this case, the server's port will be determined by
5775 adding this value to the client's port.
5776
5777 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "server" keywords
5778 accepts an important number of options and has a complete section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005779 dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more details.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005780
5781 Examples :
5782 server first 10.1.1.1:1080 cookie first check inter 1000
5783 server second 10.1.1.2:1080 cookie second check inter 1000
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01005784 server transp ipv4@
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01005785 server backup ${SRV_BACKUP}:1080 backup
5786 server www1_dc1 ${LAN_DC1}.101:80
5787 server www1_dc2 ${LAN_DC2}.101:80
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005788
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05005789 See also: "default-server", "http-send-name-header" and section 5 about
5790 server options
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005791
5792
5793source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02005794source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01005795source <addr>[:<port>] [interface <name>]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005796 Set the source address for outgoing connections
5797 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5798 yes | no | yes | yes
5799 Arguments :
5800 <addr> is the IPv4 address HAProxy will bind to before connecting to a
5801 server. This address is also used as a source for health checks.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01005802
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005803 The default value of 0.0.0.0 means that the system will select
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01005804 the most appropriate address to reach its destination. Optionally
5805 an address family prefix may be used before the address to force
5806 the family regardless of the address format, which can be useful
5807 to specify a path to a unix socket with no slash ('/'). Currently
5808 supported prefixes are :
5809 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
5810 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
5811 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02005812 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01005813 Any part of the address string may reference any number of
5814 environment variables by preceding their name with a dollar
5815 sign ('$') and optionally enclosing them with braces ('{}'),
5816 similarly to what is done in Bourne shell.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005817
5818 <port> is an optional port. It is normally not needed but may be useful
5819 in some very specific contexts. The default value of zero means
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02005820 the system will select a free port. Note that port ranges are not
5821 supported in the backend. If you want to force port ranges, you
5822 have to specify them on each "server" line.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005823
5824 <addr2> is the IP address to present to the server when connections are
5825 forwarded in full transparent proxy mode. This is currently only
5826 supported on some patched Linux kernels. When this address is
5827 specified, clients connecting to the server will be presented
5828 with this address, while health checks will still use the address
5829 <addr>.
5830
5831 <port2> is the optional port to present to the server when connections
5832 are forwarded in full transparent proxy mode (see <addr2> above).
5833 The default value of zero means the system will select a free
5834 port.
5835
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02005836 <hdr> is the name of a HTTP header in which to fetch the IP to bind to.
5837 This is the name of a comma-separated header list which can
5838 contain multiple IP addresses. By default, the last occurrence is
5839 used. This is designed to work with the X-Forwarded-For header
Baptiste Assmannea3e73b2013-02-02 23:47:49 +01005840 and to automatically bind to the client's IP address as seen
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02005841 by previous proxy, typically Stunnel. In order to use another
5842 occurrence from the last one, please see the <occ> parameter
5843 below. When the header (or occurrence) is not found, no binding
5844 is performed so that the proxy's default IP address is used. Also
5845 keep in mind that the header name is case insensitive, as for any
5846 HTTP header.
5847
5848 <occ> is the occurrence number of a value to be used in a multi-value
5849 header. This is to be used in conjunction with "hdr_ip(<hdr>)",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005850 in order to specify which occurrence to use for the source IP
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02005851 address. Positive values indicate a position from the first
5852 occurrence, 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
5853 positions relative to the last one, -1 being the last one. This
5854 is helpful for situations where an X-Forwarded-For header is set
5855 at the entry point of an infrastructure and must be used several
5856 proxy layers away. When this value is not specified, -1 is
5857 assumed. Passing a zero here disables the feature.
5858
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01005859 <name> is an optional interface name to which to bind to for outgoing
5860 traffic. On systems supporting this features (currently, only
5861 Linux), this allows one to bind all traffic to the server to
5862 this interface even if it is not the one the system would select
5863 based on routing tables. This should be used with extreme care.
5864 Note that using this option requires root privileges.
5865
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005866 The "source" keyword is useful in complex environments where a specific
5867 address only is allowed to connect to the servers. It may be needed when a
5868 private address must be used through a public gateway for instance, and it is
5869 known that the system cannot determine the adequate source address by itself.
5870
5871 An extension which is available on certain patched Linux kernels may be used
5872 through the "usesrc" optional keyword. It makes it possible to connect to the
5873 servers with an IP address which does not belong to the system itself. This
5874 is called "full transparent proxy mode". For this to work, the destination
5875 servers have to route their traffic back to this address through the machine
5876 running HAProxy, and IP forwarding must generally be enabled on this machine.
5877
5878 In this "full transparent proxy" mode, it is possible to force a specific IP
5879 address to be presented to the servers. This is not much used in fact. A more
5880 common use is to tell HAProxy to present the client's IP address. For this,
5881 there are two methods :
5882
5883 - present the client's IP and port addresses. This is the most transparent
5884 mode, but it can cause problems when IP connection tracking is enabled on
5885 the machine, because a same connection may be seen twice with different
5886 states. However, this solution presents the huge advantage of not
5887 limiting the system to the 64k outgoing address+port couples, because all
5888 of the client ranges may be used.
5889
5890 - present only the client's IP address and select a spare port. This
5891 solution is still quite elegant but slightly less transparent (downstream
5892 firewalls logs will not match upstream's). It also presents the downside
5893 of limiting the number of concurrent connections to the usual 64k ports.
5894 However, since the upstream and downstream ports are different, local IP
5895 connection tracking on the machine will not be upset by the reuse of the
5896 same session.
5897
5898 Note that depending on the transparent proxy technology used, it may be
5899 required to force the source address. In fact, cttproxy version 2 requires an
5900 IP address in <addr> above, and does not support setting of "0.0.0.0" as the
5901 IP address because it creates NAT entries which much match the exact outgoing
5902 address. Tproxy version 4 and some other kernel patches which work in pure
5903 forwarding mode generally will not have this limitation.
5904
5905 This option sets the default source for all servers in the backend. It may
5906 also be specified in a "defaults" section. Finer source address specification
5907 is possible at the server level using the "source" server option. Refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005908 section 5 for more information.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005909
5910 Examples :
5911 backend private
5912 # Connect to the servers using our 192.168.1.200 source address
5913 source 192.168.1.200
5914
5915 backend transparent_ssl1
5916 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address
5917 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
5918
5919 backend transparent_ssl2
5920 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address and port
5921 # not recommended if IP conntrack is present on the local machine.
5922 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc client
5923
5924 backend transparent_ssl3
5925 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address. It
5926 # is more conntrack-friendly.
5927 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
5928
5929 backend transparent_smtp
5930 # Connect to the SMTP farm from the client's source address/port
5931 # with Tproxy version 4.
5932 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc clientip
5933
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02005934 backend transparent_http
5935 # Connect to the servers using the client's IP as seen by previous
5936 # proxy.
5937 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
5938
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005939 See also : the "source" server option in section 5, the Tproxy patches for
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01005940 the Linux kernel on www.balabit.com, the "bind" keyword.
5941
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01005942
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005943srvtimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
5944 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
5945 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5946 yes | no | yes | yes
5947 Arguments :
5948 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
5949 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
5950 as explained at the top of this document.
5951
5952 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
5953 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
5954 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
5955 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
5956 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
5957 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
5958 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
5959
5960 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
5961 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
5962 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
5963 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
5964 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01005965 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005966 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005967 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005968
5969 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
5970 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
5971 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
5972 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
5973 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
5974 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
5975
5976 This parameter is provided for compatibility but is currently deprecated.
5977 Please use "timeout server" instead.
5978
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02005979 See also : "timeout server", "timeout tunnel", "timeout client" and
5980 "clitimeout".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01005981
5982
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02005983stats admin { if | unless } <cond>
5984 Enable statistics admin level if/unless a condition is matched
5985 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02005986 no | yes | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02005987
5988 This statement enables the statistics admin level if/unless a condition is
5989 matched.
5990
5991 The admin level allows to enable/disable servers from the web interface. By
5992 default, statistics page is read-only for security reasons.
5993
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01005994 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
5995 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
5996 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
5997
Cyril Bonté23b39d92011-02-10 22:54:44 +01005998 Currently, the POST request is limited to the buffer size minus the reserved
5999 buffer space, which means that if the list of servers is too long, the
6000 request won't be processed. It is recommended to alter few servers at a
6001 time.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02006002
6003 Example :
6004 # statistics admin level only for localhost
6005 backend stats_localhost
6006 stats enable
6007 stats admin if LOCALHOST
6008
6009 Example :
6010 # statistics admin level always enabled because of the authentication
6011 backend stats_auth
6012 stats enable
6013 stats auth admin:AdMiN123
6014 stats admin if TRUE
6015
6016 Example :
6017 # statistics admin level depends on the authenticated user
6018 userlist stats-auth
6019 group admin users admin
6020 user admin insecure-password AdMiN123
6021 group readonly users haproxy
6022 user haproxy insecure-password haproxy
6023
6024 backend stats_auth
6025 stats enable
6026 acl AUTH http_auth(stats-auth)
6027 acl AUTH_ADMIN http_auth_group(stats-auth) admin
6028 stats http-request auth unless AUTH
6029 stats admin if AUTH_ADMIN
6030
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006031 See also : "stats enable", "stats auth", "stats http-request", "nbproc",
6032 "bind-process", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
6033 ACL usage.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02006034
6035
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006036stats auth <user>:<passwd>
6037 Enable statistics with authentication and grant access to an account
6038 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006039 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006040 Arguments :
6041 <user> is a user name to grant access to
6042
6043 <passwd> is the cleartext password associated to this user
6044
6045 This statement enables statistics with default settings, and restricts access
6046 to declared users only. It may be repeated as many times as necessary to
6047 allow as many users as desired. When a user tries to access the statistics
6048 without a valid account, a "401 Forbidden" response will be returned so that
6049 the browser asks the user to provide a valid user and password. The real
6050 which will be returned to the browser is configurable using "stats realm".
6051
6052 Since the authentication method is HTTP Basic Authentication, the passwords
6053 circulate in cleartext on the network. Thus, it was decided that the
6054 configuration file would also use cleartext passwords to remind the users
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02006055 that those ones should not be sensitive and not shared with any other account.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006056
6057 It is also possible to reduce the scope of the proxies which appear in the
6058 report using "stats scope".
6059
6060 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6061 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
6062 unobvious parameters.
6063
6064 Example :
6065 # public access (limited to this backend only)
6066 backend public_www
6067 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
6068 stats enable
6069 stats hide-version
6070 stats scope .
6071 stats uri /admin?stats
6072 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
6073 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
6074 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
6075
6076 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6077 backend private_monitoring
6078 stats enable
6079 stats uri /admin?stats
6080 stats refresh 5s
6081
6082 See also : "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats scope", "stats uri"
6083
6084
6085stats enable
6086 Enable statistics reporting with default settings
6087 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006088 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006089 Arguments : none
6090
6091 This statement enables statistics reporting with default settings defined
6092 at build time. Unless stated otherwise, these settings are used :
6093 - stats uri : /haproxy?stats
6094 - stats realm : "HAProxy Statistics"
6095 - stats auth : no authentication
6096 - stats scope : no restriction
6097
6098 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6099 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
6100 unobvious parameters.
6101
6102 Example :
6103 # public access (limited to this backend only)
6104 backend public_www
6105 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
6106 stats enable
6107 stats hide-version
6108 stats scope .
6109 stats uri /admin?stats
6110 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
6111 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
6112 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
6113
6114 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6115 backend private_monitoring
6116 stats enable
6117 stats uri /admin?stats
6118 stats refresh 5s
6119
6120 See also : "stats auth", "stats realm", "stats uri"
6121
6122
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006123stats hide-version
6124 Enable statistics and hide HAProxy version reporting
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02006125 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006126 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006127 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02006128
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006129 By default, the stats page reports some useful status information along with
6130 the statistics. Among them is HAProxy's version. However, it is generally
6131 considered dangerous to report precise version to anyone, as it can help them
6132 target known weaknesses with specific attacks. The "stats hide-version"
6133 statement removes the version from the statistics report. This is recommended
6134 for public sites or any site with a weak login/password.
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02006135
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02006136 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6137 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
6138 unobvious parameters.
6139
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006140 Example :
6141 # public access (limited to this backend only)
6142 backend public_www
6143 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02006144 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006145 stats hide-version
6146 stats scope .
6147 stats uri /admin?stats
6148 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
6149 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
6150 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02006151
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02006152 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6153 backend private_monitoring
6154 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006155 stats uri /admin?stats
6156 stats refresh 5s
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki15514c22010-01-04 16:03:09 +01006157
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006158 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02006159
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01006160
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02006161stats http-request { allow | deny | auth [realm <realm>] }
6162 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6163 Access control for statistics
6164
6165 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6166 no | no | yes | yes
6167
6168 As "http-request", these set of options allow to fine control access to
6169 statistics. Each option may be followed by if/unless and acl.
6170 First option with matched condition (or option without condition) is final.
6171 For "deny" a 403 error will be returned, for "allow" normal processing is
6172 performed, for "auth" a 401/407 error code is returned so the client
6173 should be asked to enter a username and password.
6174
6175 There is no fixed limit to the number of http-request statements per
6176 instance.
6177
6178 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
6179 about ACL usage.
6180
6181
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006182stats realm <realm>
6183 Enable statistics and set authentication realm
6184 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006185 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006186 Arguments :
6187 <realm> is the name of the HTTP Basic Authentication realm reported to
6188 the browser. The browser uses it to display it in the pop-up
6189 inviting the user to enter a valid username and password.
6190
6191 The realm is read as a single word, so any spaces in it should be escaped
6192 using a backslash ('\').
6193
6194 This statement is useful only in conjunction with "stats auth" since it is
6195 only related to authentication.
6196
6197 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6198 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
6199 unobvious parameters.
6200
6201 Example :
6202 # public access (limited to this backend only)
6203 backend public_www
6204 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
6205 stats enable
6206 stats hide-version
6207 stats scope .
6208 stats uri /admin?stats
6209 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
6210 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
6211 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
6212
6213 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6214 backend private_monitoring
6215 stats enable
6216 stats uri /admin?stats
6217 stats refresh 5s
6218
6219 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats uri"
6220
6221
6222stats refresh <delay>
6223 Enable statistics with automatic refresh
6224 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006225 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006226 Arguments :
6227 <delay> is the suggested refresh delay, specified in seconds, which will
6228 be returned to the browser consulting the report page. While the
6229 browser is free to apply any delay, it will generally respect it
6230 and refresh the page this every seconds. The refresh interval may
6231 be specified in any other non-default time unit, by suffixing the
6232 unit after the value, as explained at the top of this document.
6233
6234 This statement is useful on monitoring displays with a permanent page
6235 reporting the load balancer's activity. When set, the HTML report page will
6236 include a link "refresh"/"stop refresh" so that the user can select whether
6237 he wants automatic refresh of the page or not.
6238
6239 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6240 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
6241 unobvious parameters.
6242
6243 Example :
6244 # public access (limited to this backend only)
6245 backend public_www
6246 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
6247 stats enable
6248 stats hide-version
6249 stats scope .
6250 stats uri /admin?stats
6251 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
6252 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
6253 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
6254
6255 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6256 backend private_monitoring
6257 stats enable
6258 stats uri /admin?stats
6259 stats refresh 5s
6260
6261 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
6262
6263
6264stats scope { <name> | "." }
6265 Enable statistics and limit access scope
6266 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006267 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006268 Arguments :
6269 <name> is the name of a listen, frontend or backend section to be
6270 reported. The special name "." (a single dot) designates the
6271 section in which the statement appears.
6272
6273 When this statement is specified, only the sections enumerated with this
6274 statement will appear in the report. All other ones will be hidden. This
6275 statement may appear as many times as needed if multiple sections need to be
6276 reported. Please note that the name checking is performed as simple string
6277 comparisons, and that it is never checked that a give section name really
6278 exists.
6279
6280 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6281 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
6282 unobvious parameters.
6283
6284 Example :
6285 # public access (limited to this backend only)
6286 backend public_www
6287 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
6288 stats enable
6289 stats hide-version
6290 stats scope .
6291 stats uri /admin?stats
6292 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
6293 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
6294 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
6295
6296 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6297 backend private_monitoring
6298 stats enable
6299 stats uri /admin?stats
6300 stats refresh 5s
6301
6302 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
6303
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006304
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02006305stats show-desc [ <desc> ]
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006306 Enable reporting of a description on the statistics page.
6307 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006308 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006309
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02006310 <desc> is an optional description to be reported. If unspecified, the
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006311 description from global section is automatically used instead.
6312
6313 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
6314 customers, where node or description should be different for each customer.
6315
6316 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6317 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04006318 unobvious parameters. By default description is not shown.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006319
6320 Example :
6321 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6322 backend private_monitoring
6323 stats enable
6324 stats show-desc Master node for Europe, Asia, Africa
6325 stats uri /admin?stats
6326 stats refresh 5s
6327
6328 See also: "show-node", "stats enable", "stats uri" and "description" in
6329 global section.
6330
6331
6332stats show-legends
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006333 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page
6334 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6335 yes | yes | yes | yes
6336 Arguments : none
6337
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03006338 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page :
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006339 - cap: capabilities (proxy)
6340 - mode: one of tcp, http or health (proxy)
6341 - id: SNMP ID (proxy, socket, server)
6342 - IP (socket, server)
6343 - cookie (backend, server)
6344
6345 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6346 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04006347 unobvious parameters. Default behaviour is not to show this information.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006348
6349 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
6350
6351
6352stats show-node [ <name> ]
6353 Enable reporting of a host name on the statistics page.
6354 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006355 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006356 Arguments:
6357 <name> is an optional name to be reported. If unspecified, the
6358 node name from global section is automatically used instead.
6359
6360 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
6361 customers, where node or description might be different on a stats page
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04006362 provided for each customer. Default behaviour is not to show host name.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006363
6364 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6365 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
6366 unobvious parameters.
6367
6368 Example:
6369 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6370 backend private_monitoring
6371 stats enable
6372 stats show-node Europe-1
6373 stats uri /admin?stats
6374 stats refresh 5s
6375
6376 See also: "show-desc", "stats enable", "stats uri", and "node" in global
6377 section.
6378
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006379
6380stats uri <prefix>
6381 Enable statistics and define the URI prefix to access them
6382 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02006383 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006384 Arguments :
6385 <prefix> is the prefix of any URI which will be redirected to stats. This
6386 prefix may contain a question mark ('?') to indicate part of a
6387 query string.
6388
6389 The statistics URI is intercepted on the relayed traffic, so it appears as a
6390 page within the normal application. It is strongly advised to ensure that the
6391 selected URI will never appear in the application, otherwise it will never be
6392 possible to reach it in the application.
6393
6394 The default URI compiled in haproxy is "/haproxy?stats", but this may be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006395 changed at build time, so it's better to always explicitly specify it here.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006396 It is generally a good idea to include a question mark in the URI so that
6397 intermediate proxies refrain from caching the results. Also, since any string
6398 beginning with the prefix will be accepted as a stats request, the question
6399 mark helps ensuring that no valid URI will begin with the same words.
6400
6401 It is sometimes very convenient to use "/" as the URI prefix, and put that
6402 statement in a "listen" instance of its own. That makes it easy to dedicate
6403 an address or a port to statistics only.
6404
6405 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
6406 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
6407 unobvious parameters.
6408
6409 Example :
6410 # public access (limited to this backend only)
6411 backend public_www
6412 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
6413 stats enable
6414 stats hide-version
6415 stats scope .
6416 stats uri /admin?stats
6417 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
6418 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
6419 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
6420
6421 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
6422 backend private_monitoring
6423 stats enable
6424 stats uri /admin?stats
6425 stats refresh 5s
6426
6427 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm"
6428
6429
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006430stick match <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <cond>]
6431 Define a request pattern matching condition to stick a user to a server
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006432 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006433 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006434
6435 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02006436 <pattern> is a pattern extraction rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006437 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
6438 will be analysed in the hope to find a matching entry in a
6439 stickiness table. This rule is mandatory.
6440
6441 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
6442 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
6443 the "stick-table" statement.
6444
6445 <cond> is an optional matching condition. It makes it possible to match
6446 on a certain criterion only when other conditions are met (or
6447 not met). For instance, it could be used to match on a source IP
6448 address except when a request passes through a known proxy, in
6449 which case we'd match on a header containing that IP address.
6450
6451 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
6452 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick match" statement
6453 describes a rule to extract the stickiness criterion from an incoming request
6454 or connection. See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and
6455 transformation rules.
6456
6457 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
6458 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
6459 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
6460 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
6461 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
6462 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
6463 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
6464
6465 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick match" statement
6466 will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. See section 7 for
6467 ACL based conditions.
6468
6469 There is no limit on the number of "stick match" statements. The first that
6470 applies and matches will cause the request to be directed to the same server
6471 as was used for the request which created the entry. That way, multiple
6472 matches can be used as fallbacks.
6473
6474 The stick rules are checked after the persistence cookies, so they will not
6475 affect stickiness if a cookie has already been used to select a server. That
6476 way, it becomes very easy to insert cookies and match on IP addresses in
6477 order to maintain stickiness between HTTP and HTTPS.
6478
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006479 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
6480 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
6481 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
6482
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006483 Example :
6484 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
6485 # last 30 minutes
6486 backend pop
6487 mode tcp
6488 balance roundrobin
6489 stick store-request src
6490 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
6491 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
6492 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
6493
6494 backend smtp
6495 mode tcp
6496 balance roundrobin
6497 stick match src table pop
6498 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
6499 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
6500
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006501 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
6502 about ACLs and pattern extraction.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006503
6504
6505stick on <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
6506 Define a request pattern to associate a user to a server
6507 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6508 no | no | yes | yes
6509
6510 Note : This form is exactly equivalent to "stick match" followed by
6511 "stick store-request", all with the same arguments. Please refer
6512 to both keywords for details. It is only provided as a convenience
6513 for writing more maintainable configurations.
6514
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006515 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
6516 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
6517 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
6518
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006519 Examples :
6520 # The following form ...
Willy Tarreauec579d82010-02-26 19:15:04 +01006521 stick on src table pop if !localhost
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006522
6523 # ...is strictly equivalent to this one :
6524 stick match src table pop if !localhost
6525 stick store-request src table pop if !localhost
6526
6527
6528 # Use cookie persistence for HTTP, and stick on source address for HTTPS as
6529 # well as HTTP without cookie. Share the same table between both accesses.
6530 backend http
6531 mode http
6532 balance roundrobin
6533 stick on src table https
6534 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
6535 server s1 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s1
6536 server s2 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s2
6537
6538 backend https
6539 mode tcp
6540 balance roundrobin
6541 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
6542 stick on src
6543 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
6544 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
6545
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006546 See also : "stick match", "stick store-request", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006547
6548
6549stick store-request <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
6550 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
6551 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6552 no | no | yes | yes
6553
6554 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02006555 <pattern> is a pattern extraction rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006556 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
6557 will be analysed, extracted and stored in the table once a
6558 server is selected.
6559
6560 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
6561 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
6562 the "stick-table" statement.
6563
6564 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
6565 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
6566 For instance, it could be used to store the source IP address
6567 except when the request passes through a known proxy, in which
6568 case we'd store a converted form of a header containing that IP
6569 address.
6570
6571 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
6572 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-request" statement
6573 describes a rule to decide what to extract from the request and when to do
6574 it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further requests to
6575 match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the extracted part must
6576 make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further request. Storing a
6577 client's IP address for instance often makes sense. Storing an ID found in a
6578 URL parameter also makes sense. Storing a source port will almost never make
6579 any sense because it will be randomly matched. See section 7 for a complete
6580 list of possible patterns and transformation rules.
6581
6582 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
6583 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
6584 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
6585 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
6586 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
6587 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
6588 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
6589
6590 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-request"
6591 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
6592 condition will be evaluated while parsing the request, so any criteria can be
6593 used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
6594
6595 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-request" statements, but
6596 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
6597 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
6598 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
6599 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
6600 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +01006601 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-request rules with
6602 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
6603 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
6604 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
6605 request rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
6606 not be evaluated.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006607
6608 The "store-request" rules are evaluated once the server connection has been
6609 established, so that the table will contain the real server that processed
6610 the request.
6611
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006612 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
6613 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
6614 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
6615
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006616 Example :
6617 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
6618 # last 30 minutes
6619 backend pop
6620 mode tcp
6621 balance roundrobin
6622 stick store-request src
6623 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
6624 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
6625 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
6626
6627 backend smtp
6628 mode tcp
6629 balance roundrobin
6630 stick match src table pop
6631 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
6632 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
6633
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006634 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
6635 about ACLs and pattern extraction.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006636
6637
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02006638stick-table type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02006639 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [peers <peersect>]
6640 [store <data_type>]*
Godbach64cef792013-12-04 16:08:22 +08006641 Configure the stickiness table for the current section
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006642 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02006643 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006644
6645 Arguments :
6646 ip a table declared with "type ip" will only store IPv4 addresses.
6647 This form is very compact (about 50 bytes per entry) and allows
6648 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
6649 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
6650
David du Colombier9a6d3c92011-03-17 10:40:24 +01006651 ipv6 a table declared with "type ipv6" will only store IPv6 addresses.
6652 This form is very compact (about 60 bytes per entry) and allows
6653 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
6654 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
6655
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006656 integer a table declared with "type integer" will store 32bit integers
6657 which can represent a client identifier found in a request for
6658 instance.
6659
6660 string a table declared with "type string" will store substrings of up
6661 to <len> characters. If the string provided by the pattern
6662 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
6663 being stored. During matching, at most <len> characters will be
6664 compared between the string in the table and the extracted
6665 pattern. When not specified, the string is automatically limited
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02006666 to 32 characters.
6667
6668 binary a table declared with "type binary" will store binary blocks
6669 of <len> bytes. If the block provided by the pattern
6670 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
6671 being stored. If the block provided by the pattern extractor
6672 is shorter than <len>, it will be padded by 0. When not
6673 specified, the block is automatically limited to 32 bytes.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006674
6675 <length> is the maximum number of characters that will be stored in a
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02006676 "string" type table (See type "string" above). Or the number
6677 of bytes of the block in "binary" type table. Be careful when
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006678 changing this parameter as memory usage will proportionally
6679 increase.
6680
6681 <size> is the maximum number of entries that can fit in the table. This
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01006682 value directly impacts memory usage. Count approximately
6683 50 bytes per entry, plus the size of a string if any. The size
6684 supports suffixes "k", "m", "g" for 2^10, 2^20 and 2^30 factors.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006685
6686 [nopurge] indicates that we refuse to purge older entries when the table
6687 is full. When not specified and the table is full when haproxy
6688 wants to store an entry in it, it will flush a few of the oldest
6689 entries in order to release some space for the new ones. This is
6690 most often the desired behaviour. In some specific cases, it
6691 be desirable to refuse new entries instead of purging the older
6692 ones. That may be the case when the amount of data to store is
6693 far above the hardware limits and we prefer not to offer access
6694 to new clients than to reject the ones already connected. When
6695 using this parameter, be sure to properly set the "expire"
6696 parameter (see below).
6697
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02006698 <peersect> is the name of the peers section to use for replication. Entries
6699 which associate keys to server IDs are kept synchronized with
6700 the remote peers declared in this section. All entries are also
6701 automatically learned from the local peer (old process) during a
6702 soft restart.
6703
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01006704 NOTE : peers can't be used in multi-process mode.
6705
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006706 <expire> defines the maximum duration of an entry in the table since it
6707 was last created, refreshed or matched. The expiration delay is
6708 defined using the standard time format, similarly as the various
6709 timeouts. The maximum duration is slightly above 24 days. See
6710 section 2.2 for more information. If this delay is not specified,
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02006711 the session won't automatically expire, but older entries will
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006712 be removed once full. Be sure not to use the "nopurge" parameter
6713 if not expiration delay is specified.
6714
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02006715 <data_type> is used to store additional information in the stick-table. This
6716 may be used by ACLs in order to control various criteria related
6717 to the activity of the client matching the stick-table. For each
6718 item specified here, the size of each entry will be inflated so
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02006719 that the additional data can fit. Several data types may be
6720 stored with an entry. Multiple data types may be specified after
6721 the "store" keyword, as a comma-separated list. Alternatively,
6722 it is possible to repeat the "store" keyword followed by one or
6723 several data types. Except for the "server_id" type which is
6724 automatically detected and enabled, all data types must be
6725 explicitly declared to be stored. If an ACL references a data
6726 type which is not stored, the ACL will simply not match. Some
6727 data types require an argument which must be passed just after
6728 the type between parenthesis. See below for the supported data
6729 types and their arguments.
6730
6731 The data types that can be stored with an entry are the following :
6732 - server_id : this is an integer which holds the numeric ID of the server a
6733 request was assigned to. It is used by the "stick match", "stick store",
6734 and "stick on" rules. It is automatically enabled when referenced.
6735
6736 - gpc0 : first General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
6737 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
6738 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
6739 specific behaviour was detected and must be known for future matches.
6740
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02006741 - gpc0_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
6742 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
6743 for anything. Just like <gpc0>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
6744 a cumulative count, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
6745 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
6746 occurrence of certain events (eg: requests to a specific URL).
6747
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02006748 - conn_cnt : Connection Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
6749 the absolute number of connections received from clients which matched
6750 this entry. It does not mean the connections were accepted, just that
6751 they were received.
6752
6753 - conn_cur : Current Connections. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
6754 stores the concurrent connection counts for the entry. It is incremented
6755 once an incoming connection matches the entry, and decremented once the
6756 connection leaves. That way it is possible to know at any time the exact
6757 number of concurrent connections for an entry.
6758
6759 - conn_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
6760 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
6761 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
6762 incoming connection rate over that period, in connections per period. The
6763 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
6764
6765 - sess_cnt : Session Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
6766 the absolute number of sessions received from clients which matched this
6767 entry. A session is a connection that was accepted by the layer 4 rules.
6768
6769 - sess_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
6770 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
6771 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
6772 incoming session rate over that period, in sessions per period. The
6773 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
6774
6775 - http_req_cnt : HTTP request Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
6776 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests received from clients which
6777 matched this entry. It does not matter whether they are valid requests or
6778 not. Note that this is different from sessions when keep-alive is used on
6779 the client side.
6780
6781 - http_req_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
6782 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
6783 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
6784 HTTP request rate over that period, in requests per period. The result is
6785 an integer which can be matched using ACLs. It does not matter whether
6786 they are valid requests or not. Note that this is different from sessions
6787 when keep-alive is used on the client side.
6788
6789 - http_err_cnt : HTTP Error Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
6790 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests errors induced by clients
6791 which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated
6792 requests, as well as on denied or tarpitted requests, and on failed
6793 authentications. If the server responds with 4xx, then the request is
6794 also counted as an error since it's an error triggered by the client
6795 (eg: vulnerability scan).
6796
6797 - http_err_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
6798 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
6799 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
6800 HTTP request error rate over that period, in requests per period (see
6801 http_err_cnt above for what is accounted as an error). The result is an
6802 integer which can be matched using ACLs.
6803
6804 - bytes_in_cnt : client to server byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
6805 integer which counts the cumulated amount of bytes received from clients
6806 which matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be
6807 used to limit abuse of upload features on photo or video servers.
6808
6809 - bytes_in_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
6810 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
6811 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
6812 incoming bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
6813 to detect users which upload too much and too fast. Warning: with large
6814 uploads, it is possible that the amount of uploaded data will be counted
6815 once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average transfer speed
6816 instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be smoothed with
6817 "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of byte_in_cnt is
6818 recommended for better fairness.
6819
6820 - bytes_out_cnt : server to client byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
6821 integer which counts the cumulated amount of bytes sent to clients which
6822 matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be used
6823 to limit abuse of bots sucking the whole site.
6824
6825 - bytes_out_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes
6826 an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
6827 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
6828 outgoing bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
6829 to detect users which download too much and too fast. Warning: with large
6830 transfers, it is possible that the amount of transferred data will be
6831 counted once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average
6832 transfer speed instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be
6833 smoothed with "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of
6834 byte_out_cnt is recommended for better fairness.
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02006835
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02006836 There is only one stick-table per proxy. At the moment of writing this doc,
6837 it does not seem useful to have multiple tables per proxy. If this happens
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006838 to be required, simply create a dummy backend with a stick-table in it and
6839 reference it.
6840
6841 It is important to understand that stickiness based on learning information
6842 has some limitations, including the fact that all learned associations are
6843 lost upon restart. In general it can be good as a complement but not always
6844 as an exclusive stickiness.
6845
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02006846 Last, memory requirements may be important when storing many data types.
6847 Indeed, storing all indicators above at once in each entry requires 116 bytes
6848 per entry, or 116 MB for a 1-million entries table. This is definitely not
6849 something that can be ignored.
6850
6851 Example:
6852 # Keep track of counters of up to 1 million IP addresses over 5 minutes
6853 # and store a general purpose counter and the average connection rate
6854 # computed over a sliding window of 30 seconds.
6855 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0,conn_rate(30s)
6856
6857 See also : "stick match", "stick on", "stick store-request", section 2.2
David du Colombiera13d1b92011-03-17 10:40:22 +01006858 about time format and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01006859
6860
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02006861stick store-response <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
6862 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
6863 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6864 no | no | yes | yes
6865
6866 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02006867 <pattern> is a pattern extraction rule as described in section 7.3. It
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02006868 describes what elements of the response or connection will
6869 be analysed, extracted and stored in the table once a
6870 server is selected.
6871
6872 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
6873 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
6874 the "stick-table" statement.
6875
6876 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
6877 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
6878 For instance, it could be used to store the SSL session ID only
6879 when the response is a SSL server hello.
6880
6881 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
6882 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-response"
6883 statement describes a rule to decide what to extract from the response and
6884 when to do it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further
6885 requests to match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the
6886 extracted part must make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006887 request. Storing an ID found in a header of a response makes sense.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02006888 See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and transformation
6889 rules.
6890
6891 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
6892 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
6893 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
6894 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
6895 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
6896 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
6897 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
6898
6899 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-response"
6900 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
6901 condition will be evaluated while parsing the response, so any criteria can
6902 be used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
6903
6904 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-response" statements, but
6905 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
6906 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
6907 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
6908 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
6909 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +01006910 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-response rules with
6911 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
6912 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
6913 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
6914 response rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
6915 not be evaluated. However, even if a store-request rule references a table, a
6916 store-response rule may also use the same table. This means that each table
6917 may learn exactly one element from the request and one element from the
6918 response at once.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02006919
6920 The table will contain the real server that processed the request.
6921
6922 Example :
6923 # Learn SSL session ID from both request and response and create affinity.
6924 backend https
6925 mode tcp
6926 balance roundrobin
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02006927 # maximum SSL session ID length is 32 bytes.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02006928 stick-table type binary len 32 size 30k expire 30m
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006929
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02006930 acl clienthello req_ssl_hello_type 1
6931 acl serverhello rep_ssl_hello_type 2
6932
6933 # use tcp content accepts to detects ssl client and server hello.
6934 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
6935 tcp-request content accept if clienthello
6936
6937 # no timeout on response inspect delay by default.
6938 tcp-response content accept if serverhello
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006939
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02006940 # SSL session ID (SSLID) may be present on a client or server hello.
6941 # Its length is coded on 1 byte at offset 43 and its value starts
6942 # at offset 44.
6943
6944 # Match and learn on request if client hello.
6945 stick on payload_lv(43,1) if clienthello
6946
6947 # Learn on response if server hello.
6948 stick store-response payload_lv(43,1) if serverhello
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02006949
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02006950 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
6951 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
6952
6953 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", and section 7 about ACLs and pattern
6954 extraction.
6955
6956
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02006957tcp-check connect [params*]
6958 Opens a new connection
6959 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6960 no | no | yes | yes
6961
6962 When an application lies on more than a single TCP port or when HAProxy
6963 load-balance many services in a single backend, it makes sense to probe all
6964 the services individually before considering a server as operational.
6965
6966 When there are no TCP port configured on the server line neither server port
6967 directive, then the 'tcp-check connect port <port>' must be the first step
6968 of the sequence.
6969
6970 In a tcp-check ruleset a 'connect' is required, it is also mandatory to start
6971 the ruleset with a 'connect' rule. Purpose is to ensure admin know what they
6972 do.
6973
6974 Parameters :
6975 They are optional and can be used to describe how HAProxy should open and
6976 use the TCP connection.
6977
6978 port if not set, check port or server port is used.
6979 It tells HAProxy where to open the connection to.
6980 <port> must be a valid TCP port source integer, from 1 to 65535.
6981
6982 send-proxy send a PROXY protocol string
6983
6984 ssl opens a ciphered connection
6985
6986 Examples:
6987 # check HTTP and HTTPs services on a server.
6988 # first open port 80 thanks to server line port directive, then
6989 # tcp-check opens port 443, ciphered and run a request on it:
6990 option tcp-check
6991 tcp-check connect
6992 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
6993 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
6994 tcp-check send \r\n
6995 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
6996 tcp-check connect port 443 ssl
6997 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
6998 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
6999 tcp-check send \r\n
7000 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
7001 server www 10.0.0.1 check port 80
7002
7003 # check both POP and IMAP from a single server:
7004 option tcp-check
7005 tcp-check connect port 110
7006 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
7007 tcp-check connect port 143
7008 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
7009 server mail 10.0.0.1 check
7010
7011 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check send", "tcp-check expect"
7012
7013
7014tcp-check expect [!] <match> <pattern>
7015 Specify data to be collected and analysed during a generic health check
7016 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7017 no | no | yes | yes
7018
7019 Arguments :
7020 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
7021 response. The keyword may be one of "string", "rstring" or
7022 binary.
7023 The keyword may be preceded by an exclamation mark ("!") to negate
7024 the match. Spaces are allowed between the exclamation mark and the
7025 keyword. See below for more details on the supported keywords.
7026
7027 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
7028 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
7029 with the usual backslash ('\').
7030 If the match is set to binary, then the pattern must be passed as
7031 a serie of hexadecimal digits in an even number. Each sequence of
7032 two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal digits may be
7033 used upper or lower case.
7034
7035
7036 The available matches are intentionally similar to their http-check cousins :
7037
7038 string <string> : test the exact string matches in the response buffer.
7039 A health check response will be considered valid if the
7040 response's buffer contains this exact string. If the
7041 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
7042 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
7043 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory pattern
7044 in a protocol response, or to detect a failure when a
7045 specific error appears in a protocol banner.
7046
7047 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the response buffer.
7048 A health check response will be considered valid if the
7049 response's buffer matches this expression. If the
7050 "rstring" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
7051 will be considered invalid if the body matches the
7052 expression.
7053
7054 binary <hexstring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches
7055 in the response buffer. A health check response will
7056 be considered valid if the response's buffer contains
7057 this exact hexadecimal string.
7058 Purpose is to match data on binary protocols.
7059
7060 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
7061 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
7062 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
7063 "string", "rstring" or binary. If a large response is absolutely required, it
7064 is possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
7065 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
7066 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
7067 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources. Also, in its
7068 current state, the check will not find any string nor regex past a null
7069 character in the response. Similarly it is not possible to request matching
7070 the null character.
7071
7072 Examples :
7073 # perform a POP check
7074 option tcp-check
7075 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
7076
7077 # perform an IMAP check
7078 option tcp-check
7079 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
7080
7081 # look for the redis master server
7082 option tcp-check
7083 tcp-check send PING\r\n
7084 tcp-check expect +PONG
7085 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
7086 tcp-check expect string role:master
7087 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
7088 tcp-check expect string +OK
7089
7090
7091 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check send",
7092 "tcp-check send-binary", "http-check expect", tune.chksize
7093
7094
7095tcp-check send <data>
7096 Specify a string to be sent as a question during a generic health check
7097 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7098 no | no | yes | yes
7099
7100 <data> : the data to be sent as a question during a generic health check
7101 session. For now, <data> must be a string.
7102
7103 Examples :
7104 # look for the redis master server
7105 option tcp-check
7106 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
7107 tcp-check expect string role:master
7108
7109 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
7110 "tcp-check send-binary", tune.chksize
7111
7112
7113tcp-check send-binary <hexastring>
7114 Specify an hexa digits string to be sent as a binary question during a raw
7115 tcp health check
7116 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7117 no | no | yes | yes
7118
7119 <data> : the data to be sent as a question during a generic health check
7120 session. For now, <data> must be a string.
7121 <hexastring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches in the
7122 response buffer. A health check response will be considered
7123 valid if the response's buffer contains this exact
7124 hexadecimal string.
7125 Purpose is to send binary data to ask on binary protocols.
7126
7127 Examples :
7128 # redis check in binary
7129 option tcp-check
7130 tcp-check send-binary 50494e470d0a # PING\r\n
7131 tcp-check expect binary 2b504F4e47 # +PONG
7132
7133
7134 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
7135 "tcp-check send", tune.chksize
7136
7137
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007138tcp-request connection <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
7139 Perform an action on an incoming connection depending on a layer 4 condition
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02007140 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7141 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007142 Arguments :
7143 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. Valid
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007144 actions include : "accept", "reject", "track-sc0", "track-sc1",
7145 "track-sc2", and "expect-proxy". See below for more details.
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02007146
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007147 <condition> is a standard layer4-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007148
7149 Immediately after acceptance of a new incoming connection, it is possible to
7150 evaluate some conditions to decide whether this connection must be accepted
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007151 or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions cannot make use of
7152 any data contents because the connection has not been read from yet, and the
7153 buffers are not yet allocated. This is used to selectively and very quickly
7154 accept or drop connections from various sources with a very low overhead. If
7155 some contents need to be inspected in order to take the decision, the
7156 "tcp-request content" statements must be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007157
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007158 The "tcp-request connection" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
7159 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
7160 accept the incoming connection. There is no specific limit to the number of
7161 rules which may be inserted.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007162
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007163 Three types of actions are supported :
7164 - accept :
7165 accepts the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
7166 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
7167 the rules evaluation.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007168
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007169 - reject :
7170 rejects the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
7171 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
7172 the rules evaluation. Rejected connections do not even become a
7173 session, which is why they are accounted separately for in the stats,
7174 as "denied connections". They are not considered for the session
7175 rate-limit and are not logged either. The reason is that these rules
7176 should only be used to filter extremely high connection rates such as
7177 the ones encountered during a massive DDoS attack. Under these extreme
7178 conditions, the simple action of logging each event would make the
7179 system collapse and would considerably lower the filtering capacity. If
7180 logging is absolutely desired, then "tcp-request content" rules should
7181 be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007182
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +02007183 - expect-proxy layer4 :
7184 configures the client-facing connection to receive a PROXY protocol
7185 header before any byte is read from the socket. This is equivalent to
7186 having the "accept-proxy" keyword on the "bind" line, except that using
7187 the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol to be accepted only for certain
7188 IP address ranges using an ACL. This is convenient when multiple layers
7189 of load balancers are passed through by traffic coming from public
7190 hosts.
7191
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007192 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007193 enables tracking of sticky counters from current connection. These
7194 rules do not stop evaluation and do not change default action. Two sets
7195 of counters may be simultaneously tracked by the same connection. The
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007196 first "track-sc0" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the
7197 specified table as the first set. The first "track-sc1" rule executed
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007198 enables tracking of the counters of the specified table as the second
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007199 set. The first "track-sc2" rule executed enables tracking of the
7200 counters of the specified table as the third set. It is a recommended
7201 practice to use the first set of counters for the per-frontend counters
7202 and the second set for the per-backend ones. But this is just a
7203 guideline, all may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007204
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007205 These actions take one or two arguments :
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01007206 <key> is mandatory, and is a pattern extraction rule as described
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02007207 in section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01007208 request or connection will be analysed, extracted, combined,
7209 and used to select which table entry to update the counters.
7210 Note that "tcp-request connection" cannot use content-based
7211 fetches.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007212
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007213 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one,
7214 which is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All
7215 the counters for the matches and updates for the key will
7216 then be performed in that table until the session ends.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007217
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007218 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table
7219 and if it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to
7220 that entry is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's
7221 counters are updated as often as possible, every time the session's
7222 counters are updated, and also systematically when the session ends.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01007223 Counters are only updated for events that happen after the tracking has
7224 been started. For example, connection counters will not be updated when
7225 tracking layer 7 information, since the connection event happens before
7226 layer7 information is extracted.
7227
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007228 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is
7229 counted for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not
7230 expire during that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance
7231 advantage over just checking the keys, because only one table lookup is
7232 performed for all ACL checks that make use of it.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007233
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007234 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
7235 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
7236 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007237
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007238 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
7239 connection without counting them, and track accepted connections.
7240 This results in connection rate being capped from abusive sources.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007241
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007242 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007243 tcp-request connection reject if { src_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007244 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007245
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007246 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, count all other
7247 connections and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
7248 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007249
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007250 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007251 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
7252 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007253
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +02007254 Example: enable the PROXY protocol for traffic coming from all known proxies.
7255
7256 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
7257
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007258 See section 7 about ACL usage.
7259
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007260 See also : "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007261
7262
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007263tcp-request content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
7264 Perform an action on a new session depending on a layer 4-7 condition
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007265 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02007266 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007267 Arguments :
7268 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. Valid
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007269 actions include : "accept", "reject", "track-sc0", "track-sc1",
7270 and "track-sc2". See "tcp-request connection" above for their
Willy Tarreaue25c9172013-05-28 18:32:20 +02007271 signification.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007272
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007273 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007274
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007275 A request's contents can be analysed at an early stage of request processing
7276 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
7277 evaluated every time the request contents are updated, until either an
7278 "accept" or a "reject" rule matches, or the TCP request inspection delay
7279 expires with no matching rule.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007280
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007281 The first difference between these rules and "tcp-request connection" rules
7282 is that "tcp-request content" rules can make use of contents to take a
7283 decision. Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or
7284 validity. The second difference is that content-based rules can be used in
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01007285 both frontends and backends. In case of HTTP keep-alive with the client, all
7286 tcp-request content rules are evaluated again, so haproxy keeps a record of
7287 what sticky counters were assigned by a "tcp-request connection" versus a
7288 "tcp-request content" rule, and flushes all the content-related ones after
7289 processing an HTTP request, so that they may be evaluated again by the rules
7290 being evaluated again for the next request. This is of particular importance
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007291 when the rule tracks some L7 information or when it is conditioned by an
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01007292 L7-based ACL, since tracking may change between requests.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007293
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007294 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
7295 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
7296 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
7297 inserted.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007298
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007299 Three types of actions are supported :
7300 - accept :
7301 - reject :
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007302 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007303
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007304 They have the same meaning as their counter-parts in "tcp-request connection"
7305 so please refer to that section for a complete description.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007306
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01007307 While there is nothing mandatory about it, it is recommended to use the
7308 track-sc0 in "tcp-request connection" rules, track-sc1 for "tcp-request
7309 content" rules in the frontend, and track-sc2 for "tcp-request content"
7310 rules in the backend, because that makes the configuration more readable
7311 and easier to troubleshoot, but this is just a guideline and all counters
7312 may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007313
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007314 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007315 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
7316 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007317
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007318 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-request content"
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +02007319 rules, since HTTP-specific ACL matches are able to preliminarily parse the
7320 contents of a buffer before extracting the required data. If the buffered
7321 contents do not parse as a valid HTTP message, then the ACL does not match.
7322 The parser which is involved there is exactly the same as for all other HTTP
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01007323 processing, so there is no risk of parsing something differently. In an HTTP
7324 backend connected to from an HTTP frontend, it is guaranteed that HTTP
7325 contents will always be immediately present when the rule is evaluated first.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007326
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01007327 Tracking layer7 information is also possible provided that the information
7328 are present when the rule is processed. The current solution for making the
7329 rule engine wait for such information is to set an inspect delay and to
7330 condition its execution with an ACL relying on such information.
7331
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007332 Example:
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007333 # Accept HTTP requests containing a Host header saying "example.com"
7334 # and reject everything else.
7335 acl is_host_com hdr(Host) -i example.com
7336 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +02007337 tcp-request content accept if is_host_com
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007338 tcp-request content reject
7339
7340 Example:
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007341 # reject SMTP connection if client speaks first
7342 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
7343 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007344 tcp-request content reject if content_present
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007345
7346 # Forward HTTPS connection only if client speaks
7347 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
7348 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02007349 tcp-request content accept if content_present
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007350 tcp-request content reject
7351
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01007352 Example:
7353 # Track the last IP from X-Forwarded-For
7354 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007355 tcp-request content track-sc0 hdr(x-forwarded-for,-1) if HTTP
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01007356
7357 Example:
7358 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
7359 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007360 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate if HTTP
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01007361
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007362 Example: track per-frontend and per-backend counters, block abusers at the
7363 frontend when the backend detects abuse.
7364
7365 frontend http
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007366 # Use General Purpose Couter 0 in SC0 as a global abuse counter
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007367 # protecting all our sites
7368 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007369 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
7370 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_get_gpc0 gt 0 }
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007371 ...
7372 use_backend http_dynamic if { path_end .php }
7373
7374 backend http_dynamic
7375 # if a source makes too fast requests to this dynamic site (tracked
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007376 # by SC1), block it globally in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007377 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store http_req_rate(10s)
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02007378 acl click_too_fast sc1_http_req_rate gt 10
7379 acl mark_as_abuser sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 0
7380 tcp-request content track-sc1 src
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007381 tcp-request content reject if click_too_fast mark_as_abuser
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007382
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007383 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007384
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02007385 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request inspect-delay"
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007386
7387
7388tcp-request inspect-delay <timeout>
7389 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for data during content inspection
7390 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02007391 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007392 Arguments :
7393 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
7394 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7395 as explained at the top of this document.
7396
7397 People using haproxy primarily as a TCP relay are often worried about the
7398 risk of passing any type of protocol to a server without any analysis. In
7399 order to be able to analyze the request contents, we must first withhold
7400 the data then analyze them. This statement simply enables withholding of
7401 data for at most the specified amount of time.
7402
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02007403 TCP content inspection applies very early when a connection reaches a
7404 frontend, then very early when the connection is forwarded to a backend. This
7405 means that a connection may experience a first delay in the frontend and a
7406 second delay in the backend if both have tcp-request rules.
7407
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007408 Note that when performing content inspection, haproxy will evaluate the whole
7409 rules for every new chunk which gets in, taking into account the fact that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007410 those data are partial. If no rule matches before the aforementioned delay,
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007411 a last check is performed upon expiration, this time considering that the
Willy Tarreaud869b242009-03-15 14:43:58 +01007412 contents are definitive. If no delay is set, haproxy will not wait at all
7413 and will immediately apply a verdict based on the available information.
7414 Obviously this is unlikely to be very useful and might even be racy, so such
7415 setups are not recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007416
7417 As soon as a rule matches, the request is released and continues as usual. If
7418 the timeout is reached and no rule matches, the default policy will be to let
7419 it pass through unaffected.
7420
7421 For most protocols, it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients
7422 send the full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to
7423 cover TCP retransmits but that's all. For some protocols, it may make sense
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007424 to use large values, for instance to ensure that the client never talks
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007425 before the server (eg: SMTP), or to wait for a client to talk before passing
7426 data to the server (eg: SSL). Note that the client timeout must cover at
Willy Tarreaub824b002010-09-29 16:36:16 +02007427 least the inspection delay, otherwise it will expire first. If the client
7428 closes the connection or if the buffer is full, the delay immediately expires
7429 since the contents will not be able to change anymore.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007430
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02007431 See also : "tcp-request content accept", "tcp-request content reject",
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02007432 "timeout client".
7433
7434
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02007435tcp-response content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
7436 Perform an action on a session response depending on a layer 4-7 condition
7437 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7438 no | no | yes | yes
7439 Arguments :
7440 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. Valid
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02007441 actions include : "accept", "close", "reject".
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02007442
7443 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
7444
7445 Response contents can be analysed at an early stage of response processing
7446 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
7447 evaluated every time the response contents are updated, until either an
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02007448 "accept", "close" or a "reject" rule matches, or a TCP response inspection
7449 delay is set and expires with no matching rule.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02007450
7451 Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or validity.
7452
7453 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
7454 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
7455 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
7456 inserted.
7457
7458 Two types of actions are supported :
7459 - accept :
7460 accepts the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
7461 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
7462 the rules evaluation.
7463
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02007464 - close :
7465 immediately closes the connection with the server if the condition is
7466 true (when used with "if"), or false (when used with "unless"). The
7467 first such rule executed ends the rules evaluation. The main purpose of
7468 this action is to force a connection to be finished between a client
7469 and a server after an exchange when the application protocol expects
7470 some long time outs to elapse first. The goal is to eliminate idle
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007471 connections which take significant resources on servers with certain
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02007472 protocols.
7473
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02007474 - reject :
7475 rejects the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
7476 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04007477 the rules evaluation. Rejected session are immediately closed.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02007478
7479 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
7480 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
7481 for changing the default action to a reject.
7482
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04007483 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-response
7484 content" rules, but then it is important to ensure that a full response has
7485 been buffered, otherwise no contents will match. In order to achieve this,
7486 the best solution involves detecting the HTTP protocol during the inspection
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02007487 period.
7488
7489 See section 7 about ACL usage.
7490
7491 See also : "tcp-request content", "tcp-response inspect-delay"
7492
7493
7494tcp-response inspect-delay <timeout>
7495 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a response during content inspection
7496 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7497 no | no | yes | yes
7498 Arguments :
7499 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
7500 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7501 as explained at the top of this document.
7502
7503 See also : "tcp-response content", "tcp-request inspect-delay".
7504
7505
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01007506timeout check <timeout>
7507 Set additional check timeout, but only after a connection has been already
7508 established.
7509
7510 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7511 yes | no | yes | yes
7512 Arguments:
7513 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
7514 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7515 as explained at the top of this document.
7516
7517 If set, haproxy uses min("timeout connect", "inter") as a connect timeout
7518 for check and "timeout check" as an additional read timeout. The "min" is
7519 used so that people running with *very* long "timeout connect" (eg. those
7520 who needed this due to the queue or tarpit) do not slow down their checks.
Willy Tarreaud7550a22010-02-10 05:10:19 +01007521 (Please also note that there is no valid reason to have such long connect
7522 timeouts, because "timeout queue" and "timeout tarpit" can always be used to
7523 avoid that).
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01007524
7525 If "timeout check" is not set haproxy uses "inter" for complete check
7526 timeout (connect + read) exactly like all <1.3.15 version.
7527
7528 In most cases check request is much simpler and faster to handle than normal
7529 requests and people may want to kick out laggy servers so this timeout should
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01007530 be smaller than "timeout server".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01007531
7532 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
7533 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
7534 forget about it.
7535
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01007536 See also: "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout server",
7537 "timeout tarpit".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01007538
7539
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007540timeout client <timeout>
7541timeout clitimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
7542 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
7543 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7544 yes | yes | yes | no
7545 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007546 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007547 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7548 as explained at the top of this document.
7549
7550 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
7551 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
7552 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
7553 response while it is reading data sent by the server. The value is specified
7554 in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
7555 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
7556 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
7557 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01007558 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007559 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02007560 (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). If some long-lived sessions are mixed with short-lived
7561 sessions (eg: WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering "timeout tunnel",
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02007562 which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for tunnels, as well as
7563 "timeout client-fin" for half-closed connections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007564
7565 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
7566 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
7567 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
7568 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
7569 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
7570 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
7571
7572 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "clitimeout". It is recommended
7573 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout clitimeout" is
7574 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
7575
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02007576 See also : "clitimeout", "timeout server", "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007577
7578
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02007579timeout client-fin <timeout>
7580 Set the inactivity timeout on the client side for half-closed connections.
7581 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7582 yes | yes | yes | no
7583 Arguments :
7584 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
7585 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7586 as explained at the top of this document.
7587
7588 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
7589 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
7590 from "timeout client" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
7591 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
7592 FIN_WAIT state for too long when clients do not disconnect cleanly. This
7593 problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
7594 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
7595 down in one direction.
7596
7597 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
7598 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
7599 will use the other timeouts (timeout.client or timeout.tunnel).
7600
7601 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server-fin", and "timeout tunnel".
7602
7603
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007604timeout connect <timeout>
7605timeout contimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
7606 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
7607 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7608 yes | no | yes | yes
7609 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007610 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007611 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7612 as explained at the top of this document.
7613
7614 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01007615 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007616 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007617 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01007618 connect timeout also presets both queue and tarpit timeouts to the same value
7619 if these have not been specified.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007620
7621 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
7622 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
7623 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
7624 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
7625 during startup because it may results in accumulation of failed sessions in
7626 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
7627
7628 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "contimeout". It is recommended
7629 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout contimeout" is
7630 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
7631
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01007632 See also: "timeout check", "timeout queue", "timeout server", "contimeout",
7633 "timeout tarpit".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007634
7635
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01007636timeout http-keep-alive <timeout>
7637 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a new HTTP request to appear
7638 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7639 yes | yes | yes | yes
7640 Arguments :
7641 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
7642 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7643 as explained at the top of this document.
7644
7645 By default, the time to wait for a new request in case of keep-alive is set
7646 by "timeout http-request". However this is not always convenient because some
7647 people want very short keep-alive timeouts in order to release connections
7648 faster, and others prefer to have larger ones but still have short timeouts
7649 once the request has started to present itself.
7650
7651 The "http-keep-alive" timeout covers these needs. It will define how long to
7652 wait for a new HTTP request to start coming after a response was sent. Once
7653 the first byte of request has been seen, the "http-request" timeout is used
7654 to wait for the complete request to come. Note that empty lines prior to a
7655 new request do not refresh the timeout and are not counted as a new request.
7656
7657 There is also another difference between the two timeouts : when a connection
7658 expires during timeout http-keep-alive, no error is returned, the connection
7659 just closes. If the connection expires in "http-request" while waiting for a
7660 connection to complete, a HTTP 408 error is returned.
7661
7662 In general it is optimal to set this value to a few tens to hundreds of
7663 milliseconds, to allow users to fetch all objects of a page at once but
7664 without waiting for further clicks. Also, if set to a very small value (eg:
7665 1 millisecond) it will probably only accept pipelined requests but not the
7666 non-pipelined ones. It may be a nice trade-off for very large sites running
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +02007667 with tens to hundreds of thousands of clients.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01007668
7669 If this parameter is not set, the "http-request" timeout applies, and if both
7670 are not set, "timeout client" still applies at the lower level. It should be
7671 set in the frontend to take effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in
7672 which case the HTTP backend's timeout will be used.
7673
7674 See also : "timeout http-request", "timeout client".
7675
7676
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01007677timeout http-request <timeout>
7678 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a complete HTTP request
7679 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +02007680 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01007681 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007682 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01007683 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7684 as explained at the top of this document.
7685
7686 In order to offer DoS protection, it may be required to lower the maximum
7687 accepted time to receive a complete HTTP request without affecting the client
7688 timeout. This helps protecting against established connections on which
7689 nothing is sent. The client timeout cannot offer a good protection against
7690 this abuse because it is an inactivity timeout, which means that if the
7691 attacker sends one character every now and then, the timeout will not
7692 trigger. With the HTTP request timeout, no matter what speed the client
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +02007693 types, the request will be aborted if it does not complete in time. When the
7694 timeout expires, an HTTP 408 response is sent to the client to inform it
7695 about the problem, and the connection is closed. The logs will report
7696 termination codes "cR". Some recent browsers are having problems with this
7697 standard, well-documented behaviour, so it might be needed to hide the 408
7698 code using "errorfile 408 /dev/null". See more details in the explanations of
7699 the "cR" termination code in section 8.5.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01007700
7701 Note that this timeout only applies to the header part of the request, and
7702 not to any data. As soon as the empty line is received, this timeout is not
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01007703 used anymore. It is used again on keep-alive connections to wait for a second
7704 request if "timeout http-keep-alive" is not set.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01007705
7706 Generally it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients send the
7707 full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to cover TCP
7708 retransmits but that's all. Setting it to very low values (eg: 50 ms) will
7709 generally work on local networks as long as there are no packet losses. This
7710 will prevent people from sending bare HTTP requests using telnet.
7711
7712 If this parameter is not set, the client timeout still applies between each
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +02007713 chunk of the incoming request. It should be set in the frontend to take
7714 effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in which case the HTTP backend's
7715 timeout will be used.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01007716
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +02007717 See also : "errorfile", "timeout http-keep-alive", "timeout client".
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01007718
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007719
7720timeout queue <timeout>
7721 Set the maximum time to wait in the queue for a connection slot to be free
7722 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7723 yes | no | yes | yes
7724 Arguments :
7725 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
7726 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7727 as explained at the top of this document.
7728
7729 When a server's maxconn is reached, connections are left pending in a queue
7730 which may be server-specific or global to the backend. In order not to wait
7731 indefinitely, a timeout is applied to requests pending in the queue. If the
7732 timeout is reached, it is considered that the request will almost never be
7733 served, so it is dropped and a 503 error is returned to the client.
7734
7735 The "timeout queue" statement allows to fix the maximum time for a request to
7736 be left pending in a queue. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's
7737 connection timeout ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility
7738 with older versions with no "timeout queue" parameter.
7739
7740 See also : "timeout connect", "contimeout".
7741
7742
7743timeout server <timeout>
7744timeout srvtimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
7745 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
7746 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7747 yes | no | yes | yes
7748 Arguments :
7749 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
7750 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7751 as explained at the top of this document.
7752
7753 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
7754 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
7755 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
7756 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
7757 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
7758 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
7759 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
7760
7761 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
7762 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
7763 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
7764 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
7765 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01007766 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007767 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02007768 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum). If some long-lived sessions are mixed
7769 with short-lived sessions (eg: WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering
7770 "timeout tunnel", which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for
7771 tunnels.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007772
7773 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
7774 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
7775 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
7776 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
7777 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
7778 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
7779
7780 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "srvtimeout". It is recommended
7781 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout srvtimeout" is
7782 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
7783
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02007784 See also : "srvtimeout", "timeout client" and "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007785
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02007786
7787timeout server-fin <timeout>
7788 Set the inactivity timeout on the server side for half-closed connections.
7789 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7790 yes | no | yes | yes
7791 Arguments :
7792 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
7793 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7794 as explained at the top of this document.
7795
7796 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
7797 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
7798 from "timeout server" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
7799 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
7800 FIN_WAIT state for too long when a remote server does not disconnect cleanly.
7801 This problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
7802 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
7803 down in one direction. This setting was provided for completeness, but in most
7804 situations, it should not be needed.
7805
7806 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
7807 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
7808 will use the other timeouts (timeout.server or timeout.tunnel).
7809
7810 See also : "timeout client-fin", "timeout server", and "timeout tunnel".
7811
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007812
7813timeout tarpit <timeout>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01007814 Set the duration for which tarpitted connections will be maintained
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007815 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7816 yes | yes | yes | yes
7817 Arguments :
7818 <timeout> is the tarpit duration specified in milliseconds by default, but
7819 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7820 as explained at the top of this document.
7821
7822 When a connection is tarpitted using "reqtarpit", it is maintained open with
7823 no activity for a certain amount of time, then closed. "timeout tarpit"
7824 defines how long it will be maintained open.
7825
7826 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
7827 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
7828 document. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's connection timeout
7829 ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility with older versions
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01007830 with no "timeout tarpit" parameter.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007831
7832 See also : "timeout connect", "contimeout".
7833
7834
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02007835timeout tunnel <timeout>
7836 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client and server side for tunnels.
7837 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7838 yes | no | yes | yes
7839 Arguments :
7840 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
7841 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7842 as explained at the top of this document.
7843
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04007844 The tunnel timeout applies when a bidirectional connection is established
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02007845 between a client and a server, and the connection remains inactive in both
7846 directions. This timeout supersedes both the client and server timeouts once
7847 the connection becomes a tunnel. In TCP, this timeout is used as soon as no
7848 analyser remains attached to either connection (eg: tcp content rules are
7849 accepted). In HTTP, this timeout is used when a connection is upgraded (eg:
7850 when switching to the WebSocket protocol, or forwarding a CONNECT request
7851 to a proxy), or after the first response when no keepalive/close option is
7852 specified.
7853
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02007854 Since this timeout is usually used in conjunction with long-lived connections,
7855 it usually is a good idea to also set "timeout client-fin" to handle the
7856 situation where a client suddenly disappears from the net and does not
7857 acknowledge a close, or sends a shutdown and does not acknowledge pending
7858 data anymore. This can happen in lossy networks where firewalls are present,
7859 and is detected by the presence of large amounts of sessions in a FIN_WAIT
7860 state.
7861
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02007862 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
7863 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
7864 document. Whatever the expected normal idle time, it is a good practice to
7865 cover at least one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that
7866 are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
7867
7868 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
7869 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
7870 forget about it.
7871
7872 Example :
7873 defaults http
7874 option http-server-close
7875 timeout connect 5s
7876 timeout client 30s
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02007877 timeout client-fin 30s
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02007878 timeout server 30s
7879 timeout tunnel 1h # timeout to use with WebSocket and CONNECT
7880
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02007881 See also : "timeout client", "timeout client-fin", "timeout server".
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02007882
7883
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007884transparent (deprecated)
7885 Enable client-side transparent proxying
7886 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01007887 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007888 Arguments : none
7889
7890 This keyword was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer
7891 3 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
7892 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
7893 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
7894 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
7895 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
7896 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
7897 appropriate server.
7898
7899 The "transparent" keyword is deprecated, use "option transparent" instead.
7900
7901 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
7902 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
7903
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007904 See also: "option transparent"
7905
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01007906unique-id-format <string>
7907 Generate a unique ID for each request.
7908 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7909 yes | yes | yes | no
7910 Arguments :
7911 <string> is a log-format string.
7912
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007913 This keyword creates a ID for each request using the custom log format. A
7914 unique ID is useful to trace a request passing through many components of
7915 a complex infrastructure. The newly created ID may also be logged using the
7916 %ID tag the log-format string.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01007917
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007918 The format should be composed from elements that are guaranteed to be
7919 unique when combined together. For instance, if multiple haproxy instances
7920 are involved, it might be important to include the node name. It is often
7921 needed to log the incoming connection's source and destination addresses
7922 and ports. Note that since multiple requests may be performed over the same
7923 connection, including a request counter may help differentiate them.
7924 Similarly, a timestamp may protect against a rollover of the counter.
7925 Logging the process ID will avoid collisions after a service restart.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01007926
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007927 It is recommended to use hexadecimal notation for many fields since it
7928 makes them more compact and saves space in logs.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01007929
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007930 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01007931
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -05007932 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01007933
7934 will generate:
7935
7936 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
7937
7938 See also: "unique-id-header"
7939
7940unique-id-header <name>
7941 Add a unique ID header in the HTTP request.
7942 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7943 yes | yes | yes | no
7944 Arguments :
7945 <name> is the name of the header.
7946
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007947 Add a unique-id header in the HTTP request sent to the server, using the
7948 unique-id-format. It can't work if the unique-id-format doesn't exist.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01007949
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007950 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01007951
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -05007952 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01007953 unique-id-header X-Unique-ID
7954
7955 will generate:
7956
7957 X-Unique-ID: 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
7958
7959 See also: "unique-id-format"
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007960
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +02007961use_backend <backend> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +02007962 Switch to a specific backend if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007963 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7964 no | yes | yes | no
7965 Arguments :
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01007966 <backend> is the name of a valid backend or "listen" section, or a
7967 "log-format" string resolving to a backend name.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007968
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +02007969 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7. If
7970 it is omitted, the rule is unconditionally applied.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007971
7972 When doing content-switching, connections arrive on a frontend and are then
7973 dispatched to various backends depending on a number of conditions. The
7974 relation between the conditions and the backends is described with the
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +02007975 "use_backend" keyword. While it is normally used with HTTP processing, it can
7976 also be used in pure TCP, either without content using stateless ACLs (eg:
7977 source address validation) or combined with a "tcp-request" rule to wait for
7978 some payload.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007979
7980 There may be as many "use_backend" rules as desired. All of these rules are
7981 evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which matches will
7982 assign the backend.
7983
7984 In the first form, the backend will be used if the condition is met. In the
7985 second form, the backend will be used if the condition is not met. If no
7986 condition is valid, the backend defined with "default_backend" will be used.
7987 If no default backend is defined, either the servers in the same section are
7988 used (in case of a "listen" section) or, in case of a frontend, no server is
7989 used and a 503 service unavailable response is returned.
7990
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +02007991 Note that it is possible to switch from a TCP frontend to an HTTP backend. In
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007992 this case, either the frontend has already checked that the protocol is HTTP,
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +02007993 and backend processing will immediately follow, or the backend will wait for
7994 a complete HTTP request to get in. This feature is useful when a frontend
7995 must decode several protocols on a unique port, one of them being HTTP.
7996
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01007997 When <backend> is a simple name, it is resolved at configuration time, and an
7998 error is reported if the specified backend does not exist. If <backend> is
7999 a log-format string instead, no check may be done at configuration time, so
8000 the backend name is resolved dynamically at run time. If the resulting
8001 backend name does not correspond to any valid backend, no other rule is
8002 evaluated, and the default_backend directive is applied instead. Note that
8003 when using dynamic backend names, it is highly recommended to use a prefix
8004 that no other backend uses in order to ensure that an unauthorized backend
8005 cannot be forced from the request.
8006
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008007 It is worth mentioning that "use_backend" rules with an explicit name are
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01008008 used to detect the association between frontends and backends to compute the
8009 backend's "fullconn" setting. This cannot be done for dynamic names.
8010
8011 See also: "default_backend", "tcp-request", "fullconn", "log-format", and
8012 section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008013
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01008014
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02008015use-server <server> if <condition>
8016use-server <server> unless <condition>
8017 Only use a specific server if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
8018 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8019 no | no | yes | yes
8020 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008021 <server> is the name of a valid server in the same backend section.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02008022
8023 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7.
8024
8025 By default, connections which arrive to a backend are load-balanced across
8026 the available servers according to the configured algorithm, unless a
8027 persistence mechanism such as a cookie is used and found in the request.
8028
8029 Sometimes it is desirable to forward a particular request to a specific
8030 server without having to declare a dedicated backend for this server. This
8031 can be achieved using the "use-server" rules. These rules are evaluated after
8032 the "redirect" rules and before evaluating cookies, and they have precedence
8033 on them. There may be as many "use-server" rules as desired. All of these
8034 rules are evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which
8035 matches will assign the server.
8036
8037 If a rule designates a server which is down, and "option persist" is not used
8038 and no force-persist rule was validated, it is ignored and evaluation goes on
8039 with the next rules until one matches.
8040
8041 In the first form, the server will be used if the condition is met. In the
8042 second form, the server will be used if the condition is not met. If no
8043 condition is valid, the processing continues and the server will be assigned
8044 according to other persistence mechanisms.
8045
8046 Note that even if a rule is matched, cookie processing is still performed but
8047 does not assign the server. This allows prefixed cookies to have their prefix
8048 stripped.
8049
8050 The "use-server" statement works both in HTTP and TCP mode. This makes it
8051 suitable for use with content-based inspection. For instance, a server could
8052 be selected in a farm according to the TLS SNI field. And if these servers
8053 have their weight set to zero, they will not be used for other traffic.
8054
8055 Example :
8056 # intercept incoming TLS requests based on the SNI field
8057 use-server www if { req_ssl_sni -i www.example.com }
8058 server www 192.168.0.1:443 weight 0
8059 use-server mail if { req_ssl_sni -i mail.example.com }
8060 server mail 192.168.0.1:587 weight 0
8061 use-server imap if { req_ssl_sni -i imap.example.com }
8062 server mail 192.168.0.1:993 weight 0
8063 # all the rest is forwarded to this server
8064 server default 192.168.0.2:443 check
8065
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008066 See also: "use_backend", section 5 about server and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02008067
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008068
80695. Bind and Server options
8070--------------------------
8071
8072The "bind", "server" and "default-server" keywords support a number of settings
8073depending on some build options and on the system HAProxy was built on. These
8074settings generally each consist in one word sometimes followed by a value,
8075written on the same line as the "bind" or "server" line. All these options are
8076described in this section.
8077
8078
80795.1. Bind options
8080-----------------
8081
8082The "bind" keyword supports a certain number of settings which are all passed
8083as arguments on the same line. The order in which those arguments appear makes
8084no importance, provided that they appear after the bind address. All of these
8085parameters are optional. Some of them consist in a single words (booleans),
8086while other ones expect a value after them. In this case, the value must be
8087provided immediately after the setting name.
8088
8089The currently supported settings are the following ones.
8090
8091accept-proxy
8092 Enforces the use of the PROXY protocol over any connection accepted by any of
8093 the sockets declared on the same line. The PROXY protocol dictates the layer
8094 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is
8095 used, with the only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will
8096 only see the real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses
8097 indicated in the protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real
8098 address will still be used. This keyword combined with support from external
8099 components can be used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the
8100 X-Forwarded-For mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +02008101 usable. See also "tcp-request connection expect-proxy" for a finer-grained
8102 setting of which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008103
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +02008104alpn <protocols>
8105 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
8106 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
8107 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
8108 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS
8109 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
8110 initial NPN extension.
8111
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008112backlog <backlog>
8113 Sets the socket's backlog to this value. If unspecified, the frontend's
8114 backlog is used instead, which generally defaults to the maxconn value.
8115
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +02008116ecdhe <named curve>
8117 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
Emeric Brun6924ef82013-03-06 14:08:53 +01008118 the named curve (RFC 4492) used to generate ECDH ephemeral keys. By default,
8119 used named curve is prime256v1.
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +02008120
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +02008121ca-file <cafile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +02008122 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
8123 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
8124 client's certificate.
8125
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +02008126ca-ignore-err [all|<errorID>,...]
8127 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
8128 Sets a comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth > 0.
8129 If set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an
8130 error is ignored.
8131
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008132ciphers <ciphers>
8133 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
8134 the string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008135 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake. The format of the string is defined
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008136 in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages, and can be for instance a string
8137 such as "AES:ALL:!aNULL:!eNULL:+RC4:@STRENGTH" (without quotes).
8138
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +02008139crl-file <crlfile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +02008140 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
8141 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
8142 to verify client's certificate.
8143
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008144crt <cert>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00008145 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
8146 designates a PEM file containing both the required certificates and any
8147 associated private keys. This file can be built by concatenating multiple
8148 PEM files into one (e.g. cat cert.pem key.pem > combined.pem). If your CA
8149 requires an intermediate certificate, this can also be concatenated into this
8150 file.
8151
8152 If the OpenSSL used supports Diffie-Hellman, parameters present in this file
8153 are loaded.
8154
8155 If a directory name is used instead of a PEM file, then all files found in
8156 that directory will be loaded. This directive may be specified multiple times
8157 in order to load certificates from multiple files or directories. The
8158 certificates will be presented to clients who provide a valid TLS Server Name
8159 Indication field matching one of their CN or alt subjects. Wildcards are
8160 supported, where a wildcard character '*' is used instead of the first
8161 hostname component (eg: *.example.org matches www.example.org but not
8162 www.sub.example.org).
8163
8164 If no SNI is provided by the client or if the SSL library does not support
8165 TLS extensions, or if the client provides an SNI hostname which does not
8166 match any certificate, then the first loaded certificate will be presented.
8167 This means that when loading certificates from a directory, it is highly
8168 recommended to load the default one first as a file.
8169
Emeric Brune032bfa2012-09-28 13:01:45 +02008170 Note that the same cert may be loaded multiple times without side effects.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008171
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00008172 Some CAs (such as Godaddy) offer a drop down list of server types that do not
8173 include HAProxy when obtaining a certificate. If this happens be sure to
Godbach8bf60a12014-04-21 21:42:41 +08008174 choose a webserver that the CA believes requires an intermediate CA (for
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00008175 Godaddy, selection Apache Tomcat will get the correct bundle, but many
8176 others, e.g. nginx, result in a wrong bundle that will not work for some
8177 clients).
8178
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +02008179crt-ignore-err <errors>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00008180 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. Sets a
8181 comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth == 0. If
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008182 set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an error
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +00008183 is ignored.
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +02008184
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +01008185crt-list <file>
8186 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +02008187 designates a list of PEM file with an optional list of SNI filter per
8188 certificate, with the following format for each line :
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +01008189
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +02008190 <crtfile> [[!]<snifilter> ...]
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +01008191
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +02008192 Wildcards are supported in the SNI filter. Negative filter are also supported,
8193 only useful in combination with a wildcard filter to exclude a particular SNI.
8194 The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a valid TLS Server
8195 Name Indication field matching one of the SNI filters. If no SNI filter is
8196 specified, the CN and alt subjects are used. This directive may be specified
8197 multiple times. See the "crt" option for more information. The default
8198 certificate is still needed to meet OpenSSL expectations. If it is not used,
8199 the 'strict-sni' option may be used.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +01008200
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008201defer-accept
8202 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
8203 states that a connection will only be accepted once some data arrive on it,
8204 or at worst after the first retransmit. This should be used only on protocols
8205 for which the client talks first (eg: HTTP). It can slightly improve
8206 performance by ensuring that most of the request is already available when
8207 the connection is accepted. On the other hand, it will not be able to detect
8208 connections which don't talk. It is important to note that this option is
8209 broken in all kernels up to 2.6.31, as the connection is never accepted until
8210 the client talks. This can cause issues with front firewalls which would see
8211 an established connection while the proxy will only see it in SYN_RECV. This
8212 option is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones.
8213
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02008214force-sslv3
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008215 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02008216 this listener. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts
8217 for high connection rates. See also "force-tls*", "no-sslv3", and "no-tls*".
8218
8219force-tlsv10
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008220 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02008221 this listener. See also "force-tls*", "no-sslv3", and "no-tls*".
8222
8223force-tlsv11
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008224 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02008225 this listener. See also "force-tls*", "no-sslv3", and "no-tls*".
8226
8227force-tlsv12
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008228 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02008229 this listener. See also "force-tls*", "no-sslv3", and "no-tls*".
8230
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008231gid <gid>
8232 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system gid. It can also
8233 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
8234 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "group"
8235 setting except that the group ID is used instead of its name. This setting is
8236 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
8237
8238group <group>
8239 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system group. It can
8240 also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note
8241 that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the
8242 "gid" setting except that the group name is used instead of its gid. This
8243 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
8244
8245id <id>
8246 Fixes the socket ID. By default, socket IDs are automatically assigned, but
8247 sometimes it is more convenient to fix them to ease monitoring. This value
8248 must be strictly positive and unique within the listener/frontend. This
8249 option can only be used when defining only a single socket.
8250
8251interface <interface>
Lukas Tribusfce2e962013-02-12 22:13:19 +01008252 Restricts the socket to a specific interface. When specified, only packets
8253 received from that particular interface are processed by the socket. This is
8254 currently only supported on Linux. The interface must be a primary system
8255 interface, not an aliased interface. It is also possible to bind multiple
8256 frontends to the same address if they are bound to different interfaces. Note
8257 that binding to a network interface requires root privileges. This parameter
8258 is only compatible with TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008259
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02008260level <level>
8261 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to restrict the nature of
8262 the commands that can be issued on the socket. It is ignored by other
8263 sockets. <level> can be one of :
8264 - "user" is the least privileged level ; only non-sensitive stats can be
8265 read, and no change is allowed. It would make sense on systems where it
8266 is not easy to restrict access to the socket.
8267 - "operator" is the default level and fits most common uses. All data can
8268 be read, and only non-sensitive changes are permitted (eg: clear max
8269 counters).
8270 - "admin" should be used with care, as everything is permitted (eg: clear
8271 all counters).
8272
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008273maxconn <maxconn>
8274 Limits the sockets to this number of concurrent connections. Extraneous
8275 connections will remain in the system's backlog until a connection is
8276 released. If unspecified, the limit will be the same as the frontend's
8277 maxconn. Note that in case of port ranges or multiple addresses, the same
8278 value will be applied to each socket. This setting enables different
8279 limitations on expensive sockets, for instance SSL entries which may easily
8280 eat all memory.
8281
8282mode <mode>
8283 Sets the octal mode used to define access permissions on the UNIX socket. It
8284 can also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement.
8285 Note that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is ignored by non
8286 UNIX sockets.
8287
8288mss <maxseg>
8289 Sets the TCP Maximum Segment Size (MSS) value to be advertised on incoming
8290 connections. This can be used to force a lower MSS for certain specific
8291 ports, for instance for connections passing through a VPN. Note that this
8292 relies on a kernel feature which is theoretically supported under Linux but
8293 was buggy in all versions prior to 2.6.28. It may or may not work on other
8294 operating systems. It may also not change the advertised value but change the
8295 effective size of outgoing segments. The commonly advertised value for TCPv4
8296 over Ethernet networks is 1460 = 1500(MTU) - 40(IP+TCP). If this value is
8297 positive, it will be used as the advertised MSS. If it is negative, it will
8298 indicate by how much to reduce the incoming connection's advertised MSS for
8299 outgoing segments. This parameter is only compatible with TCP v4/v6 sockets.
8300
8301name <name>
8302 Sets an optional name for these sockets, which will be reported on the stats
8303 page.
8304
8305nice <nice>
8306 Sets the 'niceness' of connections initiated from the socket. Value must be
8307 in the range -1024..1024 inclusive, and defaults to zero. Positive values
8308 means that such connections are more friendly to others and easily offer
8309 their place in the scheduler. On the opposite, negative values mean that
8310 connections want to run with a higher priority than others. The difference
8311 only happens under high loads when the system is close to saturation.
8312 Negative values are appropriate for low-latency or administration services,
8313 and high values are generally recommended for CPU intensive tasks such as SSL
8314 processing or bulk transfers which are less sensible to latency. For example,
8315 it may make sense to use a positive value for an SMTP socket and a negative
8316 one for an RDP socket.
8317
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02008318no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008319 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008320 disables support for SSLv3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener when
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008321 SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and cannot
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02008322 be enabled using any configuration option. See also "force-tls*",
8323 and "force-sslv3".
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008324
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +02008325no-tls-tickets
8326 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
8327 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
8328 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
8329 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage.
8330
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02008331no-tlsv10
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008332 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008333 disables support for TLSv1.0 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02008334 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
8335 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. See also "force-tls*",
8336 and "force-sslv3".
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008337
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02008338no-tlsv11
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02008339 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008340 disables support for TLSv1.1 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02008341 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
8342 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. See also "force-tls*",
8343 and "force-sslv3".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02008344
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02008345no-tlsv12
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02008346 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008347 disables support for TLSv1.2 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +02008348 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
8349 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. See also "force-tls*",
8350 and "force-sslv3".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02008351
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +02008352npn <protocols>
8353 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
8354 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
8355 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
8356 This requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +02008357 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
8358 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword).
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +02008359
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02008360process [ all | odd | even | <number 1-64>[-<number 1-64>] ]
8361 This restricts the list of processes on which this listener is allowed to
8362 run. It does not enforce any process but eliminates those which do not match.
8363 If the frontend uses a "bind-process" setting, the intersection between the
8364 two is applied. If in the end the listener is not allowed to run on any
8365 remaining process, a warning is emitted, and the listener will either run on
8366 the first process of the listener if a single process was specified, or on
8367 all of its processes if multiple processes were specified. For the unlikely
Willy Tarreauae302532014-05-07 19:22:24 +02008368 case where several ranges are needed, this directive may be repeated. The
8369 main purpose of this directive is to be used with the stats sockets and have
8370 one different socket per process. The second purpose is to have multiple bind
8371 lines sharing the same IP:port but not the same process in a listener, so
8372 that the system can distribute the incoming connections into multiple queues
8373 and allow a smoother inter-process load balancing. Currently Linux 3.9 and
8374 above is known for supporting this. See also "bind-process" and "nbproc".
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02008375
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008376ssl
8377 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008378 enables SSL deciphering on connections instantiated from this listener. A
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008379 certificate is necessary (see "crt" above). All contents in the buffers will
8380 appear in clear text, so that ACLs and HTTP processing will only have access
8381 to deciphered contents.
8382
Emmanuel Hocdet65623372013-01-24 17:17:15 +01008383strict-sni
8384 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. The
8385 SSL/TLS negotiation is allow only if the client provided an SNI which match
8386 a certificate. The default certificate is not used.
8387 See the "crt" option for more information.
8388
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +02008389tfo
Lukas Tribus0defb902013-02-13 23:35:39 +01008390 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on Linux kernels >= 3.7. It
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +02008391 enables TCP Fast Open on the listening socket, which means that clients which
8392 support this feature will be able to send a request and receive a response
8393 during the 3-way handshake starting from second connection, thus saving one
8394 round-trip after the first connection. This only makes sense with protocols
8395 that use high connection rates and where each round trip matters. This can
8396 possibly cause issues with many firewalls which do not accept data on SYN
8397 packets, so this option should only be enabled once well tested. This option
Lukas Tribus0999f762013-04-02 16:43:24 +02008398 is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones. You may
8399 need to build HAProxy with USE_TFO=1 if your libc doesn't define
8400 TCP_FASTOPEN.
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +02008401
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008402transparent
8403 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
8404 indicates that the addresses will be bound even if they do not belong to the
8405 local machine, and that packets targeting any of these addresses will be
8406 intercepted just as if the addresses were locally configured. This normally
8407 requires that IP forwarding is enabled. Caution! do not use this with the
8408 default address '*', as it would redirect any traffic for the specified port.
8409 This keyword is available only when HAProxy is built with USE_LINUX_TPROXY=1.
8410 This parameter is only compatible with TCPv4 and TCPv6 sockets, depending on
8411 kernel version. Some distribution kernels include backports of the feature,
8412 so check for support with your vendor.
8413
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +01008414v4v6
8415 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
8416 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to both IPv4
8417 and IPv6 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes necessary
8418 on systems which bind to IPv6 only by default. It has no effect on non-IPv6
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008419 sockets, and is overridden by the "v6only" option.
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +01008420
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +01008421v6only
8422 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
8423 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to IPv6 only
8424 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes preferred to doing it
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +01008425 system-wide as it is per-listener. It has no effect on non-IPv6 sockets and
8426 has precedence over the "v4v6" option.
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +01008427
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008428uid <uid>
8429 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system uid. It can also
8430 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
8431 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "user"
8432 setting except that the user numeric ID is used instead of its name. This
8433 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
8434
8435user <user>
8436 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system user. It can also
8437 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
8438 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "uid"
8439 setting except that the user name is used instead of its uid. This setting is
8440 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
8441
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +02008442verify [none|optional|required]
8443 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
8444 to 'none', client certificate is not requested. This is the default. In other
8445 cases, a client certificate is requested. If the client does not provide a
8446 certificate after the request and if 'verify' is set to 'required', then the
8447 handshake is aborted, while it would have succeeded if set to 'optional'. The
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +02008448 certificate provided by the client is always verified using CAs from
8449 'ca-file' and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. On verify failure the handshake
8450 is aborted, regardless of the 'verify' option, unless the error code exactly
8451 matches one of those listed with 'ca-ignore-err' or 'crt-ignore-err'.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02008452
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020084535.2. Server and default-server options
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01008454------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008455
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01008456The "server" and "default-server" keywords support a certain number of settings
8457which are all passed as arguments on the server line. The order in which those
8458arguments appear does not count, and they are all optional. Some of those
8459settings are single words (booleans) while others expect one or several values
8460after them. In this case, the values must immediately follow the setting name.
8461Except default-server, all those settings must be specified after the server's
8462address if they are used:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008463
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008464 server <name> <address>[:port] [settings ...]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01008465 default-server [settings ...]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008466
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008467The currently supported settings are the following ones.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008468
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +02008469addr <ipv4|ipv6>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008470 Using the "addr" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different IP address
8471 to send health-checks. On some servers, it may be desirable to dedicate an IP
8472 address to specific component able to perform complex tests which are more
8473 suitable to health-checks than the application. This parameter is ignored if
8474 the "check" parameter is not set. See also the "port" parameter.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008475
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008476 Supported in default-server: No
8477
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09008478agent-check
8479 Enable an auxiliary agent check which is run independently of a regular
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01008480 health check. An agent health check is performed by making a TCP connection
8481 to the port set by the "agent-port" parameter and reading an ASCII string.
8482 The string is made of a series of words delimited by spaces, tabs or commas
8483 in any order, optionally terminated by '\r' and/or '\n', each consisting of :
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09008484
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01008485 - An ASCII representation of a positive integer percentage, e.g. "75%".
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09008486 Values in this format will set the weight proportional to the initial
8487 weight of a server as configured when haproxy starts.
8488
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01008489 - The word "ready". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
8490 READY mode, thus cancelling any DRAIN or MAINT state
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09008491
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01008492 - The word "drain". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
8493 DRAIN mode, thus it will not accept any new connections other than those
8494 that are accepted via persistence.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09008495
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01008496 - The word "maint". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
8497 MAINT mode, thus it will not accept any new connections at all, and health
8498 checks will be stopped.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09008499
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01008500 - The words "down", "failed", or "stopped", optionally followed by a
8501 description string after a sharp ('#'). All of these mark the server's
8502 operating state as DOWN, but since the word itself is reported on the stats
8503 page, the difference allows an administrator to know if the situation was
8504 expected or not : the service may intentionally be stopped, may appear up
8505 but fail some validity tests, or may be seen as down (eg: missing process,
8506 or port not responding).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09008507
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01008508 - The word "up" sets back the server's operating state as UP if health checks
8509 also report that the service is accessible.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09008510
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01008511 Parameters which are not advertised by the agent are not changed. For
8512 example, an agent might be designed to monitor CPU usage and only report a
8513 relative weight and never interact with the operating status. Similarly, an
8514 agent could be designed as an end-user interface with 3 radio buttons
8515 allowing an administrator to change only the administrative state. However,
8516 it is important to consider that only the agent may revert its own actions,
8517 so if a server is set to DRAIN mode or to DOWN state using the agent, the
8518 agent must implement the other equivalent actions to bring the service into
8519 operations again.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09008520
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +09008521 Failure to connect to the agent is not considered an error as connectivity
8522 is tested by the regular health check which is enabled by the "check"
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01008523 parameter. Warning though, it is not a good idea to stop an agent after it
8524 reports "down", since only an agent reporting "up" will be able to turn the
8525 server up again. Note that the CLI on the Unix stats socket is also able to
8526 force an agent's result in order to workaround a bogus agent if needed.
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +09008527
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +01008528 Requires the "agent-port" parameter to be set. See also the "agent-inter"
8529 parameter.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09008530
8531 Supported in default-server: No
8532
8533agent-inter <delay>
8534 The "agent-inter" parameter sets the interval between two agent checks
8535 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
8536
8537 Just as with every other time-based parameter, it may be entered in any
8538 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "agent-inter"
8539 parameter also serves as a timeout for agent checks "timeout check" is
8540 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
8541 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
8542 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
8543 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
8544 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
8545 of backends use the same servers.
8546
8547 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-port" parameters.
8548
8549 Supported in default-server: Yes
8550
8551agent-port <port>
8552 The "agent-port" parameter sets the TCP port used for agent checks.
8553
8554 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-inter" parameters.
8555
8556 Supported in default-server: Yes
8557
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008558backup
8559 When "backup" is present on a server line, the server is only used in load
8560 balancing when all other non-backup servers are unavailable. Requests coming
8561 with a persistence cookie referencing the server will always be served
8562 though. By default, only the first operational backup server is used, unless
8563 the "allbackups" option is set in the backend. See also the "allbackups"
8564 option.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008565
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008566 Supported in default-server: No
8567
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +02008568ca-file <cafile>
8569 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
8570 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
8571 server's certificate.
8572
8573 Supported in default-server: No
8574
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008575check
8576 This option enables health checks on the server. By default, a server is
Patrick Mézardb7aeec62012-01-22 16:01:22 +01008577 always considered available. If "check" is set, the server is available when
8578 accepting periodic TCP connections, to ensure that it is really able to serve
8579 requests. The default address and port to send the tests to are those of the
8580 server, and the default source is the same as the one defined in the
8581 backend. It is possible to change the address using the "addr" parameter, the
8582 port using the "port" parameter, the source address using the "source"
8583 address, and the interval and timers using the "inter", "rise" and "fall"
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +09008584 parameters. The request method is define in the backend using the "httpchk",
8585 "smtpchk", "mysql-check", "pgsql-check" and "ssl-hello-chk" options. Please
8586 refer to those options and parameters for more information.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008587
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008588 Supported in default-server: No
8589
Willy Tarreau6c16adc2012-10-05 00:04:16 +02008590check-send-proxy
8591 This option forces emission of a PROXY protocol line with outgoing health
8592 checks, regardless of whether the server uses send-proxy or not for the
8593 normal traffic. By default, the PROXY protocol is enabled for health checks
8594 if it is already enabled for normal traffic and if no "port" nor "addr"
8595 directive is present. However, if such a directive is present, the
8596 "check-send-proxy" option needs to be used to force the use of the
8597 protocol. See also the "send-proxy" option for more information.
8598
8599 Supported in default-server: No
8600
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02008601check-ssl
8602 This option forces encryption of all health checks over SSL, regardless of
8603 whether the server uses SSL or not for the normal traffic. This is generally
8604 used when an explicit "port" or "addr" directive is specified and SSL health
8605 checks are not inherited. It is important to understand that this option
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008606 inserts an SSL transport layer below the checks, so that a simple TCP connect
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02008607 check becomes an SSL connect, which replaces the old ssl-hello-chk. The most
8608 common use is to send HTTPS checks by combining "httpchk" with SSL checks.
8609 All SSL settings are common to health checks and traffic (eg: ciphers).
8610 See the "ssl" option for more information.
8611
8612 Supported in default-server: No
8613
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02008614ciphers <ciphers>
8615 This option sets the string describing the list of cipher algorithms that is
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008616 is negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with the server. The format of the
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02008617 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers". When SSL is used to communicate with
8618 servers on the local network, it is common to see a weaker set of algorithms
8619 than what is used over the internet. Doing so reduces CPU usage on both the
8620 server and haproxy while still keeping it compatible with deployed software.
8621 Some algorithms such as RC4-SHA1 are reasonably cheap. If no security at all
8622 is needed and just connectivity, using DES can be appropriate.
8623
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02008624 Supported in default-server: No
8625
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008626cookie <value>
8627 The "cookie" parameter sets the cookie value assigned to the server to
8628 <value>. This value will be checked in incoming requests, and the first
8629 operational server possessing the same value will be selected. In return, in
8630 cookie insertion or rewrite modes, this value will be assigned to the cookie
8631 sent to the client. There is nothing wrong in having several servers sharing
8632 the same cookie value, and it is in fact somewhat common between normal and
8633 backup servers. See also the "cookie" keyword in backend section.
8634
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008635 Supported in default-server: No
8636
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +02008637crl-file <crlfile>
8638 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
8639 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
8640 to verify server's certificate.
8641
8642 Supported in default-server: No
8643
Emeric Bruna7aa3092012-10-26 12:58:00 +02008644crt <cert>
8645 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
8646 It designates a PEM file from which to load both a certificate and the
8647 associated private key. This file can be built by concatenating both PEM
8648 files into one. This certificate will be sent if the server send a client
8649 certificate request.
8650
8651 Supported in default-server: No
8652
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +02008653disabled
8654 The "disabled" keyword starts the server in the "disabled" state. That means
8655 that it is marked down in maintenance mode, and no connection other than the
8656 ones allowed by persist mode will reach it. It is very well suited to setup
8657 new servers, because normal traffic will never reach them, while it is still
8658 possible to test the service by making use of the force-persist mechanism.
8659
8660 Supported in default-server: No
8661
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008662error-limit <count>
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01008663 If health observing is enabled, the "error-limit" parameter specifies the
8664 number of consecutive errors that triggers event selected by the "on-error"
8665 option. By default it is set to 10 consecutive errors.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01008666
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008667 Supported in default-server: Yes
8668
8669 See also the "check", "error-limit" and "on-error".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01008670
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008671fall <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008672 The "fall" parameter states that a server will be considered as dead after
8673 <count> consecutive unsuccessful health checks. This value defaults to 3 if
8674 unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "rise" parameters.
8675
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008676 Supported in default-server: Yes
8677
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02008678force-sslv3
8679 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
8680 the server. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts for
8681 high connection rates. See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
8682
8683 Supported in default-server: No
8684
8685force-tlsv10
8686 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only when SSL is used to communicate with
8687 the server. See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
8688
8689 Supported in default-server: No
8690
8691force-tlsv11
8692 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only when SSL is used to communicate with
8693 the server. See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
8694
8695 Supported in default-server: No
8696
8697force-tlsv12
8698 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only when SSL is used to communicate with
8699 the server. See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
8700
8701 Supported in default-server: No
8702
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008703id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02008704 Set a persistent ID for the server. This ID must be positive and unique for
8705 the proxy. An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first
8706 assigned value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008707
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008708 Supported in default-server: No
8709
8710inter <delay>
8711fastinter <delay>
8712downinter <delay>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008713 The "inter" parameter sets the interval between two consecutive health checks
8714 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
8715 It is also possible to use "fastinter" and "downinter" to optimize delays
8716 between checks depending on the server state :
8717
8718 Server state | Interval used
8719 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
8720 UP 100% (non-transitional) | "inter"
8721 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
8722 Transitionally UP (going down), |
8723 Transitionally DOWN (going up), | "fastinter" if set, "inter" otherwise.
8724 or yet unchecked. |
8725 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
8726 DOWN 100% (non-transitional) | "downinter" if set, "inter" otherwise.
8727 ---------------------------------+-----------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008728
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008729 Just as with every other time-based parameter, they can be entered in any
8730 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "inter" parameter also
8731 serves as a timeout for health checks sent to servers if "timeout check" is
8732 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09008733 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
8734 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
8735 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
8736 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
8737 of backends use the same servers.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008738
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008739 Supported in default-server: Yes
8740
8741maxconn <maxconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008742 The "maxconn" parameter specifies the maximal number of concurrent
8743 connections that will be sent to this server. If the number of incoming
8744 concurrent requests goes higher than this value, they will be queued, waiting
8745 for a connection to be released. This parameter is very important as it can
8746 save fragile servers from going down under extreme loads. If a "minconn"
8747 parameter is specified, the limit becomes dynamic. The default value is "0"
8748 which means unlimited. See also the "minconn" and "maxqueue" parameters, and
8749 the backend's "fullconn" keyword.
8750
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008751 Supported in default-server: Yes
8752
8753maxqueue <maxqueue>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008754 The "maxqueue" parameter specifies the maximal number of connections which
8755 will wait in the queue for this server. If this limit is reached, next
8756 requests will be redispatched to other servers instead of indefinitely
8757 waiting to be served. This will break persistence but may allow people to
8758 quickly re-log in when the server they try to connect to is dying. The
8759 default value is "0" which means the queue is unlimited. See also the
8760 "maxconn" and "minconn" parameters.
8761
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008762 Supported in default-server: Yes
8763
8764minconn <minconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008765 When the "minconn" parameter is set, the maxconn limit becomes a dynamic
8766 limit following the backend's load. The server will always accept at least
8767 <minconn> connections, never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on
8768 the ramp between both values when the backend has less than <fullconn>
8769 concurrent connections. This makes it possible to limit the load on the
8770 server during normal loads, but push it further for important loads without
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008771 overloading the server during exceptional loads. See also the "maxconn"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008772 and "maxqueue" parameters, as well as the "fullconn" backend keyword.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01008773
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008774 Supported in default-server: Yes
8775
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02008776no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02008777 This option disables support for SSLv3 when SSL is used to communicate with
8778 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02008779 using any configuration option. See also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02008780
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02008781 Supported in default-server: No
8782
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +02008783no-tls-tickets
8784 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
8785 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
8786 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
8787 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage for servers.
8788
8789 Supported in default-server: No
8790
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02008791no-tlsv10
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02008792 This option disables support for TLSv1.0 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02008793 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
8794 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02008795 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. See
8796 also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02008797
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02008798 Supported in default-server: No
8799
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02008800no-tlsv11
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02008801 This option disables support for TLSv1.1 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02008802 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
8803 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02008804 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. See
8805 also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +02008806
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02008807 Supported in default-server: No
8808
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +02008809no-tlsv12
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02008810 This option disables support for TLSv1.2 when SSL is used to communicate with
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02008811 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
8812 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +02008813 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. See
8814 also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02008815
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02008816 Supported in default-server: No
8817
Simon Hormanfa461682011-06-25 09:39:49 +09008818non-stick
8819 Never add connections allocated to this sever to a stick-table.
8820 This may be used in conjunction with backup to ensure that
8821 stick-table persistence is disabled for backup servers.
8822
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02008823 Supported in default-server: No
8824
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01008825observe <mode>
8826 This option enables health adjusting based on observing communication with
8827 the server. By default this functionality is disabled and enabling it also
8828 requires to enable health checks. There are two supported modes: "layer4" and
8829 "layer7". In layer4 mode, only successful/unsuccessful tcp connections are
8830 significant. In layer7, which is only allowed for http proxies, responses
8831 received from server are verified, like valid/wrong http code, unparsable
Willy Tarreau150d1462012-03-10 08:19:02 +01008832 headers, a timeout, etc. Valid status codes include 100 to 499, 501 and 505.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01008833
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008834 Supported in default-server: No
8835
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01008836 See also the "check", "on-error" and "error-limit".
8837
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008838on-error <mode>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01008839 Select what should happen when enough consecutive errors are detected.
8840 Currently, four modes are available:
8841 - fastinter: force fastinter
8842 - fail-check: simulate a failed check, also forces fastinter (default)
8843 - sudden-death: simulate a pre-fatal failed health check, one more failed
8844 check will mark a server down, forces fastinter
8845 - mark-down: mark the server immediately down and force fastinter
8846
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008847 Supported in default-server: Yes
8848
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +01008849 See also the "check", "observe" and "error-limit".
8850
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +09008851on-marked-down <action>
8852 Modify what occurs when a server is marked down.
8853 Currently one action is available:
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -07008854 - shutdown-sessions: Shutdown peer sessions. When this setting is enabled,
8855 all connections to the server are immediately terminated when the server
8856 goes down. It might be used if the health check detects more complex cases
8857 than a simple connection status, and long timeouts would cause the service
8858 to remain unresponsive for too long a time. For instance, a health check
8859 might detect that a database is stuck and that there's no chance to reuse
8860 existing connections anymore. Connections killed this way are logged with
8861 a 'D' termination code (for "Down").
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +09008862
8863 Actions are disabled by default
8864
8865 Supported in default-server: Yes
8866
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -07008867on-marked-up <action>
8868 Modify what occurs when a server is marked up.
8869 Currently one action is available:
8870 - shutdown-backup-sessions: Shutdown sessions on all backup servers. This is
8871 done only if the server is not in backup state and if it is not disabled
8872 (it must have an effective weight > 0). This can be used sometimes to force
8873 an active server to take all the traffic back after recovery when dealing
8874 with long sessions (eg: LDAP, SQL, ...). Doing this can cause more trouble
8875 than it tries to solve (eg: incomplete transactions), so use this feature
8876 with extreme care. Sessions killed because a server comes up are logged
8877 with an 'U' termination code (for "Up").
8878
8879 Actions are disabled by default
8880
8881 Supported in default-server: Yes
8882
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008883port <port>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008884 Using the "port" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different port to
8885 send health-checks. On some servers, it may be desirable to dedicate a port
8886 to a specific component able to perform complex tests which are more suitable
8887 to health-checks than the application. It is common to run a simple script in
8888 inetd for instance. This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not
8889 set. See also the "addr" parameter.
8890
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008891 Supported in default-server: Yes
8892
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008893redir <prefix>
8894 The "redir" parameter enables the redirection mode for all GET and HEAD
8895 requests addressing this server. This means that instead of having HAProxy
8896 forward the request to the server, it will send an "HTTP 302" response with
8897 the "Location" header composed of this prefix immediately followed by the
8898 requested URI beginning at the leading '/' of the path component. That means
8899 that no trailing slash should be used after <prefix>. All invalid requests
8900 will be rejected, and all non-GET or HEAD requests will be normally served by
8901 the server. Note that since the response is completely forged, no header
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008902 mangling nor cookie insertion is possible in the response. However, cookies in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008903 requests are still analysed, making this solution completely usable to direct
8904 users to a remote location in case of local disaster. Main use consists in
8905 increasing bandwidth for static servers by having the clients directly
8906 connect to them. Note: never use a relative location here, it would cause a
8907 loop between the client and HAProxy!
8908
8909 Example : server srv1 192.168.1.1:80 redir http://image1.mydomain.com check
8910
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008911 Supported in default-server: No
8912
8913rise <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008914 The "rise" parameter states that a server will be considered as operational
8915 after <count> consecutive successful health checks. This value defaults to 2
8916 if unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "fall" parameters.
8917
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008918 Supported in default-server: Yes
8919
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +01008920send-proxy
8921 The "send-proxy" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol over any
8922 connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs the other
8923 end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so that it can
8924 know the client's address or the public address it accessed to, whatever the
8925 upper layer protocol. For connections accepted by an "accept-proxy" listener,
8926 the advertised address will be used. Only TCPv4 and TCPv6 address families
8927 are supported. Other families such as Unix sockets, will report an UNKNOWN
8928 family. Servers using this option can fully be chained to another instance of
8929 haproxy listening with an "accept-proxy" setting. This setting must not be
Willy Tarreau6c16adc2012-10-05 00:04:16 +02008930 used if the server isn't aware of the protocol. When health checks are sent
8931 to the server, the PROXY protocol is automatically used when this option is
8932 set, unless there is an explicit "port" or "addr" directive, in which case an
8933 explicit "check-send-proxy" directive would also be needed to use the PROXY
8934 protocol. See also the "accept-proxy" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +01008935
8936 Supported in default-server: No
8937
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -04008938send-proxy-v2
8939 The "send-proxy-v2" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version 2
8940 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
8941 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
8942 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
8943 whatever the upper layer protocol. This setting must not be used if the
8944 server isn't aware of this version of the protocol. See also the "send-proxy"
8945 option of the "bind" keyword.
8946
8947 Supported in default-server: No
8948
8949send-proxy-v2-ssl
8950 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
8951 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
8952 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
8953 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
8954 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
8955 of the PROXY protocol is added to the PROXY protocol header. This setting
8956 must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the protocol.
8957 See also the "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
8958
8959 Supported in default-server: No
8960
8961send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
8962 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
8963 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
8964 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
8965 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
8966 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
8967 of the PROXY protocol, along along with the Common Name from the subject of
8968 the client certificate (if any), is added to the PROXY protocol header. This
8969 setting must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the
8970 protocol. See also the "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
8971
8972 Supported in default-server: No
8973
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008974slowstart <start_time_in_ms>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008975 The "slowstart" parameter for a server accepts a value in milliseconds which
8976 indicates after how long a server which has just come back up will run at
8977 full speed. Just as with every other time-based parameter, it can be entered
8978 in any other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The speed grows
8979 linearly from 0 to 100% during this time. The limitation applies to two
8980 parameters :
8981
8982 - maxconn: the number of connections accepted by the server will grow from 1
8983 to 100% of the usual dynamic limit defined by (minconn,maxconn,fullconn).
8984
8985 - weight: when the backend uses a dynamic weighted algorithm, the weight
8986 grows linearly from 1 to 100%. In this case, the weight is updated at every
8987 health-check. For this reason, it is important that the "inter" parameter
8988 is smaller than the "slowstart", in order to maximize the number of steps.
8989
8990 The slowstart never applies when haproxy starts, otherwise it would cause
8991 trouble to running servers. It only applies when a server has been previously
8992 seen as failed.
8993
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01008994 Supported in default-server: Yes
8995
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02008996source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02008997source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02008998source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [interface <name>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008999 The "source" parameter sets the source address which will be used when
9000 connecting to the server. It follows the exact same parameters and principle
9001 as the backend "source" keyword, except that it only applies to the server
9002 referencing it. Please consult the "source" keyword for details.
9003
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02009004 Additionally, the "source" statement on a server line allows one to specify a
9005 source port range by indicating the lower and higher bounds delimited by a
9006 dash ('-'). Some operating systems might require a valid IP address when a
9007 source port range is specified. It is permitted to have the same IP/range for
9008 several servers. Doing so makes it possible to bypass the maximum of 64k
9009 total concurrent connections. The limit will then reach 64k connections per
9010 server.
9011
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009012 Supported in default-server: No
9013
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02009014ssl
Willy Tarreau44f65392013-06-25 07:56:20 +02009015 This option enables SSL ciphering on outgoing connections to the server. It
9016 is critical to verify server certificates using "verify" when using SSL to
9017 connect to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man in
9018 the-middle attacks rendering SSL useless. When this option is used, health
9019 checks are automatically sent in SSL too unless there is a "port" or an
9020 "addr" directive indicating the check should be sent to a different location.
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009021 See the "check-ssl" option to force SSL health checks.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02009022
9023 Supported in default-server: No
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02009024
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009025track [<proxy>/]<server>
Willy Tarreau32091232014-05-16 13:52:00 +02009026 This option enables ability to set the current state of the server by tracking
9027 another one. It is possible to track a server which itself tracks another
9028 server, provided that at the end of the chain, a server has health checks
9029 enabled. If <proxy> is omitted the current one is used. If disable-on-404 is
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009030 used, it has to be enabled on both proxies.
9031
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009032 Supported in default-server: No
9033
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +02009034verify [none|required]
9035 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +01009036 to 'none', server certificate is not verified. In the other case, The
9037 certificate provided by the server is verified using CAs from 'ca-file'
9038 and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. If 'ssl_server_verify' is not specified
9039 in global section, this is the default. On verify failure the handshake
Willy Tarreau44f65392013-06-25 07:56:20 +02009040 is aborted. It is critically important to verify server certificates when
9041 using SSL to connect to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to
9042 trivial man-in-the-middle attacks rendering SSL totally useless.
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +02009043
9044 Supported in default-server: No
9045
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -07009046verifyhost <hostname>
9047 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in, and
9048 only takes effect if 'verify required' is also specified. When set, the
9049 hostnames in the subject and subjectAlternateNames of the certificate
9050 provided by the server are checked. If none of the hostnames in the
9051 certificate match the specified hostname, the handshake is aborted. The
9052 hostnames in the server-provided certificate may include wildcards.
9053
9054 Supported in default-server: No
9055
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009056weight <weight>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009057 The "weight" parameter is used to adjust the server's weight relative to
9058 other servers. All servers will receive a load proportional to their weight
9059 relative to the sum of all weights, so the higher the weight, the higher the
Willy Tarreau6704d672009-06-15 10:56:05 +02009060 load. The default weight is 1, and the maximal value is 256. A value of 0
9061 means the server will not participate in load-balancing but will still accept
9062 persistent connections. If this parameter is used to distribute the load
9063 according to server's capacity, it is recommended to start with values which
9064 can both grow and shrink, for instance between 10 and 100 to leave enough
9065 room above and below for later adjustments.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009066
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +01009067 Supported in default-server: Yes
9068
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009069
90706. HTTP header manipulation
9071---------------------------
9072
9073In HTTP mode, it is possible to rewrite, add or delete some of the request and
9074response headers based on regular expressions. It is also possible to block a
9075request or a response if a particular header matches a regular expression,
9076which is enough to stop most elementary protocol attacks, and to protect
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01009077against information leak from the internal network.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009078
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01009079If HAProxy encounters an "Informational Response" (status code 1xx), it is able
9080to process all rsp* rules which can allow, deny, rewrite or delete a header,
9081but it will refuse to add a header to any such messages as this is not
9082HTTP-compliant. The reason for still processing headers in such responses is to
9083stop and/or fix any possible information leak which may happen, for instance
9084because another downstream equipment would unconditionally add a header, or if
9085a server name appears there. When such messages are seen, normal processing
9086still occurs on the next non-informational messages.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +02009087
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009088This section covers common usage of the following keywords, described in detail
9089in section 4.2 :
9090
9091 - reqadd <string>
9092 - reqallow <search>
9093 - reqiallow <search>
9094 - reqdel <search>
9095 - reqidel <search>
9096 - reqdeny <search>
9097 - reqideny <search>
9098 - reqpass <search>
9099 - reqipass <search>
9100 - reqrep <search> <replace>
9101 - reqirep <search> <replace>
9102 - reqtarpit <search>
9103 - reqitarpit <search>
9104 - rspadd <string>
9105 - rspdel <search>
9106 - rspidel <search>
9107 - rspdeny <search>
9108 - rspideny <search>
9109 - rsprep <search> <replace>
9110 - rspirep <search> <replace>
9111
9112With all these keywords, the same conventions are used. The <search> parameter
9113is a POSIX extended regular expression (regex) which supports grouping through
9114parenthesis (without the backslash). Spaces and other delimiters must be
9115prefixed with a backslash ('\') to avoid confusion with a field delimiter.
9116Other characters may be prefixed with a backslash to change their meaning :
9117
9118 \t for a tab
9119 \r for a carriage return (CR)
9120 \n for a new line (LF)
9121 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
9122 \# to mark a sharp and differentiate it from a comment
9123 \\ to use a backslash in a regex
9124 \\\\ to use a backslash in the text (*2 for regex, *2 for haproxy)
9125 \xXX to write the ASCII hex code XX as in the C language
9126
9127The <replace> parameter contains the string to be used to replace the largest
9128portion of text matching the regex. It can make use of the special characters
9129above, and can reference a substring which is delimited by parenthesis in the
9130regex, by writing a backslash ('\') immediately followed by one digit from 0 to
91319 indicating the group position (0 designating the entire line). This practice
9132is very common to users of the "sed" program.
9133
9134The <string> parameter represents the string which will systematically be added
9135after the last header line. It can also use special character sequences above.
9136
9137Notes related to these keywords :
9138---------------------------------
9139 - these keywords are not always convenient to allow/deny based on header
9140 contents. It is strongly recommended to use ACLs with the "block" keyword
9141 instead, resulting in far more flexible and manageable rules.
9142
9143 - lines are always considered as a whole. It is not possible to reference
9144 a header name only or a value only. This is important because of the way
9145 headers are written (notably the number of spaces after the colon).
9146
9147 - the first line is always considered as a header, which makes it possible to
9148 rewrite or filter HTTP requests URIs or response codes, but in turn makes
9149 it harder to distinguish between headers and request line. The regex prefix
9150 ^[^\ \t]*[\ \t] matches any HTTP method followed by a space, and the prefix
9151 ^[^ \t:]*: matches any header name followed by a colon.
9152
9153 - for performances reasons, the number of characters added to a request or to
9154 a response is limited at build time to values between 1 and 4 kB. This
9155 should normally be far more than enough for most usages. If it is too short
9156 on occasional usages, it is possible to gain some space by removing some
9157 useless headers before adding new ones.
9158
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009159 - keywords beginning with "reqi" and "rspi" are the same as their counterpart
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009160 without the 'i' letter except that they ignore case when matching patterns.
9161
9162 - when a request passes through a frontend then a backend, all req* rules
9163 from the frontend will be evaluated, then all req* rules from the backend
9164 will be evaluated. The reverse path is applied to responses.
9165
9166 - req* statements are applied after "block" statements, so that "block" is
9167 always the first one, but before "use_backend" in order to permit rewriting
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009168 before switching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009169
9170
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020091717. Using ACLs and fetching samples
9172----------------------------------
9173
9174Haproxy is capable of extracting data from request or response streams, from
9175client or server information, from tables, environmental information etc...
9176The action of extracting such data is called fetching a sample. Once retrieved,
9177these samples may be used for various purposes such as a key to a stick-table,
9178but most common usages consist in matching them against predefined constant
9179data called patterns.
9180
9181
91827.1. ACL basics
9183---------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009184
9185The use of Access Control Lists (ACL) provides a flexible solution to perform
9186content switching and generally to take decisions based on content extracted
9187from the request, the response or any environmental status. The principle is
9188simple :
9189
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009190 - extract a data sample from a stream, table or the environment
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +01009191 - optionally apply some format conversion to the extracted sample
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009192 - apply one or multiple pattern matching methods on this sample
9193 - perform actions only when a pattern matches the sample
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009194
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009195The actions generally consist in blocking a request, selecting a backend, or
9196adding a header.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009197
9198In order to define a test, the "acl" keyword is used. The syntax is :
9199
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009200 acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] [<value>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009201
9202This creates a new ACL <aclname> or completes an existing one with new tests.
9203Those tests apply to the portion of request/response specified in <criterion>
9204and may be adjusted with optional flags [flags]. Some criteria also support
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +01009205an operator which may be specified before the set of values. Optionally some
9206conversion operators may be applied to the sample, and they will be specified
9207as a comma-delimited list of keywords just after the first keyword. The values
9208are of the type supported by the criterion, and are separated by spaces.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009209
9210ACL names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits, '-' (dash),
9211'_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are case-sensitive,
9212which means that "my_acl" and "My_Acl" are two different ACLs.
9213
9214There is no enforced limit to the number of ACLs. The unused ones do not affect
9215performance, they just consume a small amount of memory.
9216
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009217The criterion generally is the name of a sample fetch method, or one of its ACL
9218specific declinations. The default test method is implied by the output type of
9219this sample fetch method. The ACL declinations can describe alternate matching
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +01009220methods of a same sample fetch method. The sample fetch methods are the only
9221ones supporting a conversion.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009222
9223Sample fetch methods return data which can be of the following types :
9224 - boolean
9225 - integer (signed or unsigned)
9226 - IPv4 or IPv6 address
9227 - string
9228 - data block
9229
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +01009230Converters transform any of these data into any of these. For example, some
9231converters might convert a string to a lower-case string while other ones
9232would turn a string to an IPv4 address, or apply a netmask to an IP address.
9233The resulting sample is of the type of the last converter applied to the list,
9234which defaults to the type of the sample fetch method.
9235
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +02009236Each sample or converter returns data of a specific type, specified with its
9237keyword in this documentation. When an ACL is declared using a standard sample
9238fetch method, certain types automatically involved a default matching method
9239which are summarized in the table below :
9240
9241 +---------------------+-----------------+
9242 | Sample or converter | Default |
9243 | output type | matching method |
9244 +---------------------+-----------------+
9245 | boolean | bool |
9246 +---------------------+-----------------+
9247 | integer | int |
9248 +---------------------+-----------------+
9249 | ip | ip |
9250 +---------------------+-----------------+
9251 | string | str |
9252 +---------------------+-----------------+
9253 | binary | none, use "-m" |
9254 +---------------------+-----------------+
9255
9256Note that in order to match a binary samples, it is mandatory to specify a
9257matching method, see below.
9258
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009259The ACL engine can match these types against patterns of the following types :
9260 - boolean
9261 - integer or integer range
9262 - IP address / network
9263 - string (exact, substring, suffix, prefix, subdir, domain)
9264 - regular expression
9265 - hex block
9266
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009267The following ACL flags are currently supported :
9268
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +02009269 -i : ignore case during matching of all subsequent patterns.
9270 -f : load patterns from a file.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009271 -m : use a specific pattern matching method
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +01009272 -n : forbid the DNS resolutions
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +01009273 -M : load the file pointed by -f like a map file.
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +01009274 -u : force the unique id of the ACL
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009275 -- : force end of flags. Useful when a string looks like one of the flags.
9276
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009277The "-f" flag is followed by the name of a file from which all lines will be
9278read as individual values. It is even possible to pass multiple "-f" arguments
9279if the patterns are to be loaded from multiple files. Empty lines as well as
9280lines beginning with a sharp ('#') will be ignored. All leading spaces and tabs
9281will be stripped. If it is absolutely necessary to insert a valid pattern
9282beginning with a sharp, just prefix it with a space so that it is not taken for
9283a comment. Depending on the data type and match method, haproxy may load the
9284lines into a binary tree, allowing very fast lookups. This is true for IPv4 and
9285exact string matching. In this case, duplicates will automatically be removed.
9286
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +01009287The "-M" flag allows an ACL to use a map file. If this flag is set, the file is
9288parsed as two column file. The first column contains the patterns used by the
9289ACL, and the second column contain the samples. The sample can be used later by
9290a map. This can be useful in some rare cases where an ACL would just be used to
9291check for the existence of a pattern in a map before a mapping is applied.
9292
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +01009293The "-u" flag forces the unique id of the ACL. This unique id is used with the
9294socket interface to identify ACL and dynamically change its values. Note that a
9295file is always identified by its name even if an id is set.
9296
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009297Also, note that the "-i" flag applies to subsequent entries and not to entries
9298loaded from files preceding it. For instance :
9299
9300 acl valid-ua hdr(user-agent) -f exact-ua.lst -i -f generic-ua.lst test
9301
9302In this example, each line of "exact-ua.lst" will be exactly matched against
9303the "user-agent" header of the request. Then each line of "generic-ua" will be
9304case-insensitively matched. Then the word "test" will be insensitively matched
9305as well.
9306
9307The "-m" flag is used to select a specific pattern matching method on the input
9308sample. All ACL-specific criteria imply a pattern matching method and generally
9309do not need this flag. However, this flag is useful with generic sample fetch
9310methods to describe how they're going to be matched against the patterns. This
9311is required for sample fetches which return data type for which there is no
9312obvious matching method (eg: string or binary). When "-m" is specified and
9313followed by a pattern matching method name, this method is used instead of the
9314default one for the criterion. This makes it possible to match contents in ways
9315that were not initially planned, or with sample fetch methods which return a
9316string. The matching method also affects the way the patterns are parsed.
9317
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +01009318The "-n" flag forbids the dns resolutions. It is used with the load of ip files.
9319By default, if the parser cannot parse ip address it considers that the parsed
9320string is maybe a domain name and try dns resolution. The flag "-n" disable this
9321resolution. It is useful for detecting malformed ip lists. Note that if the DNS
9322server is not reachable, the haproxy configuration parsing may last many minutes
9323waiting fir the timeout. During this time no error messages are displayed. The
9324flag "-n" disable this behavior. Note also that during the runtime, this
9325function is disabled for the dynamic acl modifications.
9326
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009327There are some restrictions however. Not all methods can be used with all
9328sample fetch methods. Also, if "-m" is used in conjunction with "-f", it must
9329be placed first. The pattern matching method must be one of the following :
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009330
9331 - "found" : only check if the requested sample could be found in the stream,
9332 but do not compare it against any pattern. It is recommended not
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009333 to pass any pattern to avoid confusion. This matching method is
9334 particularly useful to detect presence of certain contents such
9335 as headers, cookies, etc... even if they are empty and without
9336 comparing them to anything nor counting them.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009337
9338 - "bool" : check the value as a boolean. It can only be applied to fetches
9339 which return a boolean or integer value, and takes no pattern.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009340 Value zero or false does not match, all other values do match.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009341
9342 - "int" : match the value as an integer. It can be used with integer and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009343 boolean samples. Boolean false is integer 0, true is integer 1.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009344
9345 - "ip" : match the value as an IPv4 or IPv6 address. It is compatible
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009346 with IP address samples only, so it is implied and never needed.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009347
9348 - "bin" : match the contents against an hexadecimal string representing a
9349 binary sequence. This may be used with binary or string samples.
9350
9351 - "len" : match the sample's length as an integer. This may be used with
9352 binary or string samples.
9353
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009354 - "str" : exact match : match the contents against a string. This may be
9355 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009356
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009357 - "sub" : substring match : check that the contents contain at least one of
9358 the provided string patterns. This may be used with binary or
9359 string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009360
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009361 - "reg" : regex match : match the contents against a list of regular
9362 expressions. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009363
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009364 - "beg" : prefix match : check that the contents begin like the provided
9365 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009366
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009367 - "end" : suffix match : check that the contents end like the provided
9368 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009369
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009370 - "dir" : subdir match : check that a slash-delimited portion of the
9371 contents exactly matches one of the provided string patterns.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009372 This may be used with binary or string samples.
9373
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009374 - "dom" : domain match : check that a dot-delimited portion of the contents
9375 exactly match one of the provided string patterns. This may be
9376 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +02009377
9378For example, to quickly detect the presence of cookie "JSESSIONID" in an HTTP
9379request, it is possible to do :
9380
9381 acl jsess_present cook(JSESSIONID) -m found
9382
9383In order to apply a regular expression on the 500 first bytes of data in the
9384buffer, one would use the following acl :
9385
9386 acl script_tag payload(0,500) -m reg -i <script>
9387
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +01009388On systems where the regex library is much slower when using "-i", it is
9389possible to convert the sample to lowercase before matching, like this :
9390
9391 acl script_tag payload(0,500),lower -m reg <script>
9392
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009393All ACL-specific criteria imply a default matching method. Most often, these
9394criteria are composed by concatenating the name of the original sample fetch
9395method and the matching method. For example, "hdr_beg" applies the "beg" match
9396to samples retrieved using the "hdr" fetch method. Since all ACL-specific
9397criteria rely on a sample fetch method, it is always possible instead to use
9398the original sample fetch method and the explicit matching method using "-m".
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +02009399
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009400If an alternate match is specified using "-m" on an ACL-specific criterion,
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009401the matching method is simply applied to the underlying sample fetch method.
9402For example, all ACLs below are exact equivalent :
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +02009403
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009404 acl short_form hdr_beg(host) www.
9405 acl alternate1 hdr_beg(host) -m beg www.
9406 acl alternate2 hdr_dom(host) -m beg www.
9407 acl alternate3 hdr(host) -m beg www.
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +02009408
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +02009409
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +02009410The table below summarizes the compatibility matrix between sample or converter
9411types and the pattern types to fetch against. It indicates for each compatible
9412combination the name of the matching method to be used, surrounded with angle
9413brackets ">" and "<" when the method is the default one and will work by
9414default without "-m".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009415
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009416 +-------------------------------------------------+
9417 | Input sample type |
9418 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +02009419 | pattern type | boolean | integer | ip | string | binary |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009420 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
9421 | none (presence only) | found | found | found | found | found |
9422 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +02009423 | none (boolean value) |> bool <| bool | | bool | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009424 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +02009425 | integer (value) | int |> int <| int | int | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009426 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +01009427 | integer (length) | len | len | len | len | len |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009428 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +02009429 | IP address | | |> ip <| ip | ip |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009430 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +02009431 | exact string | str | str | str |> str <| str |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009432 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +01009433 | prefix | beg | beg | beg | beg | beg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009434 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +01009435 | suffix | end | end | end | end | end |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009436 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +01009437 | substring | sub | sub | sub | sub | sub |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009438 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +01009439 | subdir | dir | dir | dir | dir | dir |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009440 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +01009441 | domain | dom | dom | dom | dom | dom |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009442 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +01009443 | regex | reg | reg | reg | reg | reg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009444 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
9445 | hex block | | | | bin | bin |
9446 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009447
9448
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020094497.1.1. Matching booleans
9450------------------------
9451
9452In order to match a boolean, no value is needed and all values are ignored.
9453Boolean matching is used by default for all fetch methods of type "boolean".
9454When boolean matching is used, the fetched value is returned as-is, which means
9455that a boolean "true" will always match and a boolean "false" will never match.
9456
9457Boolean matching may also be enforced using "-m bool" on fetch methods which
9458return an integer value. Then, integer value 0 is converted to the boolean
9459"false" and all other values are converted to "true".
9460
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009461
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020094627.1.2. Matching integers
9463------------------------
9464
9465Integer matching applies by default to integer fetch methods. It can also be
9466enforced on boolean fetches using "-m int". In this case, "false" is converted
9467to the integer 0, and "true" is converted to the integer 1.
9468
9469Integer matching also supports integer ranges and operators. Note that integer
9470matching only applies to positive values. A range is a value expressed with a
9471lower and an upper bound separated with a colon, both of which may be omitted.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009472
9473For instance, "1024:65535" is a valid range to represent a range of
9474unprivileged ports, and "1024:" would also work. "0:1023" is a valid
9475representation of privileged ports, and ":1023" would also work.
9476
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009477As a special case, some ACL functions support decimal numbers which are in fact
9478two integers separated by a dot. This is used with some version checks for
9479instance. All integer properties apply to those decimal numbers, including
9480ranges and operators.
9481
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009482For an easier usage, comparison operators are also supported. Note that using
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009483operators with ranges does not make much sense and is strongly discouraged.
9484Similarly, it does not make much sense to perform order comparisons with a set
9485of values.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009486
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009487Available operators for integer matching are :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009488
9489 eq : true if the tested value equals at least one value
9490 ge : true if the tested value is greater than or equal to at least one value
9491 gt : true if the tested value is greater than at least one value
9492 le : true if the tested value is less than or equal to at least one value
9493 lt : true if the tested value is less than at least one value
9494
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009495For instance, the following ACL matches any negative Content-Length header :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009496
9497 acl negative-length hdr_val(content-length) lt 0
9498
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009499This one matches SSL versions between 3.0 and 3.1 (inclusive) :
9500
9501 acl sslv3 req_ssl_ver 3:3.1
9502
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009503
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020095047.1.3. Matching strings
9505-----------------------
9506
9507String matching applies to string or binary fetch methods, and exists in 6
9508different forms :
9509
9510 - exact match (-m str) : the extracted string must exactly match the
9511 patterns ;
9512
9513 - substring match (-m sub) : the patterns are looked up inside the
9514 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them is found inside ;
9515
9516 - prefix match (-m beg) : the patterns are compared with the beginning of
9517 the extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
9518
9519 - suffix match (-m end) : the patterns are compared with the end of the
9520 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
9521
9522 - subdir match (-m sub) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
9523 string, delimited with slashes ("/"), and the ACL matches if any of them
9524 matches.
9525
9526 - domain match (-m dom) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
9527 string, delimited with dots ("."), and the ACL matches if any of them
9528 matches.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009529
9530String matching applies to verbatim strings as they are passed, with the
9531exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it possible to escape some
9532characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is passed before the first
9533string, then the matching will be performed ignoring the case. In order
9534to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass the "--" flag
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009535before the first string. Same applies of course to match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009536
9537
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020095387.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
9539---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009540
9541Just like with string matching, regex matching applies to verbatim strings as
9542they are passed, with the exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it
9543possible to escape some characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is
9544passed before the first regex, then the matching will be performed ignoring
9545the case. In order to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009546the "--" flag before the first string. Same principle applies of course to
9547match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009548
9549
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020095507.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
9551-------------------------------------
9552
9553It is possible to match some extracted samples against a binary block which may
9554not safely be represented as a string. For this, the patterns must be passed as
9555a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number, when the match method is set
9556to binary. Each sequence of two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal
9557digits may be used upper or lower case.
9558
9559Example :
9560 # match "Hello\n" in the input stream (\x48 \x65 \x6c \x6c \x6f \x0a)
9561 acl hello payload(0,6) -m bin 48656c6c6f0a
9562
9563
95647.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
9565---------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009566
9567IPv4 addresses values can be specified either as plain addresses or with a
9568netmask appended, in which case the IPv4 address matches whenever it is
9569within the network. Plain addresses may also be replaced with a resolvable
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01009570host name, but this practice is generally discouraged as it makes it more
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009571difficult to read and debug configurations. If hostnames are used, you should
9572at least ensure that they are present in /etc/hosts so that the configuration
9573does not depend on any random DNS match at the moment the configuration is
9574parsed.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009575
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +02009576IPv6 may be entered in their usual form, with or without a netmask appended.
9577Only bit counts are accepted for IPv6 netmasks. In order to avoid any risk of
9578trouble with randomly resolved IP addresses, host names are never allowed in
9579IPv6 patterns.
9580
9581HAProxy is also able to match IPv4 addresses with IPv6 addresses in the
9582following situations :
9583 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies
9584 in IPv4 using the supplied mask if any.
9585 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv6, the match applies
9586 in IPv6 using the supplied mask if any.
9587 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies in IPv4
9588 using the pattern's mask if the IPv6 address matches with 2002:IPV4::,
9589 ::IPV4 or ::ffff:IPV4, otherwise it fails.
9590 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv6, the IPv4 address is first
9591 converted to IPv6 by prefixing ::ffff: in front of it, then the match is
9592 applied in IPv6 using the supplied IPv6 mask.
9593
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009594
95957.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
9596----------------------------------
9597
9598Some actions are only performed upon a valid condition. A condition is a
9599combination of ACLs with operators. 3 operators are supported :
9600
9601 - AND (implicit)
9602 - OR (explicit with the "or" keyword or the "||" operator)
9603 - Negation with the exclamation mark ("!")
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009604
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009605A condition is formed as a disjunctive form:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009606
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009607 [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln { or [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln } ...
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +02009608
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009609Such conditions are generally used after an "if" or "unless" statement,
9610indicating when the condition will trigger the action.
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +02009611
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009612For instance, to block HTTP requests to the "*" URL with methods other than
9613"OPTIONS", as well as POST requests without content-length, and GET or HEAD
9614requests with a content-length greater than 0, and finally every request which
9615is not either GET/HEAD/POST/OPTIONS !
9616
9617 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
9618 block if HTTP_URL_STAR !METH_OPTIONS || METH_POST missing_cl
9619 block if METH_GET HTTP_CONTENT
9620 block unless METH_GET or METH_POST or METH_OPTIONS
9621
9622To select a different backend for requests to static contents on the "www" site
9623and to every request on the "img", "video", "download" and "ftp" hosts :
9624
9625 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
9626 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
9627 acl host_www hdr_beg(host) -i www
9628 acl host_static hdr_beg(host) -i img. video. download. ftp.
9629
9630 # now use backend "static" for all static-only hosts, and for static urls
9631 # of host "www". Use backend "www" for the rest.
9632 use_backend static if host_static or host_www url_static
9633 use_backend www if host_www
9634
9635It is also possible to form rules using "anonymous ACLs". Those are unnamed ACL
9636expressions that are built on the fly without needing to be declared. They must
9637be enclosed between braces, with a space before and after each brace (because
9638the braces must be seen as independent words). Example :
9639
9640 The following rule :
9641
9642 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
9643 block if METH_POST missing_cl
9644
9645 Can also be written that way :
9646
9647 block if METH_POST { hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0 }
9648
9649It is generally not recommended to use this construct because it's a lot easier
9650to leave errors in the configuration when written that way. However, for very
9651simple rules matching only one source IP address for instance, it can make more
9652sense to use them than to declare ACLs with random names. Another example of
9653good use is the following :
9654
9655 With named ACLs :
9656
9657 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
9658 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
9659 monitor fail if site_dead
9660
9661 With anonymous ACLs :
9662
9663 monitor fail if { nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2 } || { nbsrv(static) lt 2 }
9664
9665See section 4.2 for detailed help on the "block" and "use_backend" keywords.
9666
9667
96687.3. Fetching samples
9669---------------------
9670
9671Historically, sample fetch methods were only used to retrieve data to match
9672against patterns using ACLs. With the arrival of stick-tables, a new class of
9673sample fetch methods was created, most often sharing the same syntax as their
9674ACL counterpart. These sample fetch methods are also known as "fetches". As
9675of now, ACLs and fetches have converged. All ACL fetch methods have been made
9676available as fetch methods, and ACLs may use any sample fetch method as well.
9677
9678This section details all available sample fetch methods and their output type.
9679Some sample fetch methods have deprecated aliases that are used to maintain
9680compatibility with existing configurations. They are then explicitly marked as
9681deprecated and should not be used in new setups.
9682
9683The ACL derivatives are also indicated when available, with their respective
9684matching methods. These ones all have a well defined default pattern matching
9685method, so it is never necessary (though allowed) to pass the "-m" option to
9686indicate how the sample will be matched using ACLs.
9687
9688As indicated in the sample type versus matching compatibility matrix above,
9689when using a generic sample fetch method in an ACL, the "-m" option is
9690mandatory unless the sample type is one of boolean, integer, IPv4 or IPv6. When
9691the same keyword exists as an ACL keyword and as a standard fetch method, the
9692ACL engine will automatically pick the ACL-only one by default.
9693
9694Some of these keywords support one or multiple mandatory arguments, and one or
9695multiple optional arguments. These arguments are strongly typed and are checked
9696when the configuration is parsed so that there is no risk of running with an
9697incorrect argument (eg: an unresolved backend name). Fetch function arguments
9698are passed between parenthesis and are delimited by commas. When an argument
9699is optional, it will be indicated below between square brackets ('[ ]'). When
9700all arguments are optional, the parenthesis may be omitted.
9701
9702Thus, the syntax of a standard sample fetch method is one of the following :
9703 - name
9704 - name(arg1)
9705 - name(arg1,arg2)
9706
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +02009707
97087.3.1. Converters
9709-----------------
9710
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +01009711Sample fetch methods may be combined with transformations to be applied on top
9712of the fetched sample (also called "converters"). These combinations form what
9713is called "sample expressions" and the result is a "sample". Initially this
9714was only supported by "stick on" and "stick store-request" directives but this
9715has now be extended to all places where samples may be used (acls, log-format,
9716unique-id-format, add-header, ...).
9717
9718These transformations are enumerated as a series of specific keywords after the
9719sample fetch method. These keywords may equally be appended immediately after
9720the fetch keyword's argument, delimited by a comma. These keywords can also
9721support some arguments (eg: a netmask) which must be passed in parenthesis.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009722
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009723The currently available list of transformation keywords include :
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009724
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +02009725base64
9726 Converts a binary input sample to a base64 string. It is used to log or
9727 transfer binary content in a way that can be reliably transferred (eg:
9728 an SSL ID can be copied in a header).
9729
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +02009730lower
9731 Convert a string sample to lower case. This can only be placed after a string
9732 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
9733 type. The result is of type string.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009734
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +02009735upper
9736 Convert a string sample to upper case. This can only be placed after a string
9737 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
9738 type. The result is of type string.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009739
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +02009740hex
9741 Converts a binary input sample to an hex string containing two hex digits per
9742 input byte. It is used to log or transfer hex dumps of some binary input data
9743 in a way that can be reliably transferred (eg: an SSL ID can be copied in a
9744 header).
Thierry FOURNIER2f49d6d2014-03-12 15:01:52 +01009745
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +02009746ipmask(<mask>)
9747 Apply a mask to an IPv4 address, and use the result for lookups and storage.
9748 This can be used to make all hosts within a certain mask to share the same
9749 table entries and as such use the same server. The mask can be passed in
9750 dotted form (eg: 255.255.255.0) or in CIDR form (eg: 24).
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009751
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +02009752http_date([<offset>])
9753 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
9754 representing this date in a format suitable for use in HTTP header fields. If
9755 an offset value is specified, then it is a number of seconds that is added to
9756 the date before the conversion is operated. This is particularly useful to
9757 emit Date header fields, Expires values in responses when combined with a
9758 positive offset, or Last-Modified values when the offset is negative.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009759
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +02009760language(<value>[,<default>])
9761 Returns the value with the highest q-factor from a list as extracted from the
9762 "accept-language" header using "req.fhdr". Values with no q-factor have a
9763 q-factor of 1. Values with a q-factor of 0 are dropped. Only values which
9764 belong to the list of semi-colon delimited <values> will be considered. The
9765 argument <value> syntax is "lang[;lang[;lang[;...]]]". If no value matches the
9766 given list and a default value is provided, it is returned. Note that language
9767 names may have a variant after a dash ('-'). If this variant is present in the
9768 list, it will be matched, but if it is not, only the base language is checked.
9769 The match is case-sensitive, and the output string is always one of those
9770 provided in arguments. The ordering of arguments is meaningless, only the
9771 ordering of the values in the request counts, as the first value among
9772 multiple sharing the same q-factor is used.
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +02009773
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +02009774 Example :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +02009775
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +02009776 # this configuration switches to the backend matching a
9777 # given language based on the request :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +02009778
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +02009779 acl es req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str es
9780 acl fr req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str fr
9781 acl en req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str en
9782 use_backend spanish if es
9783 use_backend french if fr
9784 use_backend english if en
9785 default_backend choose_your_language
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +02009786
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +02009787map(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
9788map_<match_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
9789map_<match_type>_<output_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
9790 Search the input value from <map_file> using the <match_type> matching method,
9791 and return the associated value converted to the type <output_type>. If the
9792 input value cannot be found in the <map_file>, the converter returns the
9793 <default_value>. If the <default_value> is not set, the converter fails and
9794 acts as if no input value could be fetched. If the <match_type> is not set, it
9795 defaults to "str". Likewise, if the <output_type> is not set, it defaults to
9796 "str". For convenience, the "map" keyword is an alias for "map_str" and maps a
9797 string to another string.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +01009798
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +02009799 It is important to avoid overlapping between the keys : IP addresses and
9800 strings are stored in trees, so the first of the finest match will be used.
9801 Other keys are stored in lists, so the first matching occurrence will be used.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +01009802
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +02009803 The following array contains the list of all map functions avalaible sorted by
9804 input type, match type and output type.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +01009805
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +02009806 input type | match method | output type str | output type int | output type ip
9807 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
9808 str | str | map_str | map_str_int | map_str_ip
9809 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Willy Tarreau787a4c02014-05-10 07:55:30 +02009810 str | beg | map_beg | map_beg_int | map_end_ip
9811 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +02009812 str | sub | map_sub | map_sub_int | map_sub_ip
9813 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
9814 str | dir | map_dir | map_dir_int | map_dir_ip
9815 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
9816 str | dom | map_dom | map_dom_int | map_dom_ip
9817 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
9818 str | end | map_end | map_end_int | map_end_ip
9819 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
9820 str | reg | map_reg | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
9821 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
9822 int | int | map_int | map_int_int | map_int_ip
9823 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
9824 ip | ip | map_ip | map_ip_int | map_ip_ip
9825 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +01009826
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +02009827 The file contains one key + value per line. Lines which start with '#' are
9828 ignored, just like empty lines. Leading tabs and spaces are stripped. The key
9829 is then the first "word" (series of non-space/tabs characters), and the value
9830 is what follows this series of space/tab till the end of the line excluding
9831 trailing spaces/tabs.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +01009832
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +02009833 Example :
9834
9835 # this is a comment and is ignored
9836 2.22.246.0/23 United Kingdom \n
9837 <-><-----------><--><------------><---->
9838 | | | | `- trailing spaces ignored
9839 | | | `---------- value
9840 | | `-------------------- middle spaces ignored
9841 | `---------------------------- key
9842 `------------------------------------ leading spaces ignored
9843
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +01009844
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020098457.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009846--------------------------------------------
9847
9848A first set of sample fetch methods applies to internal information which does
9849not even relate to any client information. These ones are sometimes used with
9850"monitor-fail" directives to report an internal status to external watchers.
9851The sample fetch methods described in this section are usable anywhere.
9852
9853always_false : boolean
9854 Always returns the boolean "false" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
9855 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
9856
9857always_true : boolean
9858 Always returns the boolean "true" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
9859 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
9860
9861avg_queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009862 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009863 divided by the number of active servers. The current backend is used if no
9864 backend is specified. This is very similar to "queue" except that the size of
9865 the farm is considered, in order to give a more accurate measurement of the
9866 time it may take for a new connection to be processed. The main usage is with
9867 ACL to return a sorry page to new users when it becomes certain they will get
9868 a degraded service, or to pass to the backend servers in a header so that
9869 they decide to work in degraded mode or to disable some functions to speed up
9870 the processing a bit. Note that in the event there would not be any active
9871 server anymore, twice the number of queued connections would be considered as
9872 the measured value. This is a fair estimate, as we expect one server to get
9873 back soon anyway, but we still prefer to send new traffic to another backend
9874 if in better shape. See also the "queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate"
9875 sample fetches.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki346f76d2010-01-12 21:59:30 +01009876
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009877be_conn([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +02009878 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the backend,
9879 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no backend name is
9880 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
9881 backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the nominal one is full.
9882 See also the "fe_conn", "queue" and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02009883
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009884be_sess_rate([<backend>]) : integer
9885 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
9886 backend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
9887 switch to an alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too
9888 high a session rate, or to limit abuse of service (eg. prevent sucking of an
9889 online dictionary). It can also be useful to add this element to logs using a
9890 log-format directive.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009891
9892 Example :
9893 # Redirect to an error page if the dictionary is requested too often
9894 backend dynamic
9895 mode http
9896 acl being_scanned be_sess_rate gt 100
9897 redirect location /denied.html if being_scanned
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009898
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009899connslots([<backend>]) : integer
9900 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connection slots
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009901 still available in the backend, by totaling the maximum amount of
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009902 connections on all servers and the maximum queue size. This is probably only
9903 used with ACLs.
Tait Clarridge7896d522012-12-05 21:39:31 -05009904
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +08009905 The basic idea here is to be able to measure the number of connection "slots"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009906 still available (connection + queue), so that anything beyond that (intended
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +08009907 usage; see "use_backend" keyword) can be redirected to a different backend.
9908
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009909 'connslots' = number of available server connection slots, + number of
9910 available server queue slots.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +08009911
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +02009912 Note that while "fe_conn" may be used, "connslots" comes in especially
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009913 useful when you have a case of traffic going to one single ip, splitting into
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009914 multiple backends (perhaps using ACLs to do name-based load balancing) and
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009915 you want to be able to differentiate between different backends, and their
9916 available "connslots". Also, whereas "nbsrv" only measures servers that are
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009917 actually *down*, this fetch is more fine-grained and looks into the number of
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +02009918 available connection slots as well. See also "queue" and "avg_queue".
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +08009919
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009920 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: at this point in time, the code does not take care
9921 of dynamic connections. Also, if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0,
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009922 then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which case the value returned
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009923 will be -1.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +08009924
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +02009925date([<offset>]) : integer
9926 Returns the current date as the epoch (number of seconds since 01/01/1970).
9927 If an offset value is specified, then it is a number of seconds that is added
9928 to the current date before returning the value. This is particularly useful
9929 to compute relative dates, as both positive and negative offsets are allowed.
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +02009930 It is useful combined with the http_date converter.
9931
9932 Example :
9933
9934 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response
9935 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600),http_date]
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +02009936
Willy Tarreau595ec542013-06-12 21:34:28 +02009937env(<name>) : string
9938 Returns a string containing the value of environment variable <name>. As a
9939 reminder, environment variables are per-process and are sampled when the
9940 process starts. This can be useful to pass some information to a next hop
9941 server, or with ACLs to take specific action when the process is started a
9942 certain way.
9943
9944 Examples :
9945 # Pass the Via header to next hop with the local hostname in it
9946 http-request add-header Via 1.1\ %[env(HOSTNAME)]
9947
9948 # reject cookie-less requests when the STOP environment variable is set
9949 http-request deny if !{ cook(SESSIONID) -m found } { env(STOP) -m found }
9950
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009951fe_conn([<frontend>]) : integer
9952 Returns the number of currently established connections on the frontend,
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009953 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no frontend name is
9954 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009955 frontend. It can be used to return a sorry page before hard-blocking, or to
9956 use a specific backend to drain new requests when the farm is considered
9957 full. This is mostly used with ACLs but can also be used to pass some
9958 statistics to servers in HTTP headers. See also the "dst_conn", "be_conn",
9959 "fe_sess_rate" fetches.
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +02009960
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009961fe_sess_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
9962 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
9963 frontend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
9964 limit the incoming session rate to an acceptable range in order to prevent
9965 abuse of service at the earliest moment, for example when combined with other
9966 layer 4 ACLs in order to force the clients to wait a bit for the rate to go
9967 down below the limit. It can also be useful to add this element to logs using
9968 a log-format directive. See also the "rate-limit sessions" directive for use
9969 in frontends.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +01009970
9971 Example :
9972 # This frontend limits incoming mails to 10/s with a max of 100
9973 # concurrent connections. We accept any connection below 10/s, and
9974 # force excess clients to wait for 100 ms. Since clients are limited to
9975 # 100 max, there cannot be more than 10 incoming mails per second.
9976 frontend mail
9977 bind :25
9978 mode tcp
9979 maxconn 100
9980 acl too_fast fe_sess_rate ge 10
9981 tcp-request inspect-delay 100ms
9982 tcp-request content accept if ! too_fast
9983 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009984
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009985nbsrv([<backend>]) : integer
9986 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of usable servers of
9987 either the current backend or the named backend. This is mostly used with
9988 ACLs but can also be useful when added to logs. This is normally used to
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009989 switch to an alternate backend when the number of servers is too low to
9990 to handle some load. It is useful to report a failure when combined with
9991 "monitor fail".
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +01009992
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009993queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009994 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend,
9995 including all the connections in server queues. If no backend name is
9996 specified, the current one is used, but it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009997 one. This is useful with ACLs or to pass statistics to backend servers. This
9998 can be used to take actions when queuing goes above a known level, generally
9999 indicating a surge of traffic or a massive slowdown on the servers. One
10000 possible action could be to reject new users but still accept old ones. See
10001 also the "avg_queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate" fetches.
10002
Willy Tarreau84310e22014-02-14 11:59:04 +010010003rand([<range>]) : integer
10004 Returns a random integer value within a range of <range> possible values,
10005 starting at zero. If the range is not specified, it defaults to 2^32, which
10006 gives numbers between 0 and 4294967295. It can be useful to pass some values
10007 needed to take some routing decisions for example, or just for debugging
10008 purposes. This random must not be used for security purposes.
10009
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010010srv_conn([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
10011 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
10012 connections on the designated server, possibly including the connection being
10013 evaluated. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the
10014 current backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when one server is
10015 full, or to inform the server about our view of the number of active
10016 connections with it. See also the "fe_conn", "be_conn" and "queue" fetch
10017 methods.
10018
10019srv_is_up([<backend>/]<server>) : boolean
10020 Returns true when the designated server is UP, and false when it is either
10021 DOWN or in maintenance mode. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is
10022 looked up in the current backend. It is mainly used to take action based on
10023 an external status reported via a health check (eg: a geographical site's
10024 availability). Another possible use which is more of a hack consists in
10025 using dummy servers as boolean variables that can be enabled or disabled from
10026 the CLI, so that rules depending on those ACLs can be tweaked in realtime.
10027
10028srv_sess_rate([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
10029 Returns an integer corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
10030 designated server, in number of new sessions per second. If <backend> is
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010031 omitted, then the server is looked up in the current backend. This is mostly
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010032 used with ACLs but can make sense with logs too. This is used to switch to an
10033 alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too high a session
10034 rate, or to limit abuse of service (eg. prevent latent requests from
10035 overloading servers).
10036
10037 Example :
10038 # Redirect to a separate back
10039 acl srv1_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv1) gt 50
10040 acl srv2_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv2) gt 50
10041 use_backend be2 if srv1_full or srv2_full
10042
10043table_avl([<table>]) : integer
10044 Returns the total number of available entries in the current proxy's
10045 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also table_cnt.
10046
10047table_cnt([<table>]) : integer
10048 Returns the total number of entries currently in use in the current proxy's
10049 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also src_conn_cnt and
10050 table_avl for other entry counting methods.
10051
10052
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200100537.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010054----------------------------------
10055
10056The layer 4 usually describes just the transport layer which in haproxy is
10057closest to the connection, where no content is yet made available. The fetch
10058methods described here are usable as low as the "tcp-request connection" rule
10059sets unless they require some future information. Those generally include
10060TCP/IP addresses and ports, as well as elements from stick-tables related to
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010061the incoming connection. For retrieving a value from a sticky counters, the
10062counter number can be explicitly set as 0, 1, or 2 using the pre-defined
10063"sc0_", "sc1_", or "sc2_" prefix, or it can be specified as the first integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010064argument when using the "sc_" prefix. An optional table may be specified with
10065the "sc*" form, in which case the currently tracked key will be looked up into
10066this alternate table instead of the table currently being tracked.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010067
10068be_id : integer
10069 Returns an integer containing the current backend's id. It can be used in
10070 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request.
10071
10072dst : ip
10073 This is the destination IPv4 address of the connection on the client side,
10074 which is the address the client connected to. It can be useful when running
10075 in transparent mode. It is of type IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables.
10076 On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its IPv6 equivalent, according to
10077 RFC 4291.
10078
10079dst_conn : integer
10080 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
10081 connections on the same socket including the one being evaluated. It is
10082 normally used with ACLs but can as well be used to pass the information to
10083 servers in an HTTP header or in logs. It can be used to either return a sorry
10084 page before hard-blocking, or to use a specific backend to drain new requests
10085 when the socket is considered saturated. This offers the ability to assign
10086 different limits to different listening ports or addresses. See also the
10087 "fe_conn" and "be_conn" fetches.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010088
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010089dst_port : integer
10090 Returns an integer value corresponding to the destination TCP port of the
10091 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected to.
10092 This might be used when running in transparent mode, when assigning dynamic
10093 ports to some clients for a whole application session, to stick all users to
10094 a same server, or to pass the destination port information to a server using
10095 an HTTP header.
10096
10097fe_id : integer
10098 Returns an integer containing the current frontend's id. It can be used in
10099 backends to check from which backend it was called, or to stick all users
10100 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
10101
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010102sc_bytes_in_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010103sc0_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
10104sc1_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
10105sc2_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010106 Returns the average client-to-server bytes rate from the currently tracked
10107 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
10108 table. See also src_bytes_in_rate.
10109
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010110sc_bytes_out_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010111sc0_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
10112sc1_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
10113sc2_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010114 Returns the average server-to-client bytes rate from the currently tracked
10115 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
10116 table. See also src_bytes_out_rate.
10117
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010118sc_clr_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010119sc0_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
10120sc1_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
10121sc2_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020010122 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
10123 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010010124 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
10125 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
10126 when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020010127
10128 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
10129 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010130 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
10131 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 5
10132 acl save sc0_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020010133 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
10134 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
10135
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010136sc_conn_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010137sc0_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
10138sc1_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
10139sc2_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010140 Returns the cumulated number of incoming connections from currently tracked
10141 counters. See also src_conn_cnt.
10142
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010143sc_conn_cur(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010144sc0_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
10145sc1_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
10146sc2_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010147 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
10148 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
10149 begins and decremented when tracking stops. See also src_conn_cur.
10150
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010151sc_conn_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010152sc0_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
10153sc1_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
10154sc2_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010155 Returns the average connection rate from the currently tracked counters,
10156 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table.
10157 See also src_conn_rate.
10158
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010159sc_get_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010160sc0_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
10161sc1_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
10162sc2_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010163 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010164 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc0 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020010165
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010166sc_gpc0_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010167sc0_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
10168sc1_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
10169sc2_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020010170 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
10171 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
10172 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010173 src_gpc0_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
10174 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
10175 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010176
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010177sc_http_err_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010178sc0_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
10179sc1_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
10180sc2_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010181 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP errors from the currently tracked
10182 counters. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
10183 See also src_http_err_cnt.
10184
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010185sc_http_err_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010186sc0_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
10187sc1_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
10188sc2_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010189 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the currently tracked counters,
10190 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
10191 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. See also
10192 src_http_err_rate.
10193
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010194sc_http_req_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010195sc0_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
10196sc1_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
10197sc2_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010198 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
10199 counters. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
10200 src_http_req_cnt.
10201
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010202sc_http_req_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010203sc0_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
10204sc1_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
10205sc2_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010206 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
10207 counters, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in
10208 the table. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
10209 src_http_req_rate.
10210
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010211sc_inc_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010212sc0_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
10213sc1_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
10214sc2_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010215 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010010216 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
10217 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
10218 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
10219 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010220
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010221 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
10222 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010223 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
10224
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010225sc_kbytes_in(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010226sc0_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
10227sc1_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
10228sc2_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010229 Returns the amount of client-to-server data from the currently tracked
10230 counters, measured in kilobytes over the period configured in the table. The
10231 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
10232 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_in.
10233
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010234sc_kbytes_out(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010235sc0_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
10236sc1_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
10237sc2_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010238 Returns the amount of server-to-client data from the currently tracked
10239 counters, measured in kilobytes over the period configured in the table. The
10240 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
10241 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_out.
10242
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010243sc_sess_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010244sc0_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
10245sc1_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
10246sc2_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010247 Returns the cumulated number of incoming connections that were transformed
10248 into sessions, which means that they were accepted by a "tcp-request
10249 connection" rule, from the currently tracked counters. A backend may count
10250 more sessions than connections because each connection could result in many
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040010251 backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is performed over the connection
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010252 with the client. See also src_sess_cnt.
10253
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010254sc_sess_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010255sc0_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
10256sc1_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
10257sc2_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010258 Returns the average session rate from the currently tracked counters,
10259 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
10260 session is a connection that got past the early "tcp-request connection"
10261 rules. A backend may count more sessions than connections because each
10262 connection could result in many backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040010263 performed over the connection with the client. See also src_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010264
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010265sc_tracked(<ctr>[,<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010266sc0_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
10267sc1_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
10268sc2_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau6f1615f2013-06-03 15:15:22 +020010269 Returns true if the designated session counter is currently being tracked by
10270 the current session. This can be useful when deciding whether or not we want
10271 to set some values in a header passed to the server.
10272
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020010273sc_trackers(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020010274sc0_trackers([<table>]) : integer
10275sc1_trackers([<table>]) : integer
10276sc2_trackers([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010010277 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
10278 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010279 begins and decremented when tracking stops. It differs from sc0_conn_cur in
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010010280 that it does not rely on any stored information but on the table's reference
10281 count (the "use" value which is returned by "show table" on the CLI). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010282 may sometimes be more suited for layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a
10283 server how many concurrent connections there are from a given address for
10284 example.
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010010285
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010286so_id : integer
10287 Returns an integer containing the current listening socket's id. It is useful
10288 in frontends involving many "bind" lines, or to stick all users coming via a
10289 same socket to the same server.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010290
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010291src : ip
10292 This is the source IPv4 address of the client of the session. It is of type
10293 IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 addresses are
10294 mapped to their IPv6 equivalent, according to RFC 4291. Note that it is the
10295 TCP-level source address which is used, and not the address of a client
10296 behind a proxy. However if the "accept-proxy" bind directive is used, it can
10297 be the address of a client behind another PROXY-protocol compatible component
10298 for all rule sets except "tcp-request connection" which sees the real address.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010299
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010010300 Example:
10301 # add an HTTP header in requests with the originating address' country
10302 http-request set-header X-Country %[src,map_ip(geoip.lst)]
10303
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010304src_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
10305 Returns the average bytes rate from the incoming connection's source address
10306 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
10307 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010308 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_in_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010309
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010310src_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
10311 Returns the average bytes rate to the incoming connection's source address in
10312 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010313 amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010314 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_out_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010315
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010316src_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
10317 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
10318 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
10319 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
10320 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
10321 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
10322 was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020010323
10324 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
10325 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
10326 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
10327 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 5
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010010328 acl save src_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020010329 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
10330 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
10331
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010332src_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010333 Returns the cumulated number of connections initiated from the current
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010334 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010335 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010336 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010337
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010338src_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010339 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections initiated from the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010340 current incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
10341 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. If the address is not found,
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010342 zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cur.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010343
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010344src_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
10345 Returns the average connection rate from the incoming connection's source
10346 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
10347 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table. If
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010348 the address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010349
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010350src_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010351 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010352 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010353 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010354 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0 and src_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010355
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010356src_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020010357 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010358 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020010359 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
10360 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010361 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc0_rate, src_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
10362 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
10363 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020010364
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010365src_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
10366 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's
10367 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010368 stick-table. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010369 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_cnt. If the address is not found, zero is
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010370 returned.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010371
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010372src_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
10373 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's source
10374 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
10375 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
10376 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010377 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010378
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010379src_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
10380 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
10381 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
10382 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010383 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010384
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010385src_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
10386 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
10387 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
10388 table, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in the
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010389 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010390 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010391
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010392src_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
10393 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
10394 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
10395 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010396 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010397 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
10398 connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010399
10400 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010010401 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010402 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010403
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010404src_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
10405 Returns the amount of data received from the incoming connection's source
10406 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
10407 measured in kilobytes over the period configured in the table. If the address
10408 is not found, zero is returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010409 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also
10410 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010411
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010412src_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
10413 Returns the amount of data sent to the incoming connection's source address
10414 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010415 in kilobytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is not
10416 found, zero is returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010417 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020010418
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010419src_port : integer
10420 Returns an integer value corresponding to the TCP source port of the
10421 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected from.
10422 Usage of this function is very limited as modern protocols do not care much
10423 about source ports nowadays.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010010424
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010425src_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
10426 Returns the cumulated number of connections initiated from the incoming
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010427 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
10428 designated stick-table, that were transformed into sessions, which means that
10429 they were accepted by "tcp-request" rules. If the address is not found, zero
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010430 is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010431
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010432src_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
10433 Returns the average session rate from the incoming connection's source
10434 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
10435 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
10436 session is a connection that went past the early "tcp-request" rules. If the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020010437 address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010438
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010439src_updt_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
10440 Creates or updates the entry associated to the incoming connection's source
10441 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table.
10442 This table must be configured to store the "conn_cnt" data type, otherwise
10443 the match will be ignored. The current count is incremented by one, and the
10444 expiration timer refreshed. The updated count is returned, so this match
10445 can't return zero. This was used to reject service abusers based on their
10446 source address. Note: it is recommended to use the more complete "track-sc*"
10447 actions in "tcp-request" rules instead.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020010448
10449 Example :
10450 # This frontend limits incoming SSH connections to 3 per 10 second for
10451 # each source address, and rejects excess connections until a 10 second
10452 # silence is observed. At most 20 addresses are tracked.
10453 listen ssh
10454 bind :22
10455 mode tcp
10456 maxconn 100
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010457 stick-table type ip size 20 expire 10s store conn_cnt
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010458 tcp-request content reject if { src_updt_conn_cnt gt 3 }
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020010459 server local 127.0.0.1:22
10460
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010461srv_id : integer
10462 Returns an integer containing the server's id when processing the response.
10463 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
10464 debugging.
Hervé COMMOWICKdaa824e2011-08-05 12:09:44 +020010465
Hervé COMMOWICK35ed8012010-12-15 14:04:51 +010010466
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200104677.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010468----------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0b1cd942010-05-16 22:18:27 +020010469
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010470The layer 5 usually describes just the session layer which in haproxy is
10471closest to the session once all the connection handshakes are finished, but
10472when no content is yet made available. The fetch methods described here are
10473usable as low as the "tcp-request content" rule sets unless they require some
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010474future information. Those generally include the results of SSL negotiations.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020010475
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020010476ssl_bc : boolean
10477 Returns true when the back connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
10478 layer and is locally deciphered. This means the outgoing connection was made
10479 other a server with the "ssl" option.
10480
10481ssl_bc_alg_keysize : integer
10482 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the outgoing
10483 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
10484
10485ssl_bc_cipher : string
10486 Returns the name of the used cipher when the outgoing connection was made
10487 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
10488
10489ssl_bc_protocol : string
10490 Returns the name of the used protocol when the outgoing connection was made
10491 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
10492
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020010493ssl_bc_unique_id : binary
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020010494 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020010495 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
10496 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64".
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020010497
10498ssl_bc_session_id : binary
10499 Returns the SSL ID of the back connection when the outgoing connection was
10500 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to log if we want to know
10501 if session was reused or not.
10502
10503ssl_bc_use_keysize : integer
10504 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the outgoing
10505 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
10506
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010507ssl_c_ca_err : integer
10508 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
10509 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification of the client
10510 certificate at depth > 0, or 0 if no error was encountered during this
10511 verification process. Please refer to your SSL library's documentation to
10512 find the exhaustive list of error codes.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020010513
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010514ssl_c_ca_err_depth : integer
10515 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
10516 returns the depth in the CA chain of the first error detected during the
10517 verification of the client certificate. If no error is encountered, 0 is
10518 returned.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010519
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010520ssl_c_err : integer
10521 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
10522 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification at depth 0, or
10523 0 if no error was encountered during this verification process. Please refer
10524 to your SSL library's documentation to find the exhaustive list of error
10525 codes.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010526
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010527ssl_c_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
10528 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
10529 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
10530 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
10531 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
10532 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
10533 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
10534 For instance, "ssl_c_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
10535 "ssl_c_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010536
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010537ssl_c_key_alg : string
10538 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
10539 presented by the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
10540 transport layer.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010541
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010542ssl_c_notafter : string
10543 Returns the end date presented by the client as a formatted string
10544 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
10545 transport layer.
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020010546
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010547ssl_c_notbefore : string
10548 Returns the start date presented by the client as a formatted string
10549 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
10550 transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010010551
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010552ssl_c_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
10553 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
10554 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
10555 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
10556 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
10557 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
10558 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
10559 For instance, "ssl_c_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
10560 "ssl_c_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010010561
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010562ssl_c_serial : binary
10563 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the client when the
10564 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
10565 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020010566
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010567ssl_c_sha1 : binary
10568 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the client when
10569 the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This can be
10570 used to stick a client to a server, or to pass this information to a server.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020010571
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010572ssl_c_sig_alg : string
10573 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
10574 the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
10575 layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020010576
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010577ssl_c_used : boolean
10578 Returns true if current SSL session uses a client certificate even if current
10579 connection uses SSL session resumption. See also "ssl_fc_has_crt".
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020010580
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010581ssl_c_verify : integer
10582 Returns the verify result error ID when the incoming connection was made over
10583 an SSL/TLS transport layer, otherwise zero if no error is encountered. Please
10584 refer to your SSL library's documentation for an exhaustive list of error
10585 codes.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020010586
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010587ssl_c_version : integer
10588 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the client when the
10589 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020010590
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010591ssl_f_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
10592 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
10593 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
10594 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
10595 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020010596 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010597 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
10598 For instance, "ssl_f_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
10599 "ssl_f_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020010600
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010601ssl_f_key_alg : string
10602 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
10603 presented by the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an
10604 SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020010605
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010606ssl_f_notafter : string
10607 Returns the end date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
10608 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
10609 transport layer.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020010610
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010611ssl_f_notbefore : string
10612 Returns the start date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
10613 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
10614 transport layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020010615
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010616ssl_f_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
10617 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
10618 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
10619 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
10620 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
10621 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
10622 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
10623 For instance, "ssl_f_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
10624 "ssl_f_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020010625
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010626ssl_f_serial : binary
10627 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
10628 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
10629 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020010630
Emeric Brun55f4fa82014-04-30 17:11:25 +020010631ssl_f_sha1 : binary
10632 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the frontend
10633 when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This
10634 can be used to know which certificate was chosen using SNI.
10635
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010636ssl_f_sig_alg : string
10637 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
10638 the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
10639 layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020010640
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010641ssl_f_version : integer
10642 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
10643 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
10644
10645ssl_fc : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020010646 Returns true when the front connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
10647 layer and is locally deciphered. This means it has matched a socket declared
10648 with a "bind" line having the "ssl" option.
10649
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010650 Example :
10651 # This passes "X-Proto: https" to servers when client connects over SSL
10652 listen http-https
10653 bind :80
10654 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy.pem
10655 http-request add-header X-Proto https if { ssl_fc }
10656
10657ssl_fc_alg_keysize : integer
10658 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the incoming
10659 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
10660
10661ssl_fc_alpn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010662 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010663 incoming connection made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by
10664 haproxy. The result is a string containing the protocol name advertised by
10665 the client. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
10666 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
10667 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a
10668 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the client to pick a protocol from this
10669 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
10670 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_fc_npn".
10671
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010672ssl_fc_cipher : string
10673 Returns the name of the used cipher when the incoming connection was made
10674 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020010675
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010676ssl_fc_has_crt : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020010677 Returns true if a client certificate is present in an incoming connection over
10678 SSL/TLS transport layer. Useful if 'verify' statement is set to 'optional'.
Emeric Brun9143d372012-12-20 15:44:16 +010010679 Note: on SSL session resumption with Session ID or TLS ticket, client
10680 certificate is not present in the current connection but may be retrieved
10681 from the cache or the ticket. So prefer "ssl_c_used" if you want to check if
10682 current SSL session uses a client certificate.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020010683
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010684ssl_fc_has_sni : boolean
10685 This checks for the presence of a Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI)
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020010686 in an incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. Returns
10687 true when the incoming connection presents a TLS SNI field. This requires
10688 that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
10689 haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020010690
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010691ssl_fc_npn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010692 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an incoming connection
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010693 made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by haproxy. The result
10694 is a string containing the protocol name advertised by the client. The SSL
10695 library must have been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
10696 haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the
10697 "npn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing
10698 forces the client to pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be
10699 requested. Please note that the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN.
Willy Tarreaua33c6542012-10-15 13:19:06 +020010700
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010701ssl_fc_protocol : string
10702 Returns the name of the used protocol when the incoming connection was made
10703 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020010704
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020010705ssl_fc_unique_id : binary
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040010706 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020010707 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
10708 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64".
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040010709
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010710ssl_fc_session_id : binary
10711 Returns the SSL ID of the front connection when the incoming connection was
10712 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to stick a given client to
10713 a server. It is important to note that some browsers refresh their session ID
10714 every few minutes.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020010715
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010716ssl_fc_sni : string
10717 This extracts the Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI) field from an
10718 incoming connection made via an SSL/TLS transport layer and locally
10719 deciphered by haproxy. The result (when present) typically is a string
10720 matching the HTTPS host name (253 chars or less). The SSL library must have
10721 been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv).
10722
10723 This fetch is different from "req_ssl_sni" above in that it applies to the
10724 connection being deciphered by haproxy and not to SSL contents being blindly
10725 forwarded. See also "ssl_fc_sni_end" and "ssl_fc_sni_reg" below. This
Cyril Bonté9c1eb1e2012-10-09 22:45:34 +020010726 requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions
10727 enabled (check haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010728
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010729 ACL derivatives :
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010730 ssl_fc_sni_end : suffix match
10731 ssl_fc_sni_reg : regex match
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +020010732
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010733ssl_fc_use_keysize : integer
10734 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the incoming
10735 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020010736
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020010737
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200107387.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010739------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020010740
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010741Fetching samples from buffer contents is a bit different from the previous
10742sample fetches above because the sampled data are ephemeral. These data can
10743only be used when they're available and will be lost when they're forwarded.
10744For this reason, samples fetched from buffer contents during a request cannot
10745be used in a response for example. Even while the data are being fetched, they
10746can change. Sometimes it is necessary to set some delays or combine multiple
10747sample fetch methods to ensure that the expected data are complete and usable,
10748for example through TCP request content inspection. Please see the "tcp-request
10749content" keyword for more detailed information on the subject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010750
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010751payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary (deprecated)
10752 This is an alias for "req.payload" when used in the context of a request (eg:
10753 "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload" when used in the context of
10754 a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010755
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010756payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary (deprecated)
10757 This is an alias for "req.payload_lv" when used in the context of a request
10758 (eg: "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload_lv" when used in the
10759 context of a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010760
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010761req.len : integer
10762req_len : integer (deprecated)
10763 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
10764 request buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
10765 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
10766 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
10767 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
10768 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
10769 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP request
10770 content inspection.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020010771
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010772req.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
10773 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020010774 in the request buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
10775 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
10776 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
10777 any location.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020010778
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010779 ACL alternatives :
10780 payload(<offset>,<length>) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020010781
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010782req.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
10783 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
10784 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
10785 the request buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets if
10786 prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020010787
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010788 ACL alternatives :
10789 payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020010790
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010791 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020010792
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010793req.proto_http : boolean
10794req_proto_http : boolean (deprecated)
10795 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like HTTP and correctly
10796 parses as such. It is the same parser as the common HTTP request parser which
10797 is used so there should be no surprises. The test does not match until the
10798 request is complete, failed or timed out. This test may be used to report the
10799 protocol in TCP logs, but the biggest use is to block TCP request analysis
10800 until a complete HTTP request is present in the buffer, for example to track
10801 a header.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020010802
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010803 Example:
10804 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
10805 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
10806 tcp-request content reject if !HTTP
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010807 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020010808
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010809req.rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string
10810rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
10811 When the request buffer looks like the RDP protocol, extracts the RDP cookie
10812 <name>, or any cookie if unspecified. The parser only checks for the first
10813 cookie, as illustrated in the RDP protocol specification. The cookie name is
10814 case insensitive. Generally the "MSTS" cookie name will be used, as it can
10815 contain the user name of the client connecting to the server if properly
10816 configured on the client. The "MSTSHASH" cookie is often used as well for
10817 session stickiness to servers.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020010818
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010819 This differs from "balance rdp-cookie" in that any balancing algorithm may be
10820 used and thus the distribution of clients to backend servers is not linked to
10821 a hash of the RDP cookie. It is envisaged that using a balancing algorithm
10822 such as "balance roundrobin" or "balance leastconn" will lead to a more even
10823 distribution of clients to backend servers than the hash used by "balance
10824 rdp-cookie".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020010825
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010826 ACL derivatives :
10827 req_rdp_cookie([<name>]) : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020010828
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010829 Example :
10830 listen tse-farm
10831 bind 0.0.0.0:3389
10832 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
10833 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
10834 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
10835 # apply RDP cookie persistence
10836 persist rdp-cookie
10837 # Persist based on the mstshash cookie
10838 # This is only useful makes sense if
10839 # balance rdp-cookie is not used
10840 stick-table type string size 204800
10841 stick on req.rdp_cookie(mstshash)
10842 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
10843 server srv1 1.1.1.2:3389
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020010844
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010845 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "persist rdp-cookie", "tcp-request" and the
10846 "req_rdp_cookie" ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020010847
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010848req.rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer
10849rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer (deprecated)
10850 Tries to parse the request buffer as RDP protocol, then returns an integer
10851 corresponding to the number of RDP cookies found. If an optional cookie name
10852 is passed, only cookies matching this name are considered. This is mostly
10853 used in ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020010854
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010855 ACL derivatives :
10856 req_rdp_cookie_cnt([<name>]) : integer match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020010857
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010858req.ssl_hello_type : integer
10859req_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
10860 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
10861 in the request buffer if the buffer contains data that parse as a complete
10862 SSL (v3 or superior) client hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
10863 contents found in the request buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
10864 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl"
10865 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
10866 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020010867
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010868req.ssl_sni : string
10869req_ssl_sni : string (deprecated)
10870 Returns a string containing the value of the Server Name TLS extension sent
10871 by a client in a TLS stream passing through the request buffer if the buffer
10872 contains data that parse as a complete SSL (v3 or superior) client hello
10873 message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
10874 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
10875 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. SNI normally contains the
10876 name of the host the client tries to connect to (for recent browsers). SNI is
10877 useful for allowing or denying access to certain hosts when SSL/TLS is used
10878 by the client. This test was designed to be used with TCP request content
10879 inspection. If content switching is needed, it is recommended to first wait
10880 for a complete client hello (type 1), like in the example below. See also
10881 "ssl_fc_sni".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020010882
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010883 ACL derivatives :
10884 req_ssl_sni : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020010885
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010886 Examples :
10887 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
10888 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
10889 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
10890 use_backend bk_allow if { req_ssl_sni -f allowed_sites }
10891 default_backend bk_sorry_page
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020010892
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010893res.ssl_hello_type : integer
10894rep_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
10895 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
10896 in the response buffer if the buffer contains data that parses as a complete
10897 SSL (v3 or superior) hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
10898 contents found in the response buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
10899 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "server" lines having the "ssl"
10900 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
10901 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
Willy Tarreau51539362012-05-08 12:46:28 +020010902
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010903req.ssl_ver : integer
10904req_ssl_ver : integer (deprecated)
10905 Returns an integer value containing the version of the SSL/TLS protocol of a
10906 stream present in the request buffer. Both SSLv2 hello messages and SSLv3
10907 messages are supported. TLSv1 is announced as SSL version 3.1. The value is
10908 composed of the major version multiplied by 65536, added to the minor
10909 version. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
10910 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
10911 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. The ACL version of the test
10912 matches against a decimal notation in the form MAJOR.MINOR (eg: 3.1). This
10913 fetch is mostly used in ACL.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010914
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010915 ACL derivatives :
10916 req_ssl_ver : decimal match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010917
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020010918res.len : integer
10919 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
10920 response buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
10921 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
10922 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
10923 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
10924 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
10925 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP response
10926 content inspection.
10927
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010928res.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
10929 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020010930 in the response buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
10931 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
10932 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
10933 any location.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010934
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010935res.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
10936 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
10937 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
10938 the response buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets
10939 if prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010940
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010941 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010942
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010943wait_end : boolean
10944 This fetch either returns true when the inspection period is over, or does
10945 not fetch. It is only used in ACLs, in conjunction with content analysis to
10946 avoid returning a wrong verdict early. It may also be used to delay some
10947 actions, such as a delayed reject for some special addresses. Since it either
10948 stops the rules evaluation or immediately returns true, it is recommended to
10949 use this acl as the last one in a rule. Please note that the default ACL
10950 "WAIT_END" is always usable without prior declaration. This test was designed
10951 to be used with TCP request content inspection.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010952
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010953 Examples :
10954 # delay every incoming request by 2 seconds
10955 tcp-request inspect-delay 2s
10956 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010957
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010958 # don't immediately tell bad guys they are rejected
10959 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
10960 acl goodguys src 10.0.0.0/24
10961 acl badguys src 10.0.1.0/24
10962 tcp-request content accept if goodguys
10963 tcp-request content reject if badguys WAIT_END
10964 tcp-request content reject
10965
10966
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200109677.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010968--------------------------------------
10969
10970It is possible to fetch samples from HTTP contents, requests and responses.
10971This application layer is also called layer 7. It is only possible to fetch the
10972data in this section when a full HTTP request or response has been parsed from
10973its respective request or response buffer. This is always the case with all
10974HTTP specific rules and for sections running with "mode http". When using TCP
10975content inspection, it may be necessary to support an inspection delay in order
10976to let the request or response come in first. These fetches may require a bit
10977more CPU resources than the layer 4 ones, but not much since the request and
10978response are indexed.
10979
10980base : string
10981 This returns the concatenation of the first Host header and the path part of
10982 the request, which starts at the first slash and ends before the question
10983 mark. It can be useful in virtual hosted environments to detect URL abuses as
10984 well as to improve shared caches efficiency. Using this with a limited size
10985 stick table also allows one to collect statistics about most commonly
10986 requested objects by host/path. With ACLs it can allow simple content
10987 switching rules involving the host and the path at the same time, such as
10988 "www.example.com/favicon.ico". See also "path" and "uri".
10989
10990 ACL derivatives :
10991 base : exact string match
10992 base_beg : prefix match
10993 base_dir : subdir match
10994 base_dom : domain match
10995 base_end : suffix match
10996 base_len : length match
10997 base_reg : regex match
10998 base_sub : substring match
10999
11000base32 : integer
11001 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value returned by the "base" fetch method
11002 above. This is useful to track per-URL activity on high traffic sites without
11003 having to store all URLs. Instead a shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of
11004 memory. The output type is an unsigned integer.
11005
11006base32+src : binary
11007 This returns the concatenation of the base32 fetch above and the src fetch
11008 below. The resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes
11009 depending on the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP,
11010 per-URL counters.
11011
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010011012capture.req.hdr(<idx>) : string
11013 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture request
11014 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
11015 The first entry is an index of 0. See also: "capture request header".
11016
11017capture.req.method : string
11018 This extracts the METHOD of an HTTP request. It can be used in both request
11019 and response. Unlike "method", it can be used in both request and response
11020 because it's allocated.
11021
11022capture.req.uri : string
11023 This extracts the request's URI, which starts at the first slash and ends
11024 before the first space in the request (without the host part). Unlike "path"
11025 and "url", it can be used in both request and response because it's
11026 allocated.
11027
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020011028capture.req.ver : string
11029 This extracts the request's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
11030 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "req.ver", it can be used in both request, response, and
11031 logs because it relies on a persistent flag.
11032
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010011033capture.res.hdr(<idx>) : string
11034 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture response
11035 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
11036 The first entry is an index of 0.
11037 See also: "capture response header"
11038
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020011039capture.res.ver : string
11040 This extracts the response's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
11041 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "res.ver", it can be used in logs because it relies on a
11042 persistent flag.
11043
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011044req.cook([<name>]) : string
11045cook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
11046 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
11047 header line from the request, and returns its value as string. If no name is
11048 specified, the first cookie value is returned. When used with ACLs, all
11049 matching cookies are evaluated. Spaces around the name and the value are
11050 ignored as requested by the Cookie header specification (RFC6265). The cookie
11051 name is case-sensitive. Empty cookies are valid, so an empty cookie may very
11052 well return an empty value if it is present. Use the "found" match to detect
11053 presence. Use the res.cook() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
11054
11055 ACL derivatives :
11056 cook([<name>]) : exact string match
11057 cook_beg([<name>]) : prefix match
11058 cook_dir([<name>]) : subdir match
11059 cook_dom([<name>]) : domain match
11060 cook_end([<name>]) : suffix match
11061 cook_len([<name>]) : length match
11062 cook_reg([<name>]) : regex match
11063 cook_sub([<name>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011064
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011065req.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
11066cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
11067 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
11068 <name> in the request, or all cookies if <name> is not specified.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011069
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011070req.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
11071cook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
11072 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
11073 header line from the request, and converts its value to an integer which is
11074 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned. When
11075 used in ACLs, all matching names are iterated over until a value matches.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020011076
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011077cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
11078 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
11079 header line from the request, or a "Set-Cookie" header from the response, and
11080 returns its value as a string. A typical use is to get multiple clients
11081 sharing a same profile use the same server. This can be similar to what
11082 "appsession" does with the "request-learn" statement, but with support for
11083 multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts. If no name is
11084 specified, the first cookie value is returned. This fetch should not be used
11085 anymore and should be replaced by req.cook() or res.cook() instead as it
11086 ambiguously uses the direction based on the context where it is used.
11087 See also : "appsession".
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011088
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011089hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
11090 This is equivalent to req.hdr() when used on requests, and to res.hdr() when
11091 used on responses. Please refer to these respective fetches for more details.
11092 In case of doubt about the fetch direction, please use the explicit ones.
11093 Note that contrary to the hdr() sample fetch method, the hdr_* ACL keywords
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011094 unambiguously apply to the request headers.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011095
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011096req.fhdr(<name>[,<occ>]) : string
11097 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
11098 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
11099 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
11100 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
11101 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
11102 with -1 being the last one. It differs from req.hdr() in that any commas
11103 present in the value are returned and are not used as delimiters. This is
11104 sometimes useful with headers such as User-Agent.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011105
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011106req.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
11107 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
11108 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
11109 not specified. Contrary to its req.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
11110 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011111
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011112req.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
11113 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
11114 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
11115 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
11116 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
11117 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
11118 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header
11119 once converted to IP, associated with an IP stick-table. The function
11120 considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers
11121 are desired instead, use req.fhdr(). Please carefully check RFC2616 to know
11122 how certain headers are supposed to be parsed. Also, some of them are case
11123 insensitive (eg: Connection).
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011124
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011125 ACL derivatives :
11126 hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
11127 hdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
11128 hdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
11129 hdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
11130 hdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
11131 hdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
11132 hdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
11133 hdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
11134
11135req.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
11136hdr_cnt([<header>]) : integer (deprecated)
11137 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
11138 header field name <name>, or the total number of header field values if
11139 <name> is not specified. It is important to remember that one header line may
11140 count as several headers if it has several values. The function considers any
11141 comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers are desired
11142 instead, req.fhdr_cnt() should be used instead. With ACLs, it can be used to
11143 detect presence, absence or abuse of a specific header, as well as to block
11144 request smuggling attacks by rejecting requests which contain more than one
11145 of certain headers. See "req.hdr" for more information on header matching.
11146
11147req.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
11148hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
11149 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request,
11150 converts it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. When used
11151 with ACLs, all occurrences are checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value
11152 of every header is checked. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
11153 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
11154 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
11155 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. A typical use
11156 is with the X-Forwarded-For and X-Client-IP headers.
11157
11158req.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
11159hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
11160 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request, and
11161 converts it to an integer value. When used with ACLs, all occurrences are
11162 checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value of every header is checked.
11163 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
11164 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
11165 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
11166 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header.
11167
11168http_auth(<userlist>) : boolean
11169 Returns a boolean indicating whether the authentication data received from
11170 the client match a username & password stored in the specified userlist. This
11171 fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
11172 basic auth is supported.
11173
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010011174http_auth_group(<userlist>) : string
11175 Returns a string corresponding to the user name found in the authentication
11176 data received from the client if both the user name and password are valid
11177 according to the specified userlist. The main purpose is to use it in ACLs
11178 where it is then checked whether the user belongs to any group within a list.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011179 This fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
11180 basic auth is supported.
11181
11182 ACL derivatives :
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010011183 http_auth_group(<userlist>) : group ...
11184 Returns true when the user extracted from the request and whose password is
11185 valid according to the specified userlist belongs to at least one of the
11186 groups.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011187
11188http_first_req : boolean
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020011189 Returns true when the request being processed is the first one of the
11190 connection. This can be used to add or remove headers that may be missing
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011191 from some requests when a request is not the first one, or to help grouping
11192 requests in the logs.
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020011193
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011194method : integer + string
11195 Returns an integer value corresponding to the method in the HTTP request. For
11196 example, "GET" equals 1 (check sources to establish the matching). Value 9
11197 means "other method" and may be converted to a string extracted from the
11198 stream. This should not be used directly as a sample, this is only meant to
11199 be used from ACLs, which transparently convert methods from patterns to these
11200 integer + string values. Some predefined ACL already check for most common
11201 methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011202
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011203 ACL derivatives :
11204 method : case insensitive method match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011205
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011206 Example :
11207 # only accept GET and HEAD requests
11208 acl valid_method method GET HEAD
11209 http-request deny if ! valid_method
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011210
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011211path : string
11212 This extracts the request's URL path, which starts at the first slash and
11213 ends before the question mark (without the host part). A typical use is with
11214 prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate multiple
11215 information from databases and keep them in caches. Note that with outgoing
11216 caches, it would be wiser to use "url" instead. With ACLs, it's typically
11217 used to match exact file names (eg: "/login.php"), or directory parts using
11218 the derivative forms. See also the "url" and "base" fetch methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011219
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011220 ACL derivatives :
11221 path : exact string match
11222 path_beg : prefix match
11223 path_dir : subdir match
11224 path_dom : domain match
11225 path_end : suffix match
11226 path_len : length match
11227 path_reg : regex match
11228 path_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011229
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011230req.ver : string
11231req_ver : string (deprecated)
11232 Returns the version string from the HTTP request, for example "1.1". This can
11233 be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL. Some predefined ACL already
11234 check for versions 1.0 and 1.1.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011235
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011236 ACL derivatives :
11237 req_ver : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020011238
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011239res.comp : boolean
11240 Returns the boolean "true" value if the response has been compressed by
11241 HAProxy, otherwise returns boolean "false". This may be used to add
11242 information in the logs.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011243
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011244res.comp_algo : string
11245 Returns a string containing the name of the algorithm used if the response
11246 was compressed by HAProxy, for example : "deflate". This may be used to add
11247 some information in the logs.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011248
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011249res.cook([<name>]) : string
11250scook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
11251 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
11252 header line from the response, and returns its value as string. If no name is
11253 specified, the first cookie value is returned.
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020011254
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011255 ACL derivatives :
11256 scook([<name>] : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020011257
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011258res.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
11259scook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
11260 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
11261 <name> in the response, or all cookies if <name> is not specified. This is
11262 mostly useful when combined with ACLs to detect suspicious responses.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011263
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011264res.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
11265scook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
11266 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
11267 header line from the response, and converts its value to an integer which is
11268 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011269
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011270res.fhdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
11271 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
11272 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
11273 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
11274 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
11275 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. It
11276 differs from res.hdr() in that any commas present in the value are returned
11277 and are not used as delimiters. If this is not desired, the res.hdr() fetch
11278 should be used instead. This is sometimes useful with headers such as Date or
11279 Expires.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011280
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011281res.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
11282 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
11283 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
11284 not specified. Contrary to its res.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
11285 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas. If this is not
11286 desired, the res.hdr_cnt() fetch should be used instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011287
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011288res.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
11289shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string (deprecated)
11290 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
11291 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
11292 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
11293 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
11294 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This
11295 can be useful to learn some data into a stick-table. The function considers
11296 any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If this is not desired, the
11297 res.fhdr() fetch should be used instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011298
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011299 ACL derivatives :
11300 shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
11301 shdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
11302 shdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
11303 shdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
11304 shdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
11305 shdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
11306 shdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
11307 shdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
11308
11309res.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
11310shdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
11311 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
11312 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
11313 not specified. The function considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct
11314 values. If this is not desired, the res.fhdr_cnt() fetch should be used
11315 instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011316
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011317res.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
11318shdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
11319 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response,
11320 convert it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. Optionally, a
11321 specific occurrence might be specified as a position number. Positive values
11322 indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one.
11323 Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being
11324 the last one. This can be useful to learn some data into a stick table.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011325
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011326res.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
11327shdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
11328 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, and
11329 converts it to an integer value. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
11330 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
11331 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
11332 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This can be
11333 useful to learn some data into a stick table.
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010011334
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011335res.ver : string
11336resp_ver : string (deprecated)
11337 Returns the version string from the HTTP response, for example "1.1". This
11338 can be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020011339
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011340 ACL derivatives :
11341 resp_ver : exact string match
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010011342
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011343set-cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
11344 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
11345 header line from the response and uses the corresponding value to match. This
11346 can be comparable to what "appsession" does with default options, but with
11347 support for multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010011348
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011349 This fetch function is deprecated and has been superseded by the "res.cook"
11350 fetch. This keyword will disappear soon.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010011351
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011352 See also : "appsession"
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020011353
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011354status : integer
11355 Returns an integer containing the HTTP status code in the HTTP response, for
11356 example, 302. It is mostly used within ACLs and integer ranges, for example,
11357 to remove any Location header if the response is not a 3xx.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020011358
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011359url : string
11360 This extracts the request's URL as presented in the request. A typical use is
11361 with prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate
11362 multiple information from databases and keep them in caches. With ACLs, using
11363 "path" is preferred over using "url", because clients may send a full URL as
11364 is normally done with proxies. The only real use is to match "*" which does
11365 not match in "path", and for which there is already a predefined ACL. See
11366 also "path" and "base".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020011367
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011368 ACL derivatives :
11369 url : exact string match
11370 url_beg : prefix match
11371 url_dir : subdir match
11372 url_dom : domain match
11373 url_end : suffix match
11374 url_len : length match
11375 url_reg : regex match
11376 url_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020011377
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011378url_ip : ip
11379 This extracts the IP address from the request's URL when the host part is
11380 presented as an IP address. Its use is very limited. For instance, a
11381 monitoring system might use this field as an alternative for the source IP in
11382 order to test what path a given source address would follow, or to force an
11383 entry in a table for a given source address. With ACLs it can be used to
11384 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
11385 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020011386
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011387url_port : integer
11388 This extracts the port part from the request's URL. Note that if the port is
11389 not specified in the request, port 80 is assumed. With ACLs it can be used to
11390 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
11391 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020011392
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011393urlp(<name>[,<delim>]) : string
11394url_param(<name>[,<delim>]) : string
11395 This extracts the first occurrence of the parameter <name> in the query
11396 string, which begins after either '?' or <delim>, and which ends before '&',
11397 ';' or <delim>. The parameter name is case-sensitive. The result is a string
11398 corresponding to the value of the parameter <name> as presented in the
11399 request (no URL decoding is performed). This can be used for session
11400 stickiness based on a client ID, to extract an application cookie passed as a
11401 URL parameter, or in ACLs to apply some checks. Note that the ACL version of
11402 this fetch do not iterate over multiple parameters and stop at the first one
11403 as well.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020011404
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011405 ACL derivatives :
11406 urlp(<name>[,<delim>]) : exact string match
11407 urlp_beg(<name>[,<delim>]) : prefix match
11408 urlp_dir(<name>[,<delim>]) : subdir match
11409 urlp_dom(<name>[,<delim>]) : domain match
11410 urlp_end(<name>[,<delim>]) : suffix match
11411 urlp_len(<name>[,<delim>]) : length match
11412 urlp_reg(<name>[,<delim>]) : regex match
11413 urlp_sub(<name>[,<delim>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020011414
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020011415
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011416 Example :
11417 # match http://example.com/foo?PHPSESSIONID=some_id
11418 stick on urlp(PHPSESSIONID)
11419 # match http://example.com/foo;JSESSIONID=some_id
11420 stick on urlp(JSESSIONID,;)
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020011421
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011422urlp_val(<name>[,<delim>]) : integer
11423 See "urlp" above. This one extracts the URL parameter <name> in the request
11424 and converts it to an integer value. This can be used for session stickiness
11425 based on a user ID for example, or with ACLs to match a page number or price.
Willy Tarreaua9fddca2012-07-31 07:51:48 +020011426
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +010011427
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200114287.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011429---------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010011430
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011431Some predefined ACLs are hard-coded so that they do not have to be declared in
11432every frontend which needs them. They all have their names in upper case in
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020011433order to avoid confusion. Their equivalence is provided below.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010011434
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011435ACL name Equivalent to Usage
11436---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011437FALSE always_false never match
Willy Tarreau2492d5b2009-07-11 00:06:00 +020011438HTTP req_proto_http match if protocol is valid HTTP
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011439HTTP_1.0 req_ver 1.0 match HTTP version 1.0
11440HTTP_1.1 req_ver 1.1 match HTTP version 1.1
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011441HTTP_CONTENT hdr_val(content-length) gt 0 match an existing content-length
11442HTTP_URL_ABS url_reg ^[^/:]*:// match absolute URL with scheme
11443HTTP_URL_SLASH url_beg / match URL beginning with "/"
11444HTTP_URL_STAR url * match URL equal to "*"
11445LOCALHOST src 127.0.0.1/8 match connection from local host
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011446METH_CONNECT method CONNECT match HTTP CONNECT method
11447METH_GET method GET HEAD match HTTP GET or HEAD method
11448METH_HEAD method HEAD match HTTP HEAD method
11449METH_OPTIONS method OPTIONS match HTTP OPTIONS method
11450METH_POST method POST match HTTP POST method
11451METH_TRACE method TRACE match HTTP TRACE method
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020011452RDP_COOKIE req_rdp_cookie_cnt gt 0 match presence of an RDP cookie
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011453REQ_CONTENT req_len gt 0 match data in the request buffer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011454TRUE always_true always match
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011455WAIT_END wait_end wait for end of content analysis
11456---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010011457
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011458
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200114598. Logging
11460----------
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011461
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011462One of HAProxy's strong points certainly lies is its precise logs. It probably
11463provides the finest level of information available for such a product, which is
11464very important for troubleshooting complex environments. Standard information
11465provided in logs include client ports, TCP/HTTP state timers, precise session
11466state at termination and precise termination cause, information about decisions
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011467to direct traffic to a server, and of course the ability to capture arbitrary
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011468headers.
11469
11470In order to improve administrators reactivity, it offers a great transparency
11471about encountered problems, both internal and external, and it is possible to
11472send logs to different sources at the same time with different level filters :
11473
11474 - global process-level logs (system errors, start/stop, etc..)
11475 - per-instance system and internal errors (lack of resource, bugs, ...)
11476 - per-instance external troubles (servers up/down, max connections)
11477 - per-instance activity (client connections), either at the establishment or
11478 at the termination.
11479
11480The ability to distribute different levels of logs to different log servers
11481allow several production teams to interact and to fix their problems as soon
11482as possible. For example, the system team might monitor system-wide errors,
11483while the application team might be monitoring the up/down for their servers in
11484real time, and the security team might analyze the activity logs with one hour
11485delay.
11486
11487
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200114888.1. Log levels
11489---------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011490
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090011491TCP and HTTP connections can be logged with information such as the date, time,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011492source IP address, destination address, connection duration, response times,
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090011493HTTP request, HTTP return code, number of bytes transmitted, conditions
11494in which the session ended, and even exchanged cookies values. For example
11495track a particular user's problems. All messages may be sent to up to two
11496syslog servers. Check the "log" keyword in section 4.2 for more information
11497about log facilities.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011498
11499
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200115008.2. Log formats
11501----------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011502
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010011503HAProxy supports 5 log formats. Several fields are common between these formats
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090011504and will be detailed in the following sections. A few of them may vary
11505slightly with the configuration, due to indicators specific to certain
11506options. The supported formats are as follows :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011507
11508 - the default format, which is very basic and very rarely used. It only
11509 provides very basic information about the incoming connection at the moment
11510 it is accepted : source IP:port, destination IP:port, and frontend-name.
11511 This mode will eventually disappear so it will not be described to great
11512 extents.
11513
11514 - the TCP format, which is more advanced. This format is enabled when "option
11515 tcplog" is set on the frontend. HAProxy will then usually wait for the
11516 connection to terminate before logging. This format provides much richer
11517 information, such as timers, connection counts, queue size, etc... This
11518 format is recommended for pure TCP proxies.
11519
11520 - the HTTP format, which is the most advanced for HTTP proxying. This format
11521 is enabled when "option httplog" is set on the frontend. It provides the
11522 same information as the TCP format with some HTTP-specific fields such as
11523 the request, the status code, and captures of headers and cookies. This
11524 format is recommended for HTTP proxies.
11525
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +020011526 - the CLF HTTP format, which is equivalent to the HTTP format, but with the
11527 fields arranged in the same order as the CLF format. In this mode, all
11528 timers, captures, flags, etc... appear one per field after the end of the
11529 common fields, in the same order they appear in the standard HTTP format.
11530
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010011531 - the custom log format, allows you to make your own log line.
11532
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011533Next sections will go deeper into details for each of these formats. Format
11534specification will be performed on a "field" basis. Unless stated otherwise, a
11535field is a portion of text delimited by any number of spaces. Since syslog
11536servers are susceptible of inserting fields at the beginning of a line, it is
11537always assumed that the first field is the one containing the process name and
11538identifier.
11539
11540Note : Since log lines may be quite long, the log examples in sections below
11541 might be broken into multiple lines. The example log lines will be
11542 prefixed with 3 closing angle brackets ('>>>') and each time a log is
11543 broken into multiple lines, each non-final line will end with a
11544 backslash ('\') and the next line will start indented by two characters.
11545
11546
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200115478.2.1. Default log format
11548-------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011549
11550This format is used when no specific option is set. The log is emitted as soon
11551as the connection is accepted. One should note that this currently is the only
11552format which logs the request's destination IP and ports.
11553
11554 Example :
11555 listen www
11556 mode http
11557 log global
11558 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
11559
11560 >>> Feb 6 12:12:09 localhost \
11561 haproxy[14385]: Connect from 10.0.1.2:33312 to 10.0.3.31:8012 \
11562 (www/HTTP)
11563
11564 Field Format Extract from the example above
11565 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14385]:
11566 2 'Connect from' Connect from
11567 3 source_ip ':' source_port 10.0.1.2:33312
11568 4 'to' to
11569 5 destination_ip ':' destination_port 10.0.3.31:8012
11570 6 '(' frontend_name '/' mode ')' (www/HTTP)
11571
11572Detailed fields description :
11573 - "source_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the connection.
11574 - "source_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
11575 - "destination_ip" is the IP address the client connected to.
11576 - "destination_port" is the TCP port the client connected to.
11577 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
11578 and processed the connection.
11579 - "mode is the mode the frontend is operating (TCP or HTTP).
11580
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010011581In case of a UNIX socket, the source and destination addresses are marked as
11582"unix:" and the ports reflect the internal ID of the socket which accepted the
11583connection (the same ID as reported in the stats).
11584
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011585It is advised not to use this deprecated format for newer installations as it
11586will eventually disappear.
11587
11588
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200115898.2.2. TCP log format
11590---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011591
11592The TCP format is used when "option tcplog" is specified in the frontend, and
11593is the recommended format for pure TCP proxies. It provides a lot of precious
11594information for troubleshooting. Since this format includes timers and byte
11595counts, the log is normally emitted at the end of the session. It can be
11596emitted earlier if "option logasap" is specified, which makes sense in most
11597environments with long sessions such as remote terminals. Sessions which match
11598the "monitor" rules are never logged. It is also possible not to emit logs for
11599sessions for which no data were exchanged between the client and the server, by
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020011600specifying "option dontlognull" in the frontend. Successful connections will
11601not be logged if "option dontlog-normal" is specified in the frontend. A few
11602fields may slightly vary depending on some configuration options, those are
11603marked with a star ('*') after the field name below.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011604
11605 Example :
11606 frontend fnt
11607 mode tcp
11608 option tcplog
11609 log global
11610 default_backend bck
11611
11612 backend bck
11613 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
11614
11615 >>> Feb 6 12:12:56 localhost \
11616 haproxy[14387]: 10.0.1.2:33313 [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443] fnt \
11617 bck/srv1 0/0/5007 212 -- 0/0/0/0/3 0/0
11618
11619 Field Format Extract from the example above
11620 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14387]:
11621 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33313
11622 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443]
11623 4 frontend_name fnt
11624 5 backend_name '/' server_name bck/srv1
11625 6 Tw '/' Tc '/' Tt* 0/0/5007
11626 7 bytes_read* 212
11627 8 termination_state --
11628 9 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 0/0/0/0/3
11629 10 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
11630
11631Detailed fields description :
11632 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010011633 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
11634 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
11635 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
11636 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, then the logs will reflect the
11637 forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011638
11639 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010011640 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
11641 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
11642 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011643
11644 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the connection was received by haproxy
11645 (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on the
11646 network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is usually
11647 the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log.
11648
11649 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
11650 and processed the connection.
11651
11652 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
11653 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
11654 frontend if no switching rule has been applied, which is common for TCP
11655 applications.
11656
11657 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
11658 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
11659 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
11660 which processed the request. If the connection was aborted before reaching
11661 a server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name.
11662
11663 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
11664 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
11665 See "Timers" below for more details.
11666
11667 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
11668 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
11669 connection was aborted before a connection could be established. See
11670 "Timers" below for more details.
11671
11672 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011673 last close. It covers all possible processing. There is one exception, if
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011674 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
11675 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
11676 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
11677 details.
11678
11679 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted from the server to
11680 the client when the log is emitted. If "option logasap" is specified, the
11681 this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that the final one
11682 may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit counter, so log
11683 analysis tools must be able to handle it without overflowing.
11684
11685 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
11686 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
11687 session to happen, and for what reason (timeout, error, ...). The normal
11688 flags should be "--", indicating the session was closed by either end with
11689 no data remaining in buffers. See below "Session state at disconnection"
11690 for more details.
11691
11692 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040011693 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011694 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 when
11695 multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system limits
11696 the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all of them
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011697 are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the system.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011698
11699 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
11700 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
11701 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
11702 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
11703 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
11704 caused by a denial of service attack.
11705
11706 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
11707 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
11708 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
11709 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
11710 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
11711 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
11712 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
11713 denial of service attack.
11714
11715 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
11716 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
11717 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
11718 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
11719 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
11720 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
11721 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
11722 that this server has some trouble causing the connections to take longer to
11723 be processed than on other servers.
11724
11725 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
11726 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
11727 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
11728 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
11729 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
11730 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
11731 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
11732 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
11733 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
11734 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
11735 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
11736 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
11737 should not be attributed to the logged server.
11738
11739 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
11740 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
11741 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
11742 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
11743 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
11744 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
11745 cumulated. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
11746 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
11747
11748 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
11749 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
11750 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
11751 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
11752 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
11753 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
11754 and then both positions will be cumulated. A request should not pass
11755 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
11756 occurs.
11757
11758
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200117598.2.3. HTTP log format
11760----------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011761
11762The HTTP format is the most complete and the best suited for HTTP proxies. It
11763is enabled by when "option httplog" is specified in the frontend. It provides
11764the same level of information as the TCP format with additional features which
11765are specific to the HTTP protocol. Just like the TCP format, the log is usually
11766emitted at the end of the session, unless "option logasap" is specified, which
11767generally only makes sense for download sites. A session which matches the
11768"monitor" rules will never logged. It is also possible not to log sessions for
11769which no data were sent by the client by specifying "option dontlognull" in the
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020011770frontend. Successful connections will not be logged if "option dontlog-normal"
11771is specified in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011772
11773Most fields are shared with the TCP log, some being different. A few fields may
11774slightly vary depending on some configuration options. Those ones are marked
11775with a star ('*') after the field name below.
11776
11777 Example :
11778 frontend http-in
11779 mode http
11780 option httplog
11781 log global
11782 default_backend bck
11783
11784 backend static
11785 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
11786
11787 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
11788 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
11789 static/srv1 10/0/30/69/109 200 2750 - - ---- 1/1/1/1/0 0/0 {1wt.eu} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010011790 {} "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011791
11792 Field Format Extract from the example above
11793 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14389]:
11794 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33317
11795 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655]
11796 4 frontend_name http-in
11797 5 backend_name '/' server_name static/srv1
11798 6 Tq '/' Tw '/' Tc '/' Tr '/' Tt* 10/0/30/69/109
11799 7 status_code 200
11800 8 bytes_read* 2750
11801 9 captured_request_cookie -
11802 10 captured_response_cookie -
11803 11 termination_state ----
11804 12 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 1/1/1/1/0
11805 13 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
11806 14 '{' captured_request_headers* '}' {haproxy.1wt.eu}
11807 15 '{' captured_response_headers* '}' {}
11808 16 '"' http_request '"' "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010011809
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011810
11811Detailed fields description :
11812 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010011813 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
11814 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
11815 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
11816 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, then the logs will reflect the
11817 forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011818
11819 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010011820 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
11821 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
11822 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011823
11824 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the TCP connection was received by
11825 haproxy (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on
11826 the network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is
11827 usually the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log. This
11828 does not depend on the fact that the client has sent the request or not.
11829
11830 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
11831 and processed the connection.
11832
11833 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
11834 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
11835 frontend if no switching rule has been applied.
11836
11837 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
11838 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
11839 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
11840 which processed the request. If the request was aborted before reaching a
11841 server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name. If the request was
11842 intercepted by the stats subsystem, "<STATS>" is indicated instead.
11843
11844 - "Tq" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the client to send
11845 a full HTTP request, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the connection
11846 was aborted before a complete request could be received. It should always
11847 be very small because a request generally fits in one single packet. Large
11848 times here generally indicate network trouble between the client and
11849 haproxy. See "Timers" below for more details.
11850
11851 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
11852 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
11853 See "Timers" below for more details.
11854
11855 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
11856 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
11857 request was aborted before a connection could be established. See "Timers"
11858 below for more details.
11859
11860 - "Tr" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the server to send
11861 a full HTTP response, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the request was
11862 aborted before a complete response could be received. It generally matches
11863 the server's processing time for the request, though it may be altered by
11864 the amount of data sent by the client to the server. Large times here on
11865 "GET" requests generally indicate an overloaded server. See "Timers" below
11866 for more details.
11867
11868 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011869 last close. It covers all possible processing. There is one exception, if
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011870 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
11871 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
11872 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
11873 details.
11874
11875 - "status_code" is the HTTP status code returned to the client. This status
11876 is generally set by the server, but it might also be set by haproxy when
11877 the server cannot be reached or when its response is blocked by haproxy.
11878
11879 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted to the client when
11880 the log is emitted. This does include HTTP headers. If "option logasap" is
11881 specified, the this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that
11882 the final one may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit
11883 counter, so log analysis tools must be able to handle it without
11884 overflowing.
11885
11886 - "captured_request_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating that
11887 the client had this cookie in the request. The cookie name and its maximum
11888 length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend
11889 configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is not
11890 set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track session
11891 ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session crossing
11892 between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please consult
11893 the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
11894
11895 - "captured_response_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating
11896 that the server has returned a cookie with its response. The cookie name
11897 and its maximum length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the
11898 frontend configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is
11899 not set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track
11900 session ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session
11901 crossing between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please
11902 consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
11903
11904 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
11905 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
11906 session to happen, for what reason (timeout, error, ...), just like in TCP
11907 logs, and information about persistence operations on cookies in the last
11908 two characters. The normal flags should begin with "--", indicating the
11909 session was closed by either end with no data remaining in buffers. See
11910 below "Session state at disconnection" for more details.
11911
11912 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040011913 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011914 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 or 1024
11915 when multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system
11916 limits the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011917 of them are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010011918 system.
11919
11920 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
11921 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
11922 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
11923 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
11924 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
11925 caused by a denial of service attack.
11926
11927 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
11928 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
11929 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
11930 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
11931 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
11932 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
11933 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
11934 denial of service attack.
11935
11936 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
11937 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
11938 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
11939 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
11940 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
11941 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
11942 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
11943 that this server has some trouble causing the requests to take longer to be
11944 processed than on other servers.
11945
11946 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
11947 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
11948 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
11949 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
11950 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
11951 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
11952 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
11953 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
11954 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
11955 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
11956 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
11957 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
11958 should not be attributed to the logged server.
11959
11960 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
11961 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
11962 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
11963 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
11964 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
11965 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
11966 cumulated. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
11967 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
11968
11969 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
11970 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
11971 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
11972 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
11973 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
11974 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
11975 and then both positions will be cumulated. A request should not pass
11976 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
11977 occurs.
11978
11979 - "captured_request_headers" is a list of headers captured in the request due
11980 to the presence of the "capture request header" statement in the frontend.
11981 Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar
11982 ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear, causing a
11983 shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this field may
11984 contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser than when
11985 it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and
11986 cookies" below for more details.
11987
11988 - "captured_response_headers" is a list of headers captured in the response
11989 due to the presence of the "capture response header" statement in the
11990 frontend. Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a
11991 vertical bar ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear,
11992 causing a shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this
11993 field may contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser
11994 than when it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers
11995 and cookies" below for more details.
11996
11997 - "http_request" is the complete HTTP request line, including the method,
11998 request and HTTP version string. Non-printable characters are encoded (see
11999 below the section "Non-printable characters"). This is always the last
12000 field, and it is always delimited by quotes and is the only one which can
12001 contain quotes. If new fields are added to the log format, they will be
12002 added before this field. This field might be truncated if the request is
12003 huge and does not fit in the standard syslog buffer (1024 characters). This
12004 is the reason why this field must always remain the last one.
12005
12006
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200120078.2.4. Custom log format
12008------------------------
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010012009
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010012010The directive log-format allows you to customize the logs in http mode and tcp
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012011mode. It takes a string as argument.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010012012
12013HAproxy understands some log format variables. % precedes log format variables.
12014Variables can take arguments using braces ('{}'), and multiple arguments are
12015separated by commas within the braces. Flags may be added or removed by
12016prefixing them with a '+' or '-' sign.
12017
12018Special variable "%o" may be used to propagate its flags to all other
12019variables on the same format string. This is particularly handy with quoted
12020string formats ("Q").
12021
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010012022If a variable is named between square brackets ('[' .. ']') then it is used
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012023as a pattern extraction rule (see section 7.3). This it useful to add some
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010012024less common information such as the client's SSL certificate's DN, or to log
12025the key that would be used to store an entry into a stick table.
12026
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010012027Note: spaces must be escaped. A space character is considered as a separator.
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012028In order to emit a verbatim '%', it must be preceded by another '%' resulting
Willy Tarreau06d97f92013-12-02 17:45:48 +010012029in '%%'. HAProxy will automatically merge consecutive separators.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010012030
12031Flags are :
12032 * Q: quote a string
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040012033 * X: hexadecimal representation (IPs, Ports, %Ts, %rt, %pid)
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010012034
12035 Example:
12036
12037 log-format %T\ %t\ Some\ Text
12038 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
12039
12040At the moment, the default HTTP format is defined this way :
12041
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010012042 log-format %ci:%cp\ [%t]\ %ft\ %b/%s\ %Tq/%Tw/%Tc/%Tr/%Tt\ %ST\ %B\ %CC\ \
12043 %CS\ %tsc\ %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc\ %sq/%bq\ %hr\ %hs\ %{+Q}r
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010012044
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012045the default CLF format is defined this way :
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010012046
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010012047 log-format %{+Q}o\ %{-Q}ci\ -\ -\ [%T]\ %r\ %ST\ %B\ \"\"\ \"\"\ %cp\ \
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020012048 %ms\ %ft\ %b\ %s\ \%Tq\ %Tw\ %Tc\ %Tr\ %Tt\ %tsc\ %ac\ %fc\ \
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010012049 %bc\ %sc\ %rc\ %sq\ %bq\ %CC\ %CS\ \%hrl\ %hsl
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010012050
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012051and the default TCP format is defined this way :
12052
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010012053 log-format %ci:%cp\ [%t]\ %ft\ %b/%s\ %Tw/%Tc/%Tt\ %B\ %ts\ \
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012054 %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc\ %sq/%bq
12055
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010012056Please refer to the table below for currently defined variables :
12057
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012058 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020012059 | R | var | field name (8.2.2 and 8.2.3 for description) | type |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012060 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
12061 | | %o | special variable, apply flags on all next var | |
12062 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010012063 | | %B | bytes_read (from server to client) | numeric |
12064 | H | %CC | captured_request_cookie | string |
12065 | H | %CS | captured_response_cookie | string |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020012066 | | %H | hostname | string |
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010012067 | | %ID | unique-id | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010012068 | H | %ST | status_code | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020012069 | | %T | gmt_date_time | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012070 | | %Tc | Tc | numeric |
Yuxans Yao4e25b012012-10-19 10:36:09 +080012071 | | %Tl | local_date_time | date |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020012072 | H | %Tq | Tq | numeric |
12073 | H | %Tr | Tr | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020012074 | | %Ts | timestamp | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012075 | | %Tt | Tt | numeric |
12076 | | %Tw | Tw | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010012077 | | %U | bytes_uploaded (from client to server) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012078 | | %ac | actconn | numeric |
12079 | | %b | backend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010012080 | | %bc | beconn (backend concurrent connections) | numeric |
12081 | | %bi | backend_source_ip (connecting address) | IP |
12082 | | %bp | backend_source_port (connecting address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012083 | | %bq | backend_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010012084 | | %ci | client_ip (accepted address) | IP |
12085 | | %cp | client_port (accepted address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012086 | | %f | frontend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010012087 | | %fc | feconn (frontend concurrent connections) | numeric |
12088 | | %fi | frontend_ip (accepting address) | IP |
12089 | | %fp | frontend_port (accepting address) | numeric |
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020012090 | | %ft | frontend_name_transport ('~' suffix for SSL) | string |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020012091 | H | %hr | captured_request_headers default style | string |
12092 | H | %hrl | captured_request_headers CLF style | string list |
12093 | H | %hs | captured_response_headers default style | string |
12094 | H | %hsl | captured_response_headers CLF style | string list |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012095 | | %ms | accept date milliseconds | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020012096 | | %pid | PID | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020012097 | H | %r | http_request | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012098 | | %rc | retries | numeric |
Willy Tarreau1f0da242014-01-25 11:01:50 +010012099 | | %rt | request_counter (HTTP req or TCP session) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012100 | | %s | server_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010012101 | | %sc | srv_conn (server concurrent connections) | numeric |
12102 | | %si | server_IP (target address) | IP |
12103 | | %sp | server_port (target address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012104 | | %sq | srv_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020012105 | S | %sslc| ssl_ciphers (ex: AES-SHA) | string |
12106 | S | %sslv| ssl_version (ex: TLSv1) | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010012107 | | %t | date_time (with millisecond resolution) | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012108 | | %ts | termination_state | string |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020012109 | H | %tsc | termination_state with cookie status | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010012110 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010012111
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020012112 R = Restrictions : H = mode http only ; S = SSL only
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010012113
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010012114
121158.2.5. Error log format
12116-----------------------
12117
12118When an incoming connection fails due to an SSL handshake or an invalid PROXY
12119protocol header, haproxy will log the event using a shorter, fixed line format.
12120By default, logs are emitted at the LOG_INFO level, unless the option
12121"log-separate-errors" is set in the backend, in which case the LOG_ERR level
12122will be used. Connections on which no data are exchanged (eg: probes) are not
12123logged if the "dontlognull" option is set.
12124
12125The format looks like this :
12126
12127 >>> Dec 3 18:27:14 localhost \
12128 haproxy[6103]: 127.0.0.1:56059 [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380] frt/f1: \
12129 Connection error during SSL handshake
12130
12131 Field Format Extract from the example above
12132 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[6103]:
12133 2 client_ip ':' client_port 127.0.0.1:56059
12134 3 '[' accept_date ']' [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380]
12135 4 frontend_name "/" bind_name ":" frt/f1:
12136 5 message Connection error during SSL handshake
12137
12138These fields just provide minimal information to help debugging connection
12139failures.
12140
12141
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200121428.3. Advanced logging options
12143-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012144
12145Some advanced logging options are often looked for but are not easy to find out
12146just by looking at the various options. Here is an entry point for the few
12147options which can enable better logging. Please refer to the keywords reference
12148for more information about their usage.
12149
12150
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200121518.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
12152------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012153
12154It is quite common to have some monitoring tools perform health checks on
12155haproxy. Sometimes it will be a layer 3 load-balancer such as LVS or any
12156commercial load-balancer, and sometimes it will simply be a more complete
12157monitoring system such as Nagios. When the tests are very frequent, users often
12158ask how to disable logging for those checks. There are three possibilities :
12159
12160 - if connections come from everywhere and are just TCP probes, it is often
12161 desired to simply disable logging of connections without data exchange, by
12162 setting "option dontlognull" in the frontend. It also disables logging of
12163 port scans, which may or may not be desired.
12164
12165 - if the connection come from a known source network, use "monitor-net" to
12166 declare this network as monitoring only. Any host in this network will then
12167 only be able to perform health checks, and their requests will not be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012168 logged. This is generally appropriate to designate a list of equipment
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012169 such as other load-balancers.
12170
12171 - if the tests are performed on a known URI, use "monitor-uri" to declare
12172 this URI as dedicated to monitoring. Any host sending this request will
12173 only get the result of a health-check, and the request will not be logged.
12174
12175
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200121768.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
12177----------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012178
12179The problem with logging at end of connection is that you have no clue about
12180what is happening during very long sessions, such as remote terminal sessions
12181or large file downloads. This problem can be worked around by specifying
12182"option logasap" in the frontend. Haproxy will then log as soon as possible,
12183just before data transfer begins. This means that in case of TCP, it will still
12184log the connection status to the server, and in case of HTTP, it will log just
12185after processing the server headers. In this case, the number of bytes reported
12186is the number of header bytes sent to the client. In order to avoid confusion
12187with normal logs, the total time field and the number of bytes are prefixed
12188with a '+' sign which means that real numbers are certainly larger.
12189
12190
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200121918.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
12192------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020012193
12194Sometimes it is more convenient to separate normal traffic from errors logs,
12195for instance in order to ease error monitoring from log files. When the option
12196"log-separate-errors" is used, connections which experience errors, timeouts,
12197retries, redispatches or HTTP status codes 5xx will see their syslog level
12198raised from "info" to "err". This will help a syslog daemon store the log in
12199a separate file. It is very important to keep the errors in the normal traffic
12200file too, so that log ordering is not altered. You should also be careful if
12201you already have configured your syslog daemon to store all logs higher than
12202"notice" in an "admin" file, because the "err" level is higher than "notice".
12203
12204
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200122058.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
12206--------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020012207
12208Although this may sound strange at first, some large sites have to deal with
12209multiple thousands of logs per second and are experiencing difficulties keeping
12210them intact for a long time or detecting errors within them. If the option
12211"dontlog-normal" is set on the frontend, all normal connections will not be
12212logged. In this regard, a normal connection is defined as one without any
12213error, timeout, retry nor redispatch. In HTTP, the status code is checked too,
12214and a response with a status 5xx is not considered normal and will be logged
12215too. Of course, doing is is really discouraged as it will remove most of the
12216useful information from the logs. Do this only if you have no other
12217alternative.
12218
12219
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200122208.4. Timing events
12221------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012222
12223Timers provide a great help in troubleshooting network problems. All values are
12224reported in milliseconds (ms). These timers should be used in conjunction with
12225the session termination flags. In TCP mode with "option tcplog" set on the
12226frontend, 3 control points are reported under the form "Tw/Tc/Tt", and in HTTP
12227mode, 5 control points are reported under the form "Tq/Tw/Tc/Tr/Tt" :
12228
12229 - Tq: total time to get the client request (HTTP mode only). It's the time
12230 elapsed between the moment the client connection was accepted and the
12231 moment the proxy received the last HTTP header. The value "-1" indicates
12232 that the end of headers (empty line) has never been seen. This happens when
12233 the client closes prematurely or times out.
12234
12235 - Tw: total time spent in the queues waiting for a connection slot. It
12236 accounts for backend queue as well as the server queues, and depends on the
12237 queue size, and the time needed for the server to complete previous
12238 requests. The value "-1" means that the request was killed before reaching
12239 the queue, which is generally what happens with invalid or denied requests.
12240
12241 - Tc: total time to establish the TCP connection to the server. It's the time
12242 elapsed between the moment the proxy sent the connection request, and the
12243 moment it was acknowledged by the server, or between the TCP SYN packet and
12244 the matching SYN/ACK packet in return. The value "-1" means that the
12245 connection never established.
12246
12247 - Tr: server response time (HTTP mode only). It's the time elapsed between
12248 the moment the TCP connection was established to the server and the moment
12249 the server sent its complete response headers. It purely shows its request
12250 processing time, without the network overhead due to the data transmission.
12251 It is worth noting that when the client has data to send to the server, for
12252 instance during a POST request, the time already runs, and this can distort
12253 apparent response time. For this reason, it's generally wise not to trust
12254 too much this field for POST requests initiated from clients behind an
12255 untrusted network. A value of "-1" here means that the last the response
12256 header (empty line) was never seen, most likely because the server timeout
12257 stroke before the server managed to process the request.
12258
12259 - Tt: total session duration time, between the moment the proxy accepted it
12260 and the moment both ends were closed. The exception is when the "logasap"
12261 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Tq+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is
12262 prefixed with a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012263 transmission time, by subtracting other timers when valid :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012264
12265 Td = Tt - (Tq + Tw + Tc + Tr)
12266
12267 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. In TCP
12268 mode, "Tq" and "Tr" have to be excluded too. Note that "Tt" can never be
12269 negative.
12270
12271These timers provide precious indications on trouble causes. Since the TCP
12272protocol defines retransmit delays of 3, 6, 12... seconds, we know for sure
12273that timers close to multiples of 3s are nearly always related to lost packets
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012274due to network problems (wires, negotiation, congestion). Moreover, if "Tt" is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012275close to a timeout value specified in the configuration, it often means that a
12276session has been aborted on timeout.
12277
12278Most common cases :
12279
12280 - If "Tq" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
12281 client and the proxy. This is very rare on local networks but might happen
12282 when clients are on far remote networks and send large requests. It may
12283 happen that values larger than usual appear here without any network cause.
12284 Sometimes, during an attack or just after a resource starvation has ended,
12285 haproxy may accept thousands of connections in a few milliseconds. The time
12286 spent accepting these connections will inevitably slightly delay processing
12287 of other connections, and it can happen that request times in the order of
12288 a few tens of milliseconds are measured after a few thousands of new
Patrick Mezard105faca2010-06-12 17:02:46 +020012289 connections have been accepted at once. Setting "option http-server-close"
12290 may display larger request times since "Tq" also measures the time spent
12291 waiting for additional requests.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012292
12293 - If "Tc" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
12294 server and the proxy during the server connection phase. This value should
12295 always be very low, such as 1 ms on local networks and less than a few tens
12296 of ms on remote networks.
12297
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020012298 - If "Tr" is nearly always lower than 3000 except some rare values which seem
12299 to be the average majored by 3000, there are probably some packets lost
12300 between the proxy and the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012301
12302 - If "Tt" is large even for small byte counts, it generally is because
12303 neither the client nor the server decides to close the connection, for
12304 instance because both have agreed on a keep-alive connection mode. In order
12305 to solve this issue, it will be needed to specify "option httpclose" on
12306 either the frontend or the backend. If the problem persists, it means that
12307 the server ignores the "close" connection mode and expects the client to
12308 close. Then it will be required to use "option forceclose". Having the
12309 smallest possible 'Tt' is important when connection regulation is used with
12310 the "maxconn" option on the servers, since no new connection will be sent
12311 to the server until another one is released.
12312
12313Other noticeable HTTP log cases ('xx' means any value to be ignored) :
12314
12315 Tq/Tw/Tc/Tr/+Tt The "option logasap" is present on the frontend and the log
12316 was emitted before the data phase. All the timers are valid
12317 except "Tt" which is shorter than reality.
12318
12319 -1/xx/xx/xx/Tt The client was not able to send a complete request in time
12320 or it aborted too early. Check the session termination flags
12321 then "timeout http-request" and "timeout client" settings.
12322
12323 Tq/-1/xx/xx/Tt It was not possible to process the request, maybe because
12324 servers were out of order, because the request was invalid
12325 or forbidden by ACL rules. Check the session termination
12326 flags.
12327
12328 Tq/Tw/-1/xx/Tt The connection could not establish on the server. Either it
12329 actively refused it or it timed out after Tt-(Tq+Tw) ms.
12330 Check the session termination flags, then check the
12331 "timeout connect" setting. Note that the tarpit action might
12332 return similar-looking patterns, with "Tw" equal to the time
12333 the client connection was maintained open.
12334
12335 Tq/Tw/Tc/-1/Tt The server has accepted the connection but did not return
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012336 a complete response in time, or it closed its connection
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012337 unexpectedly after Tt-(Tq+Tw+Tc) ms. Check the session
12338 termination flags, then check the "timeout server" setting.
12339
12340
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200123418.5. Session state at disconnection
12342-----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012343
12344TCP and HTTP logs provide a session termination indicator in the
12345"termination_state" field, just before the number of active connections. It is
123462-characters long in TCP mode, and is extended to 4 characters in HTTP mode,
12347each of which has a special meaning :
12348
12349 - On the first character, a code reporting the first event which caused the
12350 session to terminate :
12351
12352 C : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the client.
12353
12354 S : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the server, or the
12355 server explicitly refused it.
12356
12357 P : the session was prematurely aborted by the proxy, because of a
12358 connection limit enforcement, because a DENY filter was matched,
12359 because of a security check which detected and blocked a dangerous
12360 error in server response which might have caused information leak
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020012361 (eg: cacheable cookie).
12362
12363 L : the session was locally processed by haproxy and was not passed to
12364 a server. This is what happens for stats and redirects.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012365
12366 R : a resource on the proxy has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source
12367 ports, ...). Usually, this appears during the connection phase, and
12368 system logs should contain a copy of the precise error. If this
12369 happens, it must be considered as a very serious anomaly which
12370 should be fixed as soon as possible by any means.
12371
12372 I : an internal error was identified by the proxy during a self-check.
12373 This should NEVER happen, and you are encouraged to report any log
12374 containing this, because this would almost certainly be a bug. It
12375 would be wise to preventively restart the process after such an
12376 event too, in case it would be caused by memory corruption.
12377
Simon Horman752dc4a2011-06-21 14:34:59 +090012378 D : the session was killed by haproxy because the server was detected
12379 as down and was configured to kill all connections when going down.
12380
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070012381 U : the session was killed by haproxy on this backup server because an
12382 active server was detected as up and was configured to kill all
12383 backup connections when going up.
12384
Willy Tarreaua2a64e92011-09-07 23:01:56 +020012385 K : the session was actively killed by an admin operating on haproxy.
12386
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012387 c : the client-side timeout expired while waiting for the client to
12388 send or receive data.
12389
12390 s : the server-side timeout expired while waiting for the server to
12391 send or receive data.
12392
12393 - : normal session completion, both the client and the server closed
12394 with nothing left in the buffers.
12395
12396 - on the second character, the TCP or HTTP session state when it was closed :
12397
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +010012398 R : the proxy was waiting for a complete, valid REQUEST from the client
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012399 (HTTP mode only). Nothing was sent to any server.
12400
12401 Q : the proxy was waiting in the QUEUE for a connection slot. This can
12402 only happen when servers have a 'maxconn' parameter set. It can
12403 also happen in the global queue after a redispatch consecutive to
12404 a failed attempt to connect to a dying server. If no redispatch is
12405 reported, then no connection attempt was made to any server.
12406
12407 C : the proxy was waiting for the CONNECTION to establish on the
12408 server. The server might at most have noticed a connection attempt.
12409
12410 H : the proxy was waiting for complete, valid response HEADERS from the
12411 server (HTTP only).
12412
12413 D : the session was in the DATA phase.
12414
12415 L : the proxy was still transmitting LAST data to the client while the
12416 server had already finished. This one is very rare as it can only
12417 happen when the client dies while receiving the last packets.
12418
12419 T : the request was tarpitted. It has been held open with the client
12420 during the whole "timeout tarpit" duration or until the client
12421 closed, both of which will be reported in the "Tw" timer.
12422
12423 - : normal session completion after end of data transfer.
12424
12425 - the third character tells whether the persistence cookie was provided by
12426 the client (only in HTTP mode) :
12427
12428 N : the client provided NO cookie. This is usually the case for new
12429 visitors, so counting the number of occurrences of this flag in the
12430 logs generally indicate a valid trend for the site frequentation.
12431
12432 I : the client provided an INVALID cookie matching no known server.
12433 This might be caused by a recent configuration change, mixed
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +020012434 cookies between HTTP/HTTPS sites, persistence conditionally
12435 ignored, or an attack.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012436
12437 D : the client provided a cookie designating a server which was DOWN,
12438 so either "option persist" was used and the client was sent to
12439 this server, or it was not set and the client was redispatched to
12440 another server.
12441
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020012442 V : the client provided a VALID cookie, and was sent to the associated
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012443 server.
12444
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020012445 E : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a last date which was
12446 older than what is allowed by the "maxidle" cookie parameter, so
12447 the cookie is consider EXPIRED and is ignored. The request will be
12448 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
12449
12450 O : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a first date which was
12451 older than what is allowed by the "maxlife" cookie parameter, so
12452 the cookie is consider too OLD and is ignored. The request will be
12453 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
12454
Willy Tarreauc89ccb62012-04-05 21:18:22 +020012455 U : a cookie was present but was not used to select the server because
12456 some other server selection mechanism was used instead (typically a
12457 "use-server" rule).
12458
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012459 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
12460
12461 - the last character reports what operations were performed on the persistence
12462 cookie returned by the server (only in HTTP mode) :
12463
12464 N : NO cookie was provided by the server, and none was inserted either.
12465
12466 I : no cookie was provided by the server, and the proxy INSERTED one.
12467 Note that in "cookie insert" mode, if the server provides a cookie,
12468 it will still be overwritten and reported as "I" here.
12469
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020012470 U : the proxy UPDATED the last date in the cookie that was presented by
12471 the client. This can only happen in insert mode with "maxidle". It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012472 happens every time there is activity at a different date than the
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020012473 date indicated in the cookie. If any other change happens, such as
12474 a redispatch, then the cookie will be marked as inserted instead.
12475
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012476 P : a cookie was PROVIDED by the server and transmitted as-is.
12477
12478 R : the cookie provided by the server was REWRITTEN by the proxy, which
12479 happens in "cookie rewrite" or "cookie prefix" modes.
12480
12481 D : the cookie provided by the server was DELETED by the proxy.
12482
12483 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
12484
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020012485The combination of the two first flags gives a lot of information about what
12486was happening when the session terminated, and why it did terminate. It can be
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012487helpful to detect server saturation, network troubles, local system resource
12488starvation, attacks, etc...
12489
12490The most common termination flags combinations are indicated below. They are
12491alphabetically sorted, with the lowercase set just after the upper case for
12492easier finding and understanding.
12493
12494 Flags Reason
12495
12496 -- Normal termination.
12497
12498 CC The client aborted before the connection could be established to the
12499 server. This can happen when haproxy tries to connect to a recently
12500 dead (or unchecked) server, and the client aborts while haproxy is
12501 waiting for the server to respond or for "timeout connect" to expire.
12502
12503 CD The client unexpectedly aborted during data transfer. This can be
12504 caused by a browser crash, by an intermediate equipment between the
12505 client and haproxy which decided to actively break the connection,
12506 by network routing issues between the client and haproxy, or by a
12507 keep-alive session between the server and the client terminated first
12508 by the client.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012509
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012510 cD The client did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
12511 "timeout client" delay. This is often caused by network failures on
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020012512 the client side, or the client simply leaving the net uncleanly.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012513
12514 CH The client aborted while waiting for the server to start responding.
12515 It might be the server taking too long to respond or the client
12516 clicking the 'Stop' button too fast.
12517
12518 cH The "timeout client" stroke while waiting for client data during a
12519 POST request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values
12520 for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized packets. It can
12521 also happen when client timeout is smaller than server timeout and
12522 the server takes too long to respond.
12523
12524 CQ The client aborted while its session was queued, waiting for a server
12525 with enough empty slots to accept it. It might be that either all the
12526 servers were saturated or that the assigned server was taking too
12527 long a time to respond.
12528
12529 CR The client aborted before sending a full HTTP request. Most likely
12530 the request was typed by hand using a telnet client, and aborted
12531 too early. The HTTP status code is likely a 400 here. Sometimes this
12532 might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection between haproxy
12533 and the client.
12534
12535 cR The "timeout http-request" stroke before the client sent a full HTTP
12536 request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values on the
12537 client side for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized
12538 packets, or by clients sending requests by hand and not typing fast
12539 enough, or forgetting to enter the empty line at the end of the
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020012540 request. The HTTP status code is likely a 408 here. Note: recently,
12541 some browsers such as Google Chrome started to break the deployed Web
12542 infrastructure by aggressively implementing a new "pre-connect"
12543 feature, consisting in sending connections to sites recently visited
12544 without sending any request on them until the user starts to browse
12545 the site. This mechanism causes massive disruption among resource-
12546 limited servers, and causes a lot of 408 errors in HAProxy logs.
12547 Worse, some people report that sometimes the browser displays the 408
12548 error when the user expects to see the actual content (Mozilla fixed
12549 this bug in 2004, while Chrome users continue to report it in 2014),
12550 so in this case, using "errorfile 408 /dev/null" can be used as a
12551 workaround. More information on the subject is available here :
12552 https://bugzilla.mozilla.org/show_bug.cgi?id=248827
12553 https://code.google.com/p/chromium/issues/detail?id=85229
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012554
12555 CT The client aborted while its session was tarpitted. It is important to
12556 check if this happens on valid requests, in order to be sure that no
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020012557 wrong tarpit rules have been written. If a lot of them happen, it
12558 might make sense to lower the "timeout tarpit" value to something
12559 closer to the average reported "Tw" timer, in order not to consume
12560 resources for just a few attackers.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012561
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020012562 LR The request was intercepted and locally handled by haproxy. Generally
12563 it means that this was a redirect or a stats request.
12564
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012565 SC The server or an equipment between it and haproxy explicitly refused
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012566 the TCP connection (the proxy received a TCP RST or an ICMP message
12567 in return). Under some circumstances, it can also be the network
12568 stack telling the proxy that the server is unreachable (eg: no route,
12569 or no ARP response on local network). When this happens in HTTP mode,
12570 the status code is likely a 502 or 503 here.
12571
12572 sC The "timeout connect" stroke before a connection to the server could
12573 complete. When this happens in HTTP mode, the status code is likely a
12574 503 or 504 here.
12575
12576 SD The connection to the server died with an error during the data
12577 transfer. This usually means that haproxy has received an RST from
12578 the server or an ICMP message from an intermediate equipment while
12579 exchanging data with the server. This can be caused by a server crash
12580 or by a network issue on an intermediate equipment.
12581
12582 sD The server did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
12583 "timeout server" setting during the data phase. This is often caused
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012584 by too short timeouts on L4 equipments before the server (firewalls,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012585 load-balancers, ...), as well as keep-alive sessions maintained
12586 between the client and the server expiring first on haproxy.
12587
12588 SH The server aborted before sending its full HTTP response headers, or
12589 it crashed while processing the request. Since a server aborting at
12590 this moment is very rare, it would be wise to inspect its logs to
12591 control whether it crashed and why. The logged request may indicate a
12592 small set of faulty requests, demonstrating bugs in the application.
12593 Sometimes this might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection
12594 between haproxy and the server.
12595
12596 sH The "timeout server" stroke before the server could return its
12597 response headers. This is the most common anomaly, indicating too
12598 long transactions, probably caused by server or database saturation.
12599 The immediate workaround consists in increasing the "timeout server"
12600 setting, but it is important to keep in mind that the user experience
12601 will suffer from these long response times. The only long term
12602 solution is to fix the application.
12603
12604 sQ The session spent too much time in queue and has been expired. See
12605 the "timeout queue" and "timeout connect" settings to find out how to
12606 fix this if it happens too often. If it often happens massively in
12607 short periods, it may indicate general problems on the affected
12608 servers due to I/O or database congestion, or saturation caused by
12609 external attacks.
12610
12611 PC The proxy refused to establish a connection to the server because the
12612 process' socket limit has been reached while attempting to connect.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020012613 The global "maxconn" parameter may be increased in the configuration
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012614 so that it does not happen anymore. This status is very rare and
12615 might happen when the global "ulimit-n" parameter is forced by hand.
12616
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010012617 PD The proxy blocked an incorrectly formatted chunked encoded message in
12618 a request or a response, after the server has emitted its headers. In
12619 most cases, this will indicate an invalid message from the server to
Willy Tarreauf3a3e132013-08-31 08:16:26 +020012620 the client. Haproxy supports chunk sizes of up to 2GB - 1 (2147483647
12621 bytes). Any larger size will be considered as an error.
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010012622
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012623 PH The proxy blocked the server's response, because it was invalid,
12624 incomplete, dangerous (cache control), or matched a security filter.
12625 In any case, an HTTP 502 error is sent to the client. One possible
12626 cause for this error is an invalid syntax in an HTTP header name
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010012627 containing unauthorized characters. It is also possible but quite
12628 rare, that the proxy blocked a chunked-encoding request from the
12629 client due to an invalid syntax, before the server responded. In this
12630 case, an HTTP 400 error is sent to the client and reported in the
12631 logs.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012632
12633 PR The proxy blocked the client's HTTP request, either because of an
12634 invalid HTTP syntax, in which case it returned an HTTP 400 error to
12635 the client, or because a deny filter matched, in which case it
12636 returned an HTTP 403 error.
12637
12638 PT The proxy blocked the client's request and has tarpitted its
12639 connection before returning it a 500 server error. Nothing was sent
12640 to the server. The connection was maintained open for as long as
12641 reported by the "Tw" timer field.
12642
12643 RC A local resource has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source ports)
12644 preventing the connection to the server from establishing. The error
12645 logs will tell precisely what was missing. This is very rare and can
12646 only be solved by proper system tuning.
12647
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020012648The combination of the two last flags gives a lot of information about how
12649persistence was handled by the client, the server and by haproxy. This is very
12650important to troubleshoot disconnections, when users complain they have to
12651re-authenticate. The commonly encountered flags are :
12652
12653 -- Persistence cookie is not enabled.
12654
12655 NN No cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
12656 response. For instance, this can be in insert mode with "postonly"
12657 set on a GET request.
12658
12659 II A cookie designating an invalid server was provided by the client,
12660 a valid one was inserted in the response. This typically happens when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040012661 a "server" entry is removed from the configuration, since its cookie
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020012662 value can be presented by a client when no other server knows it.
12663
12664 NI No cookie was provided by the client, one was inserted in the
12665 response. This typically happens for first requests from every user
12666 in "insert" mode, which makes it an easy way to count real users.
12667
12668 VN A cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
12669 response. This happens for most responses for which the client has
12670 already got a cookie.
12671
12672 VU A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
12673 not completely up-to-date, so an updated cookie was provided in
12674 response. This can also happen if there was no date at all, or if
12675 there was a date but the "maxidle" parameter was not set, so that the
12676 cookie can be switched to unlimited time.
12677
12678 EI A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
12679 too old for the "maxidle" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
12680 new cookie was inserted in the response.
12681
12682 OI A cookie was provided by the client, with a first visit date which is
12683 too old for the "maxlife" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
12684 new cookie was inserted in the response.
12685
12686 DI The server designated by the cookie was down, a new server was
12687 selected and a new cookie was emitted in the response.
12688
12689 VI The server designated by the cookie was not marked dead but could not
12690 be reached. A redispatch happened and selected another one, which was
12691 then advertised in the response.
12692
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012693
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200126948.6. Non-printable characters
12695-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012696
12697In order not to cause trouble to log analysis tools or terminals during log
12698consulting, non-printable characters are not sent as-is into log files, but are
12699converted to the two-digits hexadecimal representation of their ASCII code,
12700prefixed by the character '#'. The only characters that can be logged without
12701being escaped are comprised between 32 and 126 (inclusive). Obviously, the
12702escape character '#' itself is also encoded to avoid any ambiguity ("#23"). It
12703is the same for the character '"' which becomes "#22", as well as '{', '|' and
12704'}' when logging headers.
12705
12706Note that the space character (' ') is not encoded in headers, which can cause
12707issues for tools relying on space count to locate fields. A typical header
12708containing spaces is "User-Agent".
12709
12710Last, it has been observed that some syslog daemons such as syslog-ng escape
12711the quote ('"') with a backslash ('\'). The reverse operation can safely be
12712performed since no quote may appear anywhere else in the logs.
12713
12714
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200127158.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
12716---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012717
12718Cookie capture simplifies the tracking a complete user session. This can be
12719achieved using the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend. Please refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012720section 4.2 for more details. Only one cookie can be captured, and the same
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012721cookie will simultaneously be checked in the request ("Cookie:" header) and in
12722the response ("Set-Cookie:" header). The respective values will be reported in
12723the HTTP logs at the "captured_request_cookie" and "captured_response_cookie"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012724locations (see section 8.2.3 about HTTP log format). When either cookie is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012725not seen, a dash ('-') replaces the value. This way, it's easy to detect when a
12726user switches to a new session for example, because the server will reassign it
12727a new cookie. It is also possible to detect if a server unexpectedly sets a
12728wrong cookie to a client, leading to session crossing.
12729
12730 Examples :
12731 # capture the first cookie whose name starts with "ASPSESSION"
12732 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
12733
12734 # capture the first cookie whose name is exactly "vgnvisitor"
12735 capture cookie vgnvisitor= len 32
12736
12737
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200127388.8. Capturing HTTP headers
12739---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012740
12741Header captures are useful to track unique request identifiers set by an upper
12742proxy, virtual host names, user-agents, POST content-length, referrers, etc. In
12743the response, one can search for information about the response length, how the
12744server asked the cache to behave, or an object location during a redirection.
12745
12746Header captures are performed using the "capture request header" and "capture
12747response header" statements in the frontend. Please consult their definition in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012748section 4.2 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012749
12750It is possible to include both request headers and response headers at the same
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012751time. Non-existent headers are logged as empty strings, and if one header
12752appears more than once, only its last occurrence will be logged. Request headers
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012753are grouped within braces '{' and '}' in the same order as they were declared,
12754and delimited with a vertical bar '|' without any space. Response headers
12755follow the same representation, but are displayed after a space following the
12756request headers block. These blocks are displayed just before the HTTP request
12757in the logs.
12758
12759 Example :
12760 # This instance chains to the outgoing proxy
12761 listen proxy-out
12762 mode http
12763 option httplog
12764 option logasap
12765 log global
12766 server cache1 192.168.1.1:3128
12767
12768 # log the name of the virtual server
12769 capture request header Host len 20
12770
12771 # log the amount of data uploaded during a POST
12772 capture request header Content-Length len 10
12773
12774 # log the beginning of the referrer
12775 capture request header Referer len 20
12776
12777 # server name (useful for outgoing proxies only)
12778 capture response header Server len 20
12779
12780 # logging the content-length is useful with "option logasap"
12781 capture response header Content-Length len 10
12782
12783 # log the expected cache behaviour on the response
12784 capture response header Cache-Control len 8
12785
12786 # the Via header will report the next proxy's name
12787 capture response header Via len 20
12788
12789 # log the URL location during a redirection
12790 capture response header Location len 20
12791
12792 >>> Aug 9 20:26:09 localhost \
12793 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34014 [09/Aug/2004:20:26:09] proxy-out \
12794 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/162/+162 200 +350 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
12795 {fr.adserver.yahoo.co||http://fr.f416.mail.} {|864|private||} \
12796 "GET http://fr.adserver.yahoo.com/"
12797
12798 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
12799 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34020 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
12800 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/182/+182 200 +279 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
12801 {w.ods.org||} {Formilux/0.1.8|3495|||} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012802 "GET http://trafic.1wt.eu/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012803
12804 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
12805 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34028 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
12806 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/2/126/+128 301 +223 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
12807 {www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr||http://trafic.1wt.eu/} \
12808 {Apache|230|||http://www.sytadin.} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012809 "GET http://www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012810
12811
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200128128.9. Examples of logs
12813---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012814
12815These are real-world examples of logs accompanied with an explanation. Some of
12816them have been made up by hand. The syslog part has been removed for better
12817reading. Their sole purpose is to explain how to decipher them.
12818
12819 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33318 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.130] px-http \
12820 px-http/srv1 6559/0/7/147/6723 200 243 - - ---- 5/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
12821 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
12822
12823 => long request (6.5s) entered by hand through 'telnet'. The server replied
12824 in 147 ms, and the session ended normally ('----')
12825
12826 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33319 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.149] px-http \
12827 px-http/srv1 6559/1230/7/147/6870 200 243 - - ---- 324/239/239/99/0 \
12828 0/9 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
12829
12830 => Idem, but the request was queued in the global queue behind 9 other
12831 requests, and waited there for 1230 ms.
12832
12833 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.654] px-http \
12834 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
12835 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
12836
12837 => request for a long data transfer. The "logasap" option was specified, so
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012838 the log was produced just before transferring data. The server replied in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012839 14 ms, 243 bytes of headers were sent to the client, and total time from
12840 accept to first data byte is 30 ms.
12841
12842 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.925] px-http \
12843 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/30 502 243 - - PH-- 3/2/2/0/0 0/0 \
12844 "GET /cgi-bin/bug.cgi? HTTP/1.0"
12845
12846 => the proxy blocked a server response either because of an "rspdeny" or
12847 "rspideny" filter, or because the response was improperly formatted and
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +020012848 not HTTP-compliant, or because it blocked sensitive information which
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012849 risked being cached. In this case, the response is replaced with a "502
12850 bad gateway". The flags ("PH--") tell us that it was haproxy who decided
12851 to return the 502 and not the server.
12852
12853 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34548 [15/Oct/2003:15:18:55.798] px-http \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012854 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/8490 -1 0 - - CR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012855
12856 => the client never completed its request and aborted itself ("C---") after
12857 8.5s, while the proxy was waiting for the request headers ("-R--").
12858 Nothing was sent to any server.
12859
12860 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34549 [15/Oct/2003:15:19:06.103] px-http \
12861 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/50001 408 0 - - cR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
12862
12863 => The client never completed its request, which was aborted by the
12864 time-out ("c---") after 50s, while the proxy was waiting for the request
12865 headers ("-R--"). Nothing was sent to any server, but the proxy could
12866 send a 408 return code to the client.
12867
12868 >>> haproxy[18989]: 127.0.0.1:34550 [15/Oct/2003:15:24:28.312] px-tcp \
12869 px-tcp/srv1 0/0/5007 0 cD 0/0/0/0/0 0/0
12870
12871 => This log was produced with "option tcplog". The client timed out after
12872 5 seconds ("c----").
12873
12874 >>> haproxy[18989]: 10.0.0.1:34552 [15/Oct/2003:15:26:31.462] px-http \
12875 px-http/srv1 3183/-1/-1/-1/11215 503 0 - - SC-- 205/202/202/115/3 \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012876 0/0 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012877
12878 => The request took 3s to complete (probably a network problem), and the
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012879 connection to the server failed ('SC--') after 4 attempts of 2 seconds
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010012880 (config says 'retries 3'), and no redispatch (otherwise we would have
12881 seen "/+3"). Status code 503 was returned to the client. There were 115
12882 connections on this server, 202 connections on this proxy, and 205 on
12883 the global process. It is possible that the server refused the
12884 connection because of too many already established.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012885
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010012886
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200128879. Statistics and monitoring
12888----------------------------
12889
12890It is possible to query HAProxy about its status. The most commonly used
12891mechanism is the HTTP statistics page. This page also exposes an alternative
12892CSV output format for monitoring tools. The same format is provided on the
12893Unix socket.
12894
12895
128969.1. CSV format
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010012897---------------
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +010012898
Willy Tarreau7f062c42009-03-05 18:43:00 +010012899The statistics may be consulted either from the unix socket or from the HTTP
12900page. Both means provide a CSV format whose fields follow.
12901
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +010012902 0. pxname: proxy name
12903 1. svname: service name (FRONTEND for frontend, BACKEND for backend, any name
12904 for server)
12905 2. qcur: current queued requests
12906 3. qmax: max queued requests
12907 4. scur: current sessions
12908 5. smax: max sessions
12909 6. slim: sessions limit
12910 7. stot: total sessions
12911 8. bin: bytes in
12912 9. bout: bytes out
12913 10. dreq: denied requests
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +010012914 11. dresp: denied responses
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +010012915 12. ereq: request errors
12916 13. econ: connection errors
Willy Tarreauae526782010-03-04 20:34:23 +010012917 14. eresp: response errors (among which srv_abrt)
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +010012918 15. wretr: retries (warning)
12919 16. wredis: redispatches (warning)
Cyril Bonté0dae5852010-02-03 00:26:28 +010012920 17. status: status (UP/DOWN/NOLB/MAINT/MAINT(via)...)
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +010012921 18. weight: server weight (server), total weight (backend)
12922 19. act: server is active (server), number of active servers (backend)
12923 20. bck: server is backup (server), number of backup servers (backend)
12924 21. chkfail: number of failed checks
12925 22. chkdown: number of UP->DOWN transitions
12926 23. lastchg: last status change (in seconds)
12927 24. downtime: total downtime (in seconds)
12928 25. qlimit: queue limit
12929 26. pid: process id (0 for first instance, 1 for second, ...)
12930 27. iid: unique proxy id
12931 28. sid: service id (unique inside a proxy)
12932 29. throttle: warm up status
12933 30. lbtot: total number of times a server was selected
12934 31. tracked: id of proxy/server if tracking is enabled
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +020012935 32. type (0=frontend, 1=backend, 2=server, 3=socket)
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkidb57c6b2009-08-31 21:23:27 +020012936 33. rate: number of sessions per second over last elapsed second
12937 34. rate_lim: limit on new sessions per second
12938 35. rate_max: max number of new sessions per second
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki09605412009-09-23 22:09:24 +020012939 36. check_status: status of last health check, one of:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +010012940 UNK -> unknown
12941 INI -> initializing
12942 SOCKERR -> socket error
12943 L4OK -> check passed on layer 4, no upper layers testing enabled
12944 L4TMOUT -> layer 1-4 timeout
12945 L4CON -> layer 1-4 connection problem, for example
12946 "Connection refused" (tcp rst) or "No route to host" (icmp)
12947 L6OK -> check passed on layer 6
12948 L6TOUT -> layer 6 (SSL) timeout
12949 L6RSP -> layer 6 invalid response - protocol error
12950 L7OK -> check passed on layer 7
12951 L7OKC -> check conditionally passed on layer 7, for example 404 with
12952 disable-on-404
12953 L7TOUT -> layer 7 (HTTP/SMTP) timeout
12954 L7RSP -> layer 7 invalid response - protocol error
12955 L7STS -> layer 7 response error, for example HTTP 5xx
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki09605412009-09-23 22:09:24 +020012956 37. check_code: layer5-7 code, if available
12957 38. check_duration: time in ms took to finish last health check
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012958 39. hrsp_1xx: http responses with 1xx code
12959 40. hrsp_2xx: http responses with 2xx code
12960 41. hrsp_3xx: http responses with 3xx code
12961 42. hrsp_4xx: http responses with 4xx code
12962 43. hrsp_5xx: http responses with 5xx code
12963 44. hrsp_other: http responses with other codes (protocol error)
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012964 45. hanafail: failed health checks details
12965 46. req_rate: HTTP requests per second over last elapsed second
12966 47. req_rate_max: max number of HTTP requests per second observed
12967 48. req_tot: total number of HTTP requests received
Willy Tarreauae526782010-03-04 20:34:23 +010012968 49. cli_abrt: number of data transfers aborted by the client
12969 50. srv_abrt: number of data transfers aborted by the server (inc. in eresp)
Willy Tarreau55058a72012-11-21 08:27:21 +010012970 51. comp_in: number of HTTP response bytes fed to the compressor
12971 52. comp_out: number of HTTP response bytes emitted by the compressor
12972 53. comp_byp: number of bytes that bypassed the HTTP compressor (CPU/BW limit)
Willy Tarreau11d4ec82012-11-26 00:49:03 +010012973 54. comp_rsp: number of HTTP responses that were compressed
Willy Tarreauf522f3d2014-02-10 22:22:49 +010012974 55. lastsess: number of seconds since last session assigned to server/backend
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012975
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010012976
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200129779.2. Unix Socket commands
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010012978-------------------------
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +010012979
Willy Tarreau468f4932013-08-01 16:50:16 +020012980The stats socket is not enabled by default. In order to enable it, it is
12981necessary to add one line in the global section of the haproxy configuration.
12982A second line is recommended to set a larger timeout, always appreciated when
12983issuing commands by hand :
12984
12985 global
12986 stats socket /var/run/haproxy.sock mode 600 level admin
12987 stats timeout 2m
12988
12989It is also possible to add multiple instances of the stats socket by repeating
12990the line, and make them listen to a TCP port instead of a UNIX socket. This is
12991never done by default because this is dangerous, but can be handy in some
12992situations :
12993
12994 global
12995 stats socket /var/run/haproxy.sock mode 600 level admin
12996 stats socket ipv4@192.168.0.1:9999 level admin
12997 stats timeout 2m
12998
12999To access the socket, an external utility such as "socat" is required. Socat is a
13000swiss-army knife to connect anything to anything. We use it to connect terminals
13001to the socket, or a couple of stdin/stdout pipes to it for scripts. The two main
13002syntaxes we'll use are the following :
13003
13004 # socat /var/run/haproxy.sock stdio
13005 # socat /var/run/haproxy.sock readline
13006
13007The first one is used with scripts. It is possible to send the output of a
13008script to haproxy, and pass haproxy's output to another script. That's useful
13009for retrieving counters or attack traces for example.
13010
13011The second one is only useful for issuing commands by hand. It has the benefit
13012that the terminal is handled by the readline library which supports line
13013editing and history, which is very convenient when issuing repeated commands
13014(eg: watch a counter).
13015
13016The socket supports two operation modes :
13017 - interactive
13018 - non-interactive
13019
13020The non-interactive mode is the default when socat connects to the socket. In
13021this mode, a single line may be sent. It is processed as a whole, responses are
13022sent back, and the connection closes after the end of the response. This is the
13023mode that scripts and monitoring tools use. It is possible to send multiple
13024commands in this mode, they need to be delimited by a semi-colon (';'). For
13025example :
13026
13027 # echo "show info;show stat;show table" | socat /var/run/haproxy stdio
13028
13029The interactive mode displays a prompt ('>') and waits for commands to be
13030entered on the line, then processes them, and displays the prompt again to wait
13031for a new command. This mode is entered via the "prompt" command which must be
13032sent on the first line in non-interactive mode. The mode is a flip switch, if
13033"prompt" is sent in interactive mode, it is disabled and the connection closes
13034after processing the last command of the same line.
13035
13036For this reason, when debugging by hand, it's quite common to start with the
13037"prompt" command :
13038
13039 # socat /var/run/haproxy readline
13040 prompt
13041 > show info
13042 ...
13043 >
13044
13045Since multiple commands may be issued at once, haproxy uses the empty line as a
13046delimiter to mark an end of output for each command, and takes care of ensuring
13047that no command can emit an empty line on output. A script can thus easily
13048parse the output even when multiple commands were pipelined on a single line.
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010013049
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020013050It is important to understand that when multiple haproxy processes are started
13051on the same sockets, any process may pick up the request and will output its
13052own stats.
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010013053
Willy Tarreau468f4932013-08-01 16:50:16 +020013054The list of commands currently supported on the stats socket is provided below.
13055If an unknown command is sent, haproxy displays the usage message which reminds
13056all supported commands. Some commands support a more complex syntax, generally
13057it will explain what part of the command is invalid when this happens.
13058
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010013059add acl <acl> <pattern>
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010013060 Add an entry into the acl <acl>. <acl> is the #<id> or the <file> returned by
13061 "show acl". This command does not verify if the entry already exists. This
13062 command cannot be used if the reference <acl> is a file also used with a map.
13063 In this case, you must use the command "add map" in place of "add acl".
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010013064
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010013065add map <map> <key> <value>
13066 Add an entry into the map <map> to associate the value <value> to the key
13067 <key>. This command does not verify if the entry already exists. It is
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010013068 mainly used to fill a map after a clear operation. Note that if the reference
13069 <map> is a file and is shared with a map, this map will contain also a new
13070 pattern entry.
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010013071
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013072clear counters
13073 Clear the max values of the statistics counters in each proxy (frontend &
13074 backend) and in each server. The cumulated counters are not affected. This
13075 can be used to get clean counters after an incident, without having to
13076 restart nor to clear traffic counters. This command is restricted and can
13077 only be issued on sockets configured for levels "operator" or "admin".
13078
13079clear counters all
13080 Clear all statistics counters in each proxy (frontend & backend) and in each
13081 server. This has the same effect as restarting. This command is restricted
13082 and can only be issued on sockets configured for level "admin".
13083
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010013084clear acl <acl>
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010013085 Remove all entries from the acl <acl>. <acl> is the #<id> or the <file>
13086 returned by "show acl". Note that if the reference <acl> is a file and is
13087 shared with a map, this map will be also cleared.
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010013088
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010013089clear map <map>
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010013090 Remove all entries from the map <map>. <map> is the #<id> or the <file>
13091 returned by "show map". Note that if the reference <map> is a file and is
13092 shared with a acl, this acl will be also cleared.
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010013093
Simon Hormanc88b8872011-06-15 15:18:49 +090013094clear table <table> [ data.<type> <operator> <value> ] | [ key <key> ]
13095 Remove entries from the stick-table <table>.
13096
13097 This is typically used to unblock some users complaining they have been
13098 abusively denied access to a service, but this can also be used to clear some
13099 stickiness entries matching a server that is going to be replaced (see "show
13100 table" below for details). Note that sometimes, removal of an entry will be
13101 refused because it is currently tracked by a session. Retrying a few seconds
13102 later after the session ends is usual enough.
13103
13104 In the case where no options arguments are given all entries will be removed.
13105
13106 When the "data." form is used entries matching a filter applied using the
13107 stored data (see "stick-table" in section 4.2) are removed. A stored data
13108 type must be specified in <type>, and this data type must be stored in the
13109 table otherwise an error is reported. The data is compared according to
13110 <operator> with the 64-bit integer <value>. Operators are the same as with
13111 the ACLs :
13112
13113 - eq : match entries whose data is equal to this value
13114 - ne : match entries whose data is not equal to this value
13115 - le : match entries whose data is less than or equal to this value
13116 - ge : match entries whose data is greater than or equal to this value
13117 - lt : match entries whose data is less than this value
13118 - gt : match entries whose data is greater than this value
13119
13120 When the key form is used the entry <key> is removed. The key must be of the
Simon Horman619e3cc2011-06-15 15:18:52 +090013121 same type as the table, which currently is limited to IPv4, IPv6, integer and
13122 string.
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020013123
13124 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020013125 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020013126 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020013127 >>> 0x80e6a4c: key=127.0.0.1 use=0 exp=3594729 gpc0=0 conn_rate(30000)=1 \
13128 bytes_out_rate(60000)=187
13129 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
13130 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020013131
13132 $ echo "clear table http_proxy key 127.0.0.1" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
13133
13134 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020013135 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:1
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020013136 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
13137 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Simon Hormanc88b8872011-06-15 15:18:49 +090013138 $ echo "clear table http_proxy data.gpc0 eq 1" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
13139 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
13140 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:1
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020013141
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010013142del acl <acl> [<key>|#<ref>]
13143 Delete all the acl entries from the acl <acl> corresponding to the key <key>.
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010013144 <acl> is the #<id> or the <file> returned by "show acl". If the <ref> is used,
13145 this command delete only the listed reference. The reference can be found with
13146 listing the content of the acl. Note that if the reference <acl> is a file and
13147 is shared with a map, the entry will be also deleted in the map.
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010013148
13149del map <map> [<key>|#<ref>]
Thierry FOURNIER0b90f312014-01-29 20:40:18 +010013150 Delete all the map entries from the map <map> corresponding to the key <key>.
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010013151 <map> is the #<id> or the <file> returned by "show map". If the <ref> is used,
13152 this command delete only the listed reference. The reference can be found with
13153 listing the content of the map. Note that if the reference <map> is a file and
13154 is shared with a acl, the entry will be also deleted in the map.
Thierry FOURNIER0b90f312014-01-29 20:40:18 +010013155
13156disable agent <backend>/<server>
Simon Horman671b6f02013-11-25 10:46:39 +090013157 Mark the auxiliary agent check as temporarily stopped.
13158
13159 In the case where an agent check is being run as a auxiliary check, due
13160 to the agent-check parameter of a server directive, new checks are only
13161 initialised when the agent is in the enabled. Thus, disable agent will
13162 prevent any new agent checks from begin initiated until the agent
13163 re-enabled using enable agent.
13164
13165 When an agent is disabled the processing of an auxiliary agent check that
13166 was initiated while the agent was set as enabled is as follows: All
13167 results that would alter the weight, specifically "drain" or a weight
13168 returned by the agent, are ignored. The processing of agent check is
13169 otherwise unchanged.
13170
13171 The motivation for this feature is to allow the weight changing effects
13172 of the agent checks to be paused to allow the weight of a server to be
13173 configured using set weight without being overridden by the agent.
13174
13175 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
13176 level "admin".
13177
Willy Tarreau532a4502011-09-07 22:37:44 +020013178disable frontend <frontend>
13179 Mark the frontend as temporarily stopped. This corresponds to the mode which
13180 is used during a soft restart : the frontend releases the port but can be
13181 enabled again if needed. This should be used with care as some non-Linux OSes
13182 are unable to enable it back. This is intended to be used in environments
13183 where stopping a proxy is not even imaginable but a misconfigured proxy must
13184 be fixed. That way it's possible to release the port and bind it into another
13185 process to restore operations. The frontend will appear with status "STOP"
13186 on the stats page.
13187
13188 The frontend may be specified either by its name or by its numeric ID,
13189 prefixed with a sharp ('#').
13190
13191 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
13192 level "admin".
13193
Willy Tarreau9b5aecd2014-05-23 11:53:10 +020013194disable health <backend>/<server>
13195 Mark the primary health check as temporarily stopped. This will disable
13196 sending of health checks, and the last health check result will be ignored.
13197 The server will be in unchecked state and considered UP unless an auxiliary
13198 agent check forces it down.
13199
13200 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
13201 level "admin".
13202
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013203disable server <backend>/<server>
13204 Mark the server DOWN for maintenance. In this mode, no more checks will be
13205 performed on the server until it leaves maintenance.
13206 If the server is tracked by other servers, those servers will be set to DOWN
13207 during the maintenance.
13208
13209 In the statistics page, a server DOWN for maintenance will appear with a
13210 "MAINT" status, its tracking servers with the "MAINT(via)" one.
13211
13212 Both the backend and the server may be specified either by their name or by
Willy Tarreauf5f31922011-08-02 11:32:07 +020013213 their numeric ID, prefixed with a sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013214
13215 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
13216 level "admin".
13217
Simon Horman671b6f02013-11-25 10:46:39 +090013218enable agent <backend>/<server>
13219 Resume auxiliary agent check that was temporarily stopped.
13220
13221 See "disable agent" for details of the effect of temporarily starting
13222 and stopping an auxiliary agent.
13223
13224 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
13225 level "admin".
13226
Willy Tarreau532a4502011-09-07 22:37:44 +020013227enable frontend <frontend>
13228 Resume a frontend which was temporarily stopped. It is possible that some of
13229 the listening ports won't be able to bind anymore (eg: if another process
13230 took them since the 'disable frontend' operation). If this happens, an error
13231 is displayed. Some operating systems might not be able to resume a frontend
13232 which was disabled.
13233
13234 The frontend may be specified either by its name or by its numeric ID,
13235 prefixed with a sharp ('#').
13236
13237 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
13238 level "admin".
13239
Willy Tarreau9b5aecd2014-05-23 11:53:10 +020013240enable health <backend>/<server>
13241 Resume a primary health check that was temporarily stopped. This will enable
13242 sending of health checks again. Please see "disable health" for details.
13243
13244 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
13245 level "admin".
13246
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013247enable server <backend>/<server>
13248 If the server was previously marked as DOWN for maintenance, this marks the
13249 server UP and checks are re-enabled.
13250
13251 Both the backend and the server may be specified either by their name or by
Willy Tarreauf5f31922011-08-02 11:32:07 +020013252 their numeric ID, prefixed with a sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013253
13254 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
13255 level "admin".
13256
Thierry FOURNIER5b16df72014-02-26 18:07:38 +010013257get map <map> <value>
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010013258get acl <acl> <value>
13259 Lookup the value <value> in the map <map> or in the ACL <acl>. <map> or <acl>
13260 are the #<id> or the <file> returned by "show map" or "show acl". This command
13261 returns all the matching patterns associated with this map. This is useful for
13262 debugging maps and ACLs. The output format is composed by one line par
13263 matching type. Each line is composed by space-delimited series of words.
Thierry FOURNIER5b16df72014-02-26 18:07:38 +010013264
13265 The first two words are:
13266
13267 <match method>: The match method applied. It can be "found", "bool",
13268 "int", "ip", "bin", "len", "str", "beg", "sub", "dir",
13269 "dom", "end" or "reg".
13270
13271 <match result>: The result. Can be "match" or "no-match".
13272
13273 The following words are returned only if the pattern matches an entry.
13274
13275 <index type>: "tree" or "list". The internal lookup algorithm.
13276
13277 <case>: "case-insensitive" or "case-sensitive". The
13278 interpretation of the case.
13279
13280 <entry matched>: match="<entry>". Return the matched pattern. It is
13281 useful with regular expressions.
13282
13283 The two last word are used to show the returned value and its type. With the
13284 "acl" case, the pattern doesn't exist.
13285
13286 return=nothing: No return because there are no "map".
13287 return="<value>": The value returned in the string format.
13288 return=cannot-display: The value cannot be converted as string.
13289
13290 type="<type>": The type of the returned sample.
13291
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013292get weight <backend>/<server>
13293 Report the current weight and the initial weight of server <server> in
13294 backend <backend> or an error if either doesn't exist. The initial weight is
13295 the one that appears in the configuration file. Both are normally equal
13296 unless the current weight has been changed. Both the backend and the server
13297 may be specified either by their name or by their numeric ID, prefixed with a
Willy Tarreauf5f31922011-08-02 11:32:07 +020013298 sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013299
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020013300help
13301 Print the list of known keywords and their basic usage. The same help screen
13302 is also displayed for unknown commands.
Willy Tarreau3dfe6cd2008-12-07 22:29:48 +010013303
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020013304prompt
13305 Toggle the prompt at the beginning of the line and enter or leave interactive
13306 mode. In interactive mode, the connection is not closed after a command
13307 completes. Instead, the prompt will appear again, indicating the user that
13308 the interpreter is waiting for a new command. The prompt consists in a right
13309 angle bracket followed by a space "> ". This mode is particularly convenient
13310 when one wants to periodically check information such as stats or errors.
13311 It is also a good idea to enter interactive mode before issuing a "help"
13312 command.
13313
13314quit
13315 Close the connection when in interactive mode.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +010013316
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010013317set map <map> [<key>|#<ref>] <value>
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010013318 Modify the value corresponding to each key <key> in a map <map>. <map> is the
13319 #<id> or <file> returned by "show map". If the <ref> is used in place of
13320 <key>, only the entry pointed by <ref> is changed. The new value is <value>.
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010013321
Willy Tarreau2a0f4d22011-08-02 11:49:05 +020013322set maxconn frontend <frontend> <value>
Willy Tarreau3c7a79d2012-09-26 21:07:15 +020013323 Dynamically change the specified frontend's maxconn setting. Any positive
13324 value is allowed including zero, but setting values larger than the global
13325 maxconn does not make much sense. If the limit is increased and connections
13326 were pending, they will immediately be accepted. If it is lowered to a value
13327 below the current number of connections, new connections acceptation will be
Willy Tarreau2a0f4d22011-08-02 11:49:05 +020013328 delayed until the threshold is reached. The frontend might be specified by
13329 either its name or its numeric ID prefixed with a sharp ('#').
13330
Willy Tarreau91886b62011-09-07 14:38:31 +020013331set maxconn global <maxconn>
13332 Dynamically change the global maxconn setting within the range defined by the
13333 initial global maxconn setting. If it is increased and connections were
13334 pending, they will immediately be accepted. If it is lowered to a value below
13335 the current number of connections, new connections acceptation will be
13336 delayed until the threshold is reached. A value of zero restores the initial
13337 setting.
13338
Willy Tarreauf5b22872011-09-07 16:13:44 +020013339set rate-limit connections global <value>
13340 Change the process-wide connection rate limit, which is set by the global
13341 'maxconnrate' setting. A value of zero disables the limitation. This limit
13342 applies to all frontends and the change has an immediate effect. The value
13343 is passed in number of connections per second.
13344
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +010013345set rate-limit http-compression global <value>
13346 Change the maximum input compression rate, which is set by the global
13347 'maxcomprate' setting. A value of zero disables the limitation. The value is
William Lallemand096f5542012-11-19 17:26:05 +010013348 passed in number of kilobytes per second. The value is available in the "show
13349 info" on the line "CompressBpsRateLim" in bytes.
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +010013350
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +020013351set rate-limit sessions global <value>
13352 Change the process-wide session rate limit, which is set by the global
13353 'maxsessrate' setting. A value of zero disables the limitation. This limit
13354 applies to all frontends and the change has an immediate effect. The value
13355 is passed in number of sessions per second.
13356
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +020013357set rate-limit ssl-sessions global <value>
13358 Change the process-wide SSL session rate limit, which is set by the global
13359 'maxsslrate' setting. A value of zero disables the limitation. This limit
13360 applies to all frontends and the change has an immediate effect. The value
13361 is passed in number of sessions per second sent to the SSL stack. It applies
13362 before the handshake in order to protect the stack against handshake abuses.
13363
Willy Tarreau2a4b70f2014-05-22 18:42:35 +020013364set server <backend>/<server> agent [ up | down ]
13365 Force a server's agent to a new state. This can be useful to immediately
13366 switch a server's state regardless of some slow agent checks for example.
13367 Note that the change is propagated to tracking servers if any.
13368
13369set server <backend>/<server> health [ up | stopping | down ]
13370 Force a server's health to a new state. This can be useful to immediately
13371 switch a server's state regardless of some slow health checks for example.
13372 Note that the change is propagated to tracking servers if any.
13373
13374set server <backend>/<server> state [ ready | drain | maint ]
13375 Force a server's administrative state to a new state. This can be useful to
13376 disable load balancing and/or any traffic to a server. Setting the state to
13377 "ready" puts the server in normal mode, and the command is the equivalent of
13378 the "enable server" command. Setting the state to "maint" disables any traffic
13379 to the server as well as any health checks. This is the equivalent of the
13380 "disable server" command. Setting the mode to "drain" only removes the server
13381 from load balancing but still allows it to be checked and to accept new
13382 persistent connections. Changes are propagated to tracking servers if any.
13383
13384set server <backend>/<server> weight <weight>[%]
13385 Change a server's weight to the value passed in argument. This is the exact
13386 equivalent of the "set weight" command below.
13387
Willy Tarreau47060b62013-08-01 21:11:42 +020013388set table <table> key <key> [data.<data_type> <value>]*
Willy Tarreau654694e2012-06-07 01:03:16 +020013389 Create or update a stick-table entry in the table. If the key is not present,
13390 an entry is inserted. See stick-table in section 4.2 to find all possible
13391 values for <data_type>. The most likely use consists in dynamically entering
13392 entries for source IP addresses, with a flag in gpc0 to dynamically block an
Willy Tarreau47060b62013-08-01 21:11:42 +020013393 IP address or affect its quality of service. It is possible to pass multiple
13394 data_types in a single call.
Willy Tarreau654694e2012-06-07 01:03:16 +020013395
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013396set timeout cli <delay>
13397 Change the CLI interface timeout for current connection. This can be useful
13398 during long debugging sessions where the user needs to constantly inspect
13399 some indicators without being disconnected. The delay is passed in seconds.
13400
13401set weight <backend>/<server> <weight>[%]
13402 Change a server's weight to the value passed in argument. If the value ends
13403 with the '%' sign, then the new weight will be relative to the initially
Simon Horman58b5d292013-02-12 10:45:52 +090013404 configured weight. Absolute weights are permitted between 0 and 256.
13405 Relative weights must be positive with the resulting absolute weight is
13406 capped at 256. Servers which are part of a farm running a static
13407 load-balancing algorithm have stricter limitations because the weight
13408 cannot change once set. Thus for these servers, the only accepted values
13409 are 0 and 100% (or 0 and the initial weight). Changes take effect
13410 immediately, though certain LB algorithms require a certain amount of
13411 requests to consider changes. A typical usage of this command is to
13412 disable a server during an update by setting its weight to zero, then to
13413 enable it again after the update by setting it back to 100%. This command
13414 is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for level
13415 "admin". Both the backend and the server may be specified either by their
13416 name or by their numeric ID, prefixed with a sharp ('#').
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013417
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +010013418show errors [<iid>]
13419 Dump last known request and response errors collected by frontends and
13420 backends. If <iid> is specified, the limit the dump to errors concerning
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +020013421 either frontend or backend whose ID is <iid>. This command is restricted
13422 and can only be issued on sockets configured for levels "operator" or
13423 "admin".
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +010013424
13425 The errors which may be collected are the last request and response errors
13426 caused by protocol violations, often due to invalid characters in header
13427 names. The report precisely indicates what exact character violated the
13428 protocol. Other important information such as the exact date the error was
13429 detected, frontend and backend names, the server name (when known), the
13430 internal session ID and the source address which has initiated the session
13431 are reported too.
13432
13433 All characters are returned, and non-printable characters are encoded. The
13434 most common ones (\t = 9, \n = 10, \r = 13 and \e = 27) are encoded as one
13435 letter following a backslash. The backslash itself is encoded as '\\' to
13436 avoid confusion. Other non-printable characters are encoded '\xNN' where
13437 NN is the two-digits hexadecimal representation of the character's ASCII
13438 code.
13439
13440 Lines are prefixed with the position of their first character, starting at 0
13441 for the beginning of the buffer. At most one input line is printed per line,
13442 and large lines will be broken into multiple consecutive output lines so that
13443 the output never goes beyond 79 characters wide. It is easy to detect if a
13444 line was broken, because it will not end with '\n' and the next line's offset
13445 will be followed by a '+' sign, indicating it is a continuation of previous
13446 line.
13447
13448 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020013449 $ echo "show errors" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
13450 >>> [04/Mar/2009:15:46:56.081] backend http-in (#2) : invalid response
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +010013451 src 127.0.0.1, session #54, frontend fe-eth0 (#1), server s2 (#1)
13452 response length 213 bytes, error at position 23:
13453
13454 00000 HTTP/1.0 200 OK\r\n
13455 00017 header/bizarre:blah\r\n
13456 00038 Location: blah\r\n
13457 00054 Long-line: this is a very long line which should b
13458 00104+ e broken into multiple lines on the output buffer,
13459 00154+ otherwise it would be too large to print in a ter
13460 00204+ minal\r\n
13461 00211 \r\n
13462
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013463 In the example above, we see that the backend "http-in" which has internal
Willy Tarreaue0c8a1a2009-03-04 16:33:10 +010013464 ID 2 has blocked an invalid response from its server s2 which has internal
13465 ID 1. The request was on session 54 initiated by source 127.0.0.1 and
13466 received by frontend fe-eth0 whose ID is 1. The total response length was
13467 213 bytes when the error was detected, and the error was at byte 23. This
13468 is the slash ('/') in header name "header/bizarre", which is not a valid
13469 HTTP character for a header name.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki2c6962c2008-03-02 02:42:14 +010013470
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020013471show info
13472 Dump info about haproxy status on current process.
13473
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010013474show map [<map>]
13475 Dump info about map converters. Without argument, the list of all available
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010013476 maps is returned. If a <map> is specified, its contents are dumped. <map> is
13477 the #<id> or <file>. The first column is a unique identifier. It can be used
13478 as reference for the operation "del map" and "set map". The second column is
13479 the pattern and the third column is the sample if available. The data returned
13480 are not directly a list of available maps, but are the list of all patterns
13481 composing any map. Many of these patterns can be shared with ACL.
Thierry FOURNIERd32079e2014-01-29 20:02:04 +010013482
13483show acl [<acl>]
13484 Dump info about acl converters. Without argument, the list of all available
Thierry FOURNIER65ce6132014-03-20 11:42:45 +010013485 acls is returned. If a <acl> is specified, its contents are dumped. <acl> if
13486 the #<id> or <file>. The dump format is the same than the map even for the
13487 sample value. The data returned are not a list of available ACL, but are the
13488 list of all patterns composing any ACL. Many of these patterns can be shared
13489 with maps.
Thierry FOURNIERc0e0d7b2013-12-11 16:55:52 +010013490
Willy Tarreau12833bb2014-01-28 16:49:56 +010013491show pools
13492 Dump the status of internal memory pools. This is useful to track memory
13493 usage when suspecting a memory leak for example. It does exactly the same
13494 as the SIGQUIT when running in foreground except that it does not flush
13495 the pools.
13496
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020013497show sess
13498 Dump all known sessions. Avoid doing this on slow connections as this can
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +020013499 be huge. This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets
13500 configured for levels "operator" or "admin".
13501
Willy Tarreau66dc20a2010-03-05 17:53:32 +010013502show sess <id>
13503 Display a lot of internal information about the specified session identifier.
13504 This identifier is the first field at the beginning of the lines in the dumps
13505 of "show sess" (it corresponds to the session pointer). Those information are
13506 useless to most users but may be used by haproxy developers to troubleshoot a
13507 complex bug. The output format is intentionally not documented so that it can
Willy Tarreau76153662012-11-26 01:16:39 +010013508 freely evolve depending on demands. The special id "all" dumps the states of
13509 all sessions, which can be avoided as much as possible as it is highly CPU
13510 intensive and can take a lot of time.
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020013511
13512show stat [<iid> <type> <sid>]
13513 Dump statistics in the CSV format. By passing <id>, <type> and <sid>, it is
13514 possible to dump only selected items :
13515 - <iid> is a proxy ID, -1 to dump everything
13516 - <type> selects the type of dumpable objects : 1 for frontends, 2 for
13517 backends, 4 for servers, -1 for everything. These values can be ORed,
13518 for example:
13519 1 + 2 = 3 -> frontend + backend.
13520 1 + 2 + 4 = 7 -> frontend + backend + server.
13521 - <sid> is a server ID, -1 to dump everything from the selected proxy.
13522
13523 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020013524 $ echo "show info;show stat" | socat stdio unix-connect:/tmp/sock1
13525 >>> Name: HAProxy
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020013526 Version: 1.4-dev2-49
13527 Release_date: 2009/09/23
13528 Nbproc: 1
13529 Process_num: 1
13530 (...)
13531
13532 # pxname,svname,qcur,qmax,scur,smax,slim,stot,bin,bout,dreq, (...)
13533 stats,FRONTEND,,,0,0,1000,0,0,0,0,0,0,,,,,OPEN,,,,,,,,,1,1,0, (...)
13534 stats,BACKEND,0,0,0,0,1000,0,0,0,0,0,,0,0,0,0,UP,0,0,0,,0,250,(...)
13535 (...)
13536 www1,BACKEND,0,0,0,0,1000,0,0,0,0,0,,0,0,0,0,UP,1,1,0,,0,250, (...)
13537
13538 $
13539
13540 Here, two commands have been issued at once. That way it's easy to find
13541 which process the stats apply to in multi-process mode. Notice the empty
13542 line after the information output which marks the end of the first block.
13543 A similar empty line appears at the end of the second block (stats) so that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010013544 the reader knows the output has not been truncated.
Willy Tarreau9a42c0d2009-09-22 19:31:03 +020013545
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020013546show table
13547 Dump general information on all known stick-tables. Their name is returned
13548 (the name of the proxy which holds them), their type (currently zero, always
13549 IP), their size in maximum possible number of entries, and the number of
13550 entries currently in use.
13551
13552 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020013553 $ echo "show table" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090013554 >>> # table: front_pub, type: ip, size:204800, used:171454
13555 >>> # table: back_rdp, type: ip, size:204800, used:0
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020013556
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090013557show table <name> [ data.<type> <operator> <value> ] | [ key <key> ]
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020013558 Dump contents of stick-table <name>. In this mode, a first line of generic
13559 information about the table is reported as with "show table", then all
13560 entries are dumped. Since this can be quite heavy, it is possible to specify
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090013561 a filter in order to specify what entries to display.
13562
13563 When the "data." form is used the filter applies to the stored data (see
13564 "stick-table" in section 4.2). A stored data type must be specified
13565 in <type>, and this data type must be stored in the table otherwise an
13566 error is reported. The data is compared according to <operator> with the
13567 64-bit integer <value>. Operators are the same as with the ACLs :
13568
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020013569 - eq : match entries whose data is equal to this value
13570 - ne : match entries whose data is not equal to this value
13571 - le : match entries whose data is less than or equal to this value
13572 - ge : match entries whose data is greater than or equal to this value
13573 - lt : match entries whose data is less than this value
13574 - gt : match entries whose data is greater than this value
13575
Simon Hormanc88b8872011-06-15 15:18:49 +090013576
13577 When the key form is used the entry <key> is shown. The key must be of the
Simon Horman619e3cc2011-06-15 15:18:52 +090013578 same type as the table, which currently is limited to IPv4, IPv6, integer,
13579 and string.
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090013580
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020013581 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020013582 $ echo "show table http_proxy" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090013583 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020013584 >>> 0x80e6a4c: key=127.0.0.1 use=0 exp=3594729 gpc0=0 conn_rate(30000)=1 \
13585 bytes_out_rate(60000)=187
13586 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
13587 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020013588
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020013589 $ echo "show table http_proxy data.gpc0 gt 0" | socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090013590 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020013591 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
13592 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020013593
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020013594 $ echo "show table http_proxy data.conn_rate gt 5" | \
13595 socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090013596 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020013597 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
13598 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020013599
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090013600 $ echo "show table http_proxy key 127.0.0.2" | \
13601 socat stdio /tmp/sock1
Simon Horman64b28d02011-08-13 08:03:50 +090013602 >>> # table: http_proxy, type: ip, size:204800, used:2
Simon Horman17bce342011-06-15 15:18:47 +090013603 >>> 0x80e6a80: key=127.0.0.2 use=0 exp=3594740 gpc0=1 conn_rate(30000)=10 \
13604 bytes_out_rate(60000)=191
13605
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020013606 When the data criterion applies to a dynamic value dependent on time such as
13607 a bytes rate, the value is dynamically computed during the evaluation of the
13608 entry in order to decide whether it has to be dumped or not. This means that
13609 such a filter could match for some time then not match anymore because as
13610 time goes, the average event rate drops.
13611
13612 It is possible to use this to extract lists of IP addresses abusing the
13613 service, in order to monitor them or even blacklist them in a firewall.
13614 Example :
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020013615 $ echo "show table http_proxy data.gpc0 gt 0" \
13616 | socat stdio /tmp/sock1 \
Willy Tarreau88bc4ec2010-08-01 07:58:48 +020013617 | fgrep 'key=' | cut -d' ' -f2 | cut -d= -f2 > abusers-ip.txt
13618 ( or | awk '/key/{ print a[split($2,a,"=")]; }' )
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki719e7262009-10-04 15:02:46 +020013619
Willy Tarreau532a4502011-09-07 22:37:44 +020013620shutdown frontend <frontend>
13621 Completely delete the specified frontend. All the ports it was bound to will
13622 be released. It will not be possible to enable the frontend anymore after
13623 this operation. This is intended to be used in environments where stopping a
13624 proxy is not even imaginable but a misconfigured proxy must be fixed. That
13625 way it's possible to release the port and bind it into another process to
13626 restore operations. The frontend will not appear at all on the stats page
13627 once it is terminated.
13628
13629 The frontend may be specified either by its name or by its numeric ID,
13630 prefixed with a sharp ('#').
13631
13632 This command is restricted and can only be issued on sockets configured for
13633 level "admin".
13634
Willy Tarreaua295edc2011-09-07 23:21:03 +020013635shutdown session <id>
13636 Immediately terminate the session matching the specified session identifier.
13637 This identifier is the first field at the beginning of the lines in the dumps
13638 of "show sess" (it corresponds to the session pointer). This can be used to
13639 terminate a long-running session without waiting for a timeout or when an
13640 endless transfer is ongoing. Such terminated sessions are reported with a 'K'
13641 flag in the logs.
13642
Willy Tarreau52b2d222011-09-07 23:48:48 +020013643shutdown sessions <backend>/<server>
13644 Immediately terminate all the sessions attached to the specified server. This
13645 can be used to terminate long-running sessions after a server is put into
13646 maintenance mode, for instance. Such terminated sessions are reported with a
13647 'K' flag in the logs.
13648
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013649/*
13650 * Local variables:
13651 * fill-column: 79
13652 * End:
13653 */